CROMPTON GREAVES LTD. TRANSFORMER (T1) DIVISION MUMBAI 400 042, INDIA Tel : 0091 22 67558200 Fax : 0091 22 67558307
OPERATION & MAINTENANCE MANUAL FOR
80 MVA, 220/13.8/6.9 kV HV TRANSFORMER CGL W.O. ET10412 CLIENT
: Black & Veatch on behalf of Minera Escondida Ltd.
SUBSTATION : BHPB Escondida Water Supply Project EQUIPMENT
: HV POWER TRANSFORMER
ORIGINATED BY
APPROVED BY
DATE: 16/02/2015
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
INDEX 1.
Introduction 1.1. Purpose of O & M Manual 1.2. Instruction Guide – Guide to Important Drawings 1.3. General Safety Measures 1.3.1.Overview 1.3.2.Basic Safety Practice 1.3.3.Transformer Specific Safety Practice 1.4. Contact Details 1.5. Health, Safety and Environment considerations at site
2.
General Transformer Features 2.1. Technical Characteristics 2.2. Mechanical Features 2.3. Transformer Grounding 2.3.1.Transformer Grounding 2.3.2.Temporary Grounding of Transformer Body
3.
Packing, Transport, Handling & Storage 3.1. Packing 3.1.1.Overview 3.1.2.Packaging of transformer 3.1.3.Condenser bushings 3.1.4.Oil 3.1.5.Radiators 3.1.6.Fabricated Items 3.1.7.Control Cabinets 3.1.8.Instruments 3.1.9.Marking 3.2. Transport & Handling 3.2.1. Overview 3.2.2. Road Transport
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 3.2.3. Rail Transport 3.2.4. Water Transport 3.2.5. Loading 3.2.6. Shipping Documents 3.3. Receiving Main Unit and Accessories 3.3.1.Checking Shipping & Consignment Documents 3.3.2.Unpacking & Inspection 3.3.3.Standard Receiving Tests 3.4. Storage of Main Unit and Accessories 3.4.1. Overview 3.4.2. Storage of Transformer 3.4.3. Storage of Accessories 3.4.4. Storage of Oil Drums 3.4.5. Periodic Inspection during Storage 3.5. Safety Measures during Transport, Handling and Storage
4.
Assembling & Installation 4.1. Installation Equipments & Tools 4.2. General Installation Topics 4.3. Locating Transformer on a Plinth 4.3.1.Moving a Transformer on Wheels 4.3.2.Moving a Transformer on Steel Rods 4.4. Recommended Steps for Assembling & Installation 4.5. Installation of Transformer Main Unit 4.6. Installation of Radiators 4.7. Installation of Cooling Fans 4.8. Installation of Bushing Turrets 4.9. Installation of Condenser Bushings 4.10. Installation of Other Bushings 4.11. Installation of Conservator and Pipes 4.12. Installation of Current Transformers (CT’s) 4.13. Wiring on the Transformer 4.14. Installation of Other Items 4.14.1.Gaskets for Liquid Filled Transformers
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 4.14.2.Breather Installation 4.14.3.OTI and WTI 4.14.4.PRD 4.14.5.Plate Valves and their Assemblies 4.15. Oil Filling Procedure 4.16. Do’s and Don’ts during Assembling and Installation
5.
Pre-commissioning checks 5.1. Overview 5.2. General Guidelines 5.3. Mechanical Checks 5.3.1. Location on Foundation 5.3.2. Bushings and Terminal Connectors 5.3.3. Valves and Pipe-work 5.3.4. Radiators and Cooling Systems 5.3.5. Leak Test 5.4. Tests on Transformer and Accessories 5.4.1.
Oil Sampling and Testing
5.4.2.
Ratio, Polarity and Vector Group Test
5.4.3.
Winding Resistance Measurement
5.4.4.
Insulation Resistance (Meggar) test
5.4.5.
Insulation Resistance Test
5.4.6.
Measurement of Magnetising Current
5.4.7.
Magnetic Balance Test
5.4.8.
Power Factor Measurement (Tan-Delta) of Transformer Windings & Bushings
5.4.9.
Tests on Auxiliary Instruments
5.4.10. Tests on Tap Changer 5.4.11. Checking of Fans and Pumps 5.4.12. Checking of Marshalling Box 5.4.13. Checking of Oil 5.4.14. SFRA Test 5.5. Instruments used for Pre - Commissioning Tests 5.6. Start Up Instructions
3
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
6.
Commissioning 6.1. Repeating Pre-Commissioning Checks 6.2. Operational System Tests 6.2.1.Relay Settings 6.2.2.Alarm Circuits and Contacts 6.2.3.Trip Circuit and Contacts 6.2.4.Temperature Settings 6.2.5.Rating of Pressure Relief Device 6.2.6.System Voltage, Frequency & Phase Sequence Check 6.2.7.Oil Sampling and Checking 6.3. Transformer Energization 6.3.1.Minimum Settling Time after Final Oil Filling 6.3.2.First Energization on No Load 6.3.3.Loading the Transformer
7.
Maintenance 7.1. Introduction 7.2. Safety during Maintenance 7.3. Periodic Inspection and Checks during Service 7.3.1.External Cleaning 7.3.2.Transformer Body 7.3.3.Gaskets 7.3.4.Oil 7.3.5.Bushings 7.3.6.Conservator and Magnetic Oil Gauge 7.3.7.Tap Changer 7.3.8.Dehydrating Breather 7.3.9. Cooling System 7.3.10. Temperature Indicators 7.3.11. External Circuits and Control Equipment 7.3.12. Buchholtz Relay 7.3.13. Explosion Vent 7.4. Preventive Maintenance Inspection Chart
4
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
8.
Trouble shooting 8.1. Indication Signals of Malfunction or Abnormality 8.2. Trouble Shooting Chart 8.2.1. Trouble Shooting Flow 8.2.2. Trouble Shooting Flowchart for Abnormal level of Fault Gases 8.3. Trouble Shooting Process 8.4. Emergency Response for Unexpected Events 8.5. Energizing Transformer after Fault
9.
End of life Disposal 9.1. Planning for disposal 9.2. Human safety 9.3. Environment safety
10.
Transformer Drawings and Catalogue 10.1. Transformer Details 10.2. List of Approved drawings 10.3. List of Reference Drawings 10.4. Brochures for Accessories and Fittings
11.
TMDS (SMART MONITOR) 11.1. Operation and Maintenance Manual
12.
GAS GUARD 12.1. GAS-Guard Site Preparation Guide 12.2. GAS-Guard Installation Guide 12.3. GAS-Guard Operation and Maintenance Guide 12.4. GAS-Guard Software User's Manual
13.
Neutral Grounding resistor / transformer 13.1. Installation And Maintenance Instructions
14.
Oil discharge Instruction 14.1. Oil Discharge Procedure
5
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
SECTION – 1
Introduction
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 1.1
Purpose of O & M Manual
Every product comes with a user manual and a transformer is no exception. The main purpose of this Operation and Maintenance manual (O&M manual) Is to educate and familiarize the end user about the product, its installation procedure, operating procedure and maintenance activities. 1.2
Instruction Guide – Guide to important drawings
All the relevant drawings including Outline general arrangement drawing (GA) etc. have been attached at the end of manual for ready reference. 1.3 1.3.1
General safety measures Overview
Always be alert to emergencies. If an accident should occur, quickly utilize the safety equipment, emergency tools and equipment at hand. Before you begin a project, ensure that at least two people know first aid procedures and that they have the proper first aid kits at hand. Ensure that all protective equipment required for the job is available to all workers and ensure that it is used correctly. This equipment may include helmets, breathing apparatus, eye protection, gloves, foot protection etc. Ensure that all electrical circuits to be worked on have been traced and deenergized. Ensure that all safety grounds have been correctly applied to protect personnel against the accidental application of power to these circuits (refer to chapter 2 for more information on temporary grounding.)
Being a high voltage product, safety to life and property is of utmost importance. Keeping this in mind, relevant caution and safety instructions have been provided at relevant places, the reason being that safety instructions specific to specific tasks have been covered at respective places.
DO NOT assume that someone else has turned off the power, check for yourself. Use the padlock and key interlock system where available to protect yourself and others.
1.3.2
DO NOT walk under equipment that is suspended from a crane.
Basic safety practice
Every operator must have a safety program and he has to know how to use it in the event of an accident. Ensure that safety equipment and tools are always close at hand, and suitable fire extinguishing equipment and qualified personnel are available. Make sure that the equipment used is suitable for fire involving oil filled electrical installations. Make sure that it is correctly charged and that you know how to use it.
DO NOT work under equipment that is raised and insecurely blocked.
DO NOT walk holding a ladder or any other long object near a transformer or overhead lines under voltage. Before lifting any object by any means, ensure that its weight can be handled correctly. Use the appropriate lifting or handling tools. DO NOT work on or adjust moving equipment. DO NOT work on or adjust mechanical equipment unless its motive source has been deactivated.
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 1.3.3
Transformer specific safety practice
must be taken to prevent objects from falling into the transformer.
DO NOT walk on a transformer or its parts unless the unit has been de-energized.
Anyone going inside a transformer must wear clean clothes and clean syntheticrubber boots. Never stand directly on any part of the insulation.
DO NOT walk on a transformer under vacuum. Never perform any electrical tests on a transformer under vacuum. Do not apply vacuum when it is raining or when the transformer is unsupervised. When pressure tests are being performed or when vacuum is being applied, the pressure must be equalized between the main tank and the (On) Load Tap Changer compartment if these compartments are separated by terminal panels which might not be able to withstand pressure differences. Find out which parts will not be able to withstand a complete vacuum. Before removing any cover plate or transformer fitting, ensure that the overpressure inside the transformer is zero and that the oil level is lower than the opening in question. In the event of a sudden change in the weather bringing penetrating rain or snow, provisions must be made for closing the tank quickly and pressurizing it with dry air in order to preserve the insulation. To allow anyone entering a transformer the air has to support life with a sufficient oxygen level (19.5%).
Correct operation of all protective circuits and protective devices for the transformer should be checked on a regular basis. Neglecting of these circuits or devices, or overriding of the functions of these circuits or devices could allow minor problems to develop into a major problem. This may result in a total loss of the transformer, damage to other equipment and injury of personnel. A pressure relief device incorporates heavy spring in compression, DO NOT dismantles such a device, unless suitable safeguards have been implemented, otherwise personnel injury may occur. Recommended commissioning checks must be performed before the first energization of the transformer. 1.4
Contact details
Customer Services Dept. Crompton Greaves Ltd; Power Transformers division (T1) Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai- 400042 Tel.: +91 22 6755 8000/25782451
Extreme precautions are to be taken to protect the insulation of the transformer from any damage and to prevent the ingress of foreign objects and moisture during the checking and erection of the transformer. Whilst the transformer is open, no one may be allowed on top of it, unless this person has emptied his/her pockets, has checked himself/herself for the presence of objects such as watch, rings etc. and has removed them. These precautions
3
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 1.5
Health, Safety & Environment considerations at site
1.
In view of the hazards associated while working with transformers all personnel who work or support the work must demonstrate a responsible attitude.
2.
The personnel working must undergo orientation, of the HSE requirements through the employer.
3.
Categorization of Risk & Hazards must be done before carrying out related activity.
4.
Prohibit entry where there potential Risks & Hazards.
5.
Documentation of preventive actions / remedial actions in case of high risk areas.
6.
7.
is
Storage of accessories (including high risk material) as per guidelines given in the Manual/MSDS. Disposition of hazardous waste as per guidelines given in MSDS.
12. Ensure personnel are not permitted to enter confined spaces i.e spaces which have the risk of encountering hazardous conditions like fire, fumes, and vapors, deficiency of oxygen, drowning, and high temperature. 13. Ensure use of weather proof hand lamps, scaffolding, man lift, bucket crane, crane, belts and ropes wherever required. 14. Transformer Oil is capable of catching fire ensure extinguishers are available during work. 15. Use appropriate clothing considering nature of work and climatic condition at site. 16. Ensure availability of assistance in case of emergency like first aid box, details of nearest medical care facilities. 17. Any other statutory requirements as per customer or local authority to be followed.
8. Documentation for Permit To Work. 9. Inspection of tools/ tackles/ instruments and safety equipment for suitability before start of work. 10. Review of Calibration status for testing/measuring instruments. 11. Ensure Use of personnel protective equipment like safety harness/Safety shoes, Helmet goggles.
4
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
SECTION - 2 General Transformer Features
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
2.1. Technical characteristics A transformer is essentially an electrical product. The technical characteristic which are of utmost importance are MVA rating, kV rating & impedance of the transformer. Please refer Rating & Diagram plate for details specific for the transformer. The other technical aspect is the insulation level for which the transformer is designed. The transformer being a tailor-made product, every transformer differs from any other transformer as far as electrical characteristics and features are concerned. 2.2.
Mechanical features By looking at the transformers around us, we find that majority of the transformers resemble each other. This tells us that though the electrical features may differ, mechanical features do not differ much. The point made here is that the transformer has a body (tank), and is mounted with accessories such as radiators, fans, breather, conservator, breather, Buscholz relay, bushings etc. as applicable. To know the mechanical features specific to the transformer, please refer General Arrangement (OGA) drawing along with the drawings of the accessories enclosed at the end of the manual.
2.3.
Transformer grounding
2.3.1. Transformer grounding Parts that are to be grounded are as shown in the figure 2.1. Please refer General arrangement drawing before proceeding. The generic items are as shown in the schematic and the corresponding parts are as follows: 1. Breather 2. Conservator and parts 3. Tap changer 4. Bushing 5. Cable box 6. Current transformer 7. Lightning arrester 8. Current transformer 9. Marshalling kiosk and OLTC Motordrive unit 10. Oil-air cooler 11. Radiators and mounting structures 12. Fan 13. Oil-water cooler 14. Pump 2.3.2. Temporary transformer body
grounding
of
Temporary groundings, used while personnel are working on de-energized transformers, must always be applied in accordance with the approved safety and operation practices issued by the employer. In addition, they must be in accordance with the instructions for the specific grounding equipment used. Temporary grounding is required for a number of reasons: · Induced voltage from adjacent energized lines. · Fault current feed-over from adjacent lines. · Lightning strikes anywhere on the circuit. · Switching equipment malfunction or human error. · Accident initiated contact with adjacent lines.
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
Figure 2.1 Parts to be grounded
3
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
======================================================================
SECTION – 3 Packing, Transport, Handling and Storage
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
====================================================================== 3.1
Packing
3.1.1
Overview
• Oil in Tanker/ container: Oil transported in clean oil tanks/ containers
The main unit is dispatched oil filled or Dry air filled.
• Flexi bags in Container: Oil can also be filled in flexi bags transported in containers. 3.1.5
Radiators
The packing type depends on: Radiators are packed in crates. • Dimension/ Weight constraints during transportation and handling • Customer specification • Legal obligations concerning mode of transport The parts/accessories detached from main unit assembly for transportation are listed in the Outline drawing. These are transported separately in suitable crates. Preserve packing lists enclosed package to facilitate onsite check. 3.1.2
with
each
Packaging of Transformer
The transformer body is not packed (unless otherwise specified). Shock recorders are provided if specified. Bushings mounted on transformer during dispatch are guarded with transport hoods made of steel/wood. Valves fitted on main units are to be properly locked and protected by providing valve guards. All dismounted parts are packed separately (see below). 3.1.3
Condenser bushings
3.1.6
Fabricated Items
All fabricated items like headers, cooler pipes, conservators, cable boxes etc are packed in wooden cases.. 3.1.7
Control Cabinets
RTCC, Marshalling box and Thermo-Junction box are individually covered and packed in wooden case. Sometimes Marshalling box and Thermo –Junction box may be mounted on the main unit. 3.1.8
Instruments
Instruments line Winding Temperature Indicator, Oil Temperature Indicator, Dissolved Gas Analyzer and relays etc are individually covered and packed in wooden case 3.1.9
Marking
For ease of identification, fabricated items are punched marked. a) Work Order Number (W.O. No.) b) Serial Number c) Item Number
Condenser bushings are packed in wooden crates, as per the OEM instruction. 3.1.4
Oil
• Oil filled Dispatch: Oil is transported filled in the transformer tank. Oil is filled to fully cover the core and winding assembly.. • Dry Air Filled Dispatch: Oil is packed in sealeddrums of standard size.
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
====================================================================== 3.2
Transport & Handling
3.2.3
3.2.1
Overview
Transformer is transported to loading railway station either by a rail network or road tractortrailers. Rollers of transformer are removed before leaving works.
In many cases, a transformer has to travel long distances before reaching its final destination. During this journey many handling operations are needed for loading, transportation, unloading and transfer to other carrier types. All necessary precautions need to be taken during transit to assure safe handling of the transformer. Transformers may be transported by road/ rail/ sea depending on size of transformer, destination, delivery time and the route limitations. Detached parts are packed/crated and normally dispatched along with the main body of the unit, so that all the parts are received at the destination station with the unit.
3.2.4
Rail Transport
Water Transport
Ocean going ships for high seas and barges for inland navigation routes are used for water transportation. Special care is to be taken for prevention of rusting of parts and ingress of moisture like use of anti corrosive paints, silica gel packing, and sealing using polythene covers etc. 3.2.5
Loading
3.2.5.1 Lifting and Jacking During transportation, make sure that the Transformer body is blocked and secured on all sides. This should be done to prevent the Transformer body from shifting its position. 3.2.2
Road Transport
Transport by road necessitates availability of good condition roads and route permit. Route survey to cover following aspects is to be done: Width of road: Adequacy of passage at all places. (ii) Bridges and Culverts: Adequacy to take the moving load. (iii) Encumbrances En-route: Presence of telephone, telegraph, traction and electric utility wires, subways etc across the roadway (iv) Sharp bends (v) Road Worthiness: Check for road condition, locality, presence of schools and other public places (vi) Operational Constraints: Of Tractor-trailor
Before lifting the complete transformer it should be ensured that all cover bolts are tightened. Use lifting points provided on the tank for the purpose of lifting. Simultaneous use should be made of all such lugs or lifting bollards in order to avoid any unbalance in lifting. It is advisable to use a spreader between slings so that the lift on the hooks is in the vertical direction. The slinging angle is not to exceed 60°. Safe loads of wire ropes and the multiplying factors to be used corresponding to the lifting angles are furnished in
(i)
Necessary clearance from local authorities, for movement shall be ensured.
Fig. 1. When using jacking for lifting, only the Jacking pads provided for the purpose of jacking should be used. Jacks are also not to be left in position with load for a long time. The transformer should always be handled in the normal upright position. During the handling operation care must be taken to prevent overturning or uneven tilting. 3.2.5.2 Lashing The transformer is lashed on all four sides by wire ropes or chain of adequate size and Tightened using turn buckles with locking facility. Tightness of lashing is to be checked after short movement.
3
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
====================================================================== 3.2.6
Shipping Documents
Contents, route, destination of each shipment, invoices of shipment, bills of loading etc and packing list accompanies the shipment.
4
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
====================================================================== 3.3
Receiving Main Unit and Accessories
3.3.1
Checking Shipping and Consignment Documents
On receiving the transformer unit, check the consignment against packing list enclosed. Also ensure all consignment documents including various bills etc are in order before proceeding further. 3.3.2
Unpacking and Inspection
A thorough external examination shall be made immediately on arrival of the transformer at site. If any damage is suspected, open delivery is to be taken and a claim made against the carriers in accordance with the terms of contract. The manufacturers and under-writers are also to be informed about the details of inspection done jointly in carriers. Packages are to be opened carefully so that the tools used for opening do not cause damage to the contents. 3.3.2.1 External Inspection 1) Preliminary Inspection: Check for signs of damage on the exterior like damage to blocking, impact on covers, paint scraping etc.
The gas pressure varies in proportion to gas temperature. Check the gas pressure upon arrival against gas pressure and temperature at the time of dispatch. Consult Manufacturer in case Main tank received with zero pressure. When the transformer is dispatched filled with oil, oil level in main tank at the time of receipt is to be verified visually through the dispatch oil gauge on the tank. Any shortage, theft or damage is to be duly recorded and reported to Carrier, Underwriters and manufacturer. 3.3.2.2 Inspection of Accessories Refer Packing list and check off each inspected accessory. Below checks important: 1) Oil Drums: Drums containing transformer oil, which have been dispatched separately, shall be examined carefully for leaks. All drums are dispatched filled up to their capacity and any shortage should be reported. 2) Bushings: Oil level shall be checked (in Condenser bushings). The porcelain portion is to be checked for any crack or chipping. The terminals should be checked for any bends. 3) Instruments: Fragile instruments like oil level gauge, temperature indicators, etc. are to be inspected for breakage or other damages.
2) Check of Impact Recorder An Impact recorder is installed if specified. The impact recorder shall be returned to the Manufacturer. Please refer the outline drawing for the locations Type of Impact X-Axis Y-Axis Z-Axis
Levels of Acceleration 2g 2g 1.5g
Any shortage, theft or damage is to be duly recorded and reported to Carrier, Underwriters and manufacturer.. 3.3.3
Standard Receiving Tests
1) Core Grounding Megger test Refer Section 5.4.4.2 The Core Frame and Tank Isolation should be verified upon receiving.
The Manufacturer shall be consulted in case the acceleration is exceeding the above limits. 3) Check of Gas Pressure/ Oil leak Inspect the dry air pressure system (if given).
5
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
====================================================================== 3.4. Storage of main unit and accessories 3.4.1 Overview In case when the transformer is not immediately commissioned, ensure below guidelines for storage: • Storage area should be adequate and should be easily accessible for inspection. • The surface on which it is to be stored is strong and leveled. • Surrounding area of storage place is not polluted and water does not accumulate in/around this area. 3.4.2
Storage of Transformer
The preferred method of storage is to store transformer under oil with all the accessories fully installed. Heaters in the control cabinet should be connected to a power supply and energized to prevent condensation. The transformer main tank may be stored in Dry air for storage till six months. Storage in oil is advised for storage above to six months. While in storage, the gas pressure, oil samples, breather condition are to be checked frequently. Wherever feasible, the transformer should be fully assembled; vacuum filled with oil and made operation ready in case of storage is exceeding six months. 3.4.3
Storage of Accessories
After receiving the accessories at site those should be inspected and kept ready for immediate erection. If erection work is not to be done immediately then those accessories should be repacked into their own crates properly and packing list should be retained. All packings should be kept above ground by suitable supports so as to allow free air flow underneath. The storage space area should be such that it is accessible for inspection, water does not collect on or around the area and handling/transport would be easy.
Also note the following points: • • • • •
• • •
Equipment meant for indoor use, such as control panels should be stored indoor All fragile material should be stored in a closed room. All openings should be blanked off with suitable blanking plates. Crate should be positioned as per markings on the crate. Do not stack crates one along the other except those for radiators. However, for radiators also maximum three crates could be stacked. Heaters for Control Cabinets, etc., shall be kept energized. Refer specific storage instructions given in respective leaflets for accessories. Those should be strictly followed. Refer Table-A for further details.
3.4.4 Storage of Oil Drums,if applicable • • •
Store drums containing oil either in a shed or covered with tarpaulin. The drums must be stored in a place free from fire and explosion hazards. Keep bungs tight. Protect the drums from weather and contact with water.
•
Drums should not be stored standing on ends.
•
Store drums horizontally with bungs at 45 deg. This will ensure that bungs are under a positive oil pressure 3.4.5 Periodic Inspection during Storage During storage period the main unit and accessories should be inspected regularly as specified in Table-A. Observations, readings and dates should be noted in separate register. In case a fault or abnormality is observed, CGL should be contacted. Check at regular intervals especially when weather changes such as heavy rains storm etc.. Carry out periodic inspection for possible external fault/ damage rusting or leakages of main unit and accessories periodically. Condition of silica-gel on oil filled unit
6
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
====================================================================== should
be
inspected
periodically.
Oil
samples and should be tested periodically.
TABLE-A Instructions for Storage of Accessories and Inspection During Storage
Sr. Accessories No. 1. All condenser bushings
Storage Storage Position Location Into their Protected from own crates Rain
Precaution
Cover with Tarpaulin
Special Instruction Refer Manual for Bushings
Inspection Checks Physical damage
2.
Porcelain bushings and Pin/Post insulation
-do-
-do-
3.
Radiators
-do-
-do-
4.
Conservator (COPS)
-do-
-do-
Into their own crates
Protected from Rain
Space heater should be connected to electric supply to be kept ON.
Space heaters ON. Should be free of dust and condensati on
-do-
-do-
5. TJ box, Marshalling box (if supplied loose) and RTCC panel
6.
OLTC Drive Mechanism (if supplied loose)
-do-
-do-
7.
Buchholz Relay, MOG, Breather, Pressure relief device, Valves, Hardware items paint, Oil operated relays, small brackets. Clamps, pipes for bleed valves and other small items.
-do-
-do-
Physical damage
All openings must be blanked off
Damage and rust Damage and rust
Refer respective Instruction Manual
7
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
====================================================================== Sr. Accessories No. 8. Pipe work
Storage Position Uncrated
Storage Location Protected from Rain
9.
Fan assembly & Pumps
-do-
-do-
10.
-do-
-do-
11.
Air insulated cable boxes/ disconnection chambers Gaskets
12.
Oil drums
In its own crate
Precaution
Special Instruction -do-
Inspection Checks Physical damage
Refer respective Instruction Manual Physical damage
Into a closed room
Store in stress free condition. Do not fold. Do not roll
Physical damage
No crates
Oil leakage Physical damage
GRA PH SH O W IN G V A RIA T IO N O F PRESSU RE V / S T EM PERA T U RE O F GA S FO R GA S FILLED U N IT D U RIN G T RA N SPO RT O R ST O RA GE
lb/ in2 0.35
Gauge Pressure – kG/CM
2
5 4.5
A2
0.3
4 3.5 3
0.25
0.2
P E R M IS S IB L E RANGE
A1
2.5 2 1.5
0.15
0.1
1 0.05 0.5 0 - 0.05
- 30
- 20
- 10
0
10
20
30
40
50
TEMPERATURE IN ° C.
E X A M P LE :
F O R 40 ° C TEMPERATURE (D E P E N D IN G U P O N THE PRESSURE OF G A S A T T H E TIM E O F F IL LIN G
---M IN IM U M P R E SS U R E O F G A S 2 C A N BE 0.18 5K G /C M A T P O IN T A 1. M AX IM U M P R E SS U R E O F G A S 2 C A N BE 0.32 KG /C M A T P O IN T A 2.
8
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
======================================================================
STORAGE OF OIL DRUMS, IF APPLICABLE
AIR RELEASE HOLE
45°
OIL DRUMS OIL FILTER HOLE
FLOOR
3.5
Safety measures during transport, handling and storage
•
Safety measures/precautions should be given the due importance during transport/ handling/ inspection/ storage. Any mishap during the process will result in delay in erection, endangering human life, endangering equipment life.
•
Ensure that the transformer is evacuated and purged with breathable air. Ensure minimum 25% oxygen level in air before allowing personnel entry. Continuously purge dry air through the tank. Follow warning and precautions stated on accessories Earth the transformer tank for the period of mounting works Before entering the tank, make sure there is air inside. Also take appropriate measures to secure air during work. When transporting or carrying the tank, use equipment corresponding to the lifting weight.
• •
•
• • • •
• •
When lifting parts, lift them leveled. Attach guide ropes so that they do not hit surrounding objects. Never leave the secondary circuit of Current Transformer open. When connecting conductive parts inside the transformer, tighten them with specified torque. Do not loosen bolts that maintain oil tightness. Do not leave tools/ screws etc inside the tank Close the inspection holes and other openings immediately after work inside the transformer finishes preventing moisture ingress.
9
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
SECTION – 4 Assembling & Installation
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
4.1
Installation equipment & tools 1)
1/2 Nos. mobile crane having a free vertical lift suitable for lifting HV bushing and lifting capacity 3 tones each.
2)
Steel/Manila/Nylon ropes and ‘D’ shackles for lifting 3 tones weight.
3)
Filter machine of capacity 6000 liters per hour or more in excellent working condition. It must be capable of heating transformer oil upto 80°C (heating should be indirect) and must be equipped with in-built high vacuum degassing chamber filter elements. The following accessories should also be provided. a) Non-collapsible hose nipples/adapters.
pipes
of
adequate
length
and
size
provided
with
Hose pipes should be of oil resistant material, natural rubber should not be used.
4)
b) 3 Nos. flanges each of sizes 25, 50 & 80 mm pipe suitably threaded for connecting the hose pipes and provided with holes for fastening on main unit valves. c) The incoming electricity supply capacity must be adequate to operate the machine with all its heaters ‘ON’. Vacuum pump of capacity 1500-2500 LPM with booster of 60-900 cub-m/hour and -3 capable of an ultimate vacuum of 1 x 10 milli-bar, along with the following accessories : a) Non-collapsible hoses with suitable flanges for connecting to main tank. b) Condenser for condensation of moisture. c) MacLeod gauge for measuring up to 10 vacuum pump.
-3
milli-bar vacuum to confirm efficiency of
5)
Storage tank for transformer oil of adequate capacity provided with 50 mm bottom draincum-filter valve and another 50 mm top valve. The tank should have an air tight inspection cover at the top and must be provided with a breather and oil level sight windows. Tank must be painted with oil resistant paint from inside and must be cleaned thoroughly before storing the oil. Capacity of the storage tank should be equal to the total oil quantity of complete unit.
6)
Tarpaulin for covering main unit during filtration.
7)
Adequate number of aluminum trays for salvaging oil leakages while connection of pipes.
8)
2 complete sets of fixed ended spanners metric sizes 4-36.
9)
2 complete sets of ring ended spanners metric sizes 4 to 36.
10) 1 complete set of Allen keys.
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
11) Set of screw drivers, centering tummies, flat ended tummies, pipe wrenches, pliers, hammers, ladders, hole punches and other tools normally required for such work. 12) 6 mm thk 3 ply nylon ropes of 15 meters length. 13) Oil test set in good working condition having 2.5 mm gauges for adjusting the sphere gap. 14) 2.5/5 kV megger, preferably motor driven and capable of reading up to 50,000 meg. ohms. 15) 500 volt megger, hand driven, capable of reading up to at least 50 meg. ohms. OR digital testers with adjustable voltage 16) 2 Nos. multimeters, preferably digital type having the following ranges : AC voltage:0 - 2.5, 0 - 25, 0 - 100, 0 - 250, & 0 - 1000 AC current:0 - 100 mA, 0 - 1A, 0 - 10A 17) Single/3 phase supply with DP ICTPN switches. 18) 2.5 mm single core copper leads (approximately 30 meters). 19) 3 litres of Surface cleaning agent.. 20) Muslin cloth and waste cloth in sufficient quantities, as may be required at site. 21) Hot air blower for drying porcelain bushings. 22) Vacuum Hose pipes for oil connections should be of oil resistant material. Natural rubber should not be used. Should withstand full vacuum. Necessary adapters for connecting to filter machine outlet; filter m/c inlet, filter valves on main unit, Buchholz relay pipe, oil filling pipe on conservator etc. 23) Instruments for checking humidity 24) Adequate length of 10 mm I/D PVC pipe suitable for vacuum with suitable adapters for connecting this pipe to std. 25 mm or 50 mm flanged valves. 25) Pulling winches/pulleys 26) Steel ropes 27) Steel plates 28) Grease 29) Wooden sleepers.
3
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
30) Hydraulic/mechanical screw jacks with locking arrangement capacity of each should be minimum 50% of the total weight of main unit with oil. 31) Power pack system to operate all the jacks simultaneously. 32) Measure tapes. 33) Level bottle/Level tube (plastic). 34) Stainless steel bottles for oil samples. 35) Dry Air generator or cylinders with regulator and pressure gauges. 36) Welding machine (for attending damages of Fabricated parts if required.) 37) Gas cylinders with nozzles. Torch for gas cutting ox Acetele (for attending damages of Fabricated parts if required.) 38) Pressure/vacuum equalization pipes and valves 39) Adapters :
80 mm to 25 mm - 3 nos. each 80 mm to 50 mm - 3 nos. each 50 mm to 25 mm - 3 nos. each
40) Valves: 25 mm flanged type with position indicators and locking devices. 50 mm flanged type with position indicators and locking devices. 41) Adapters suitable for valve and pressure gauge. 42) Bushing lifting equipments as specified in the instructions on bushings. 43) Capsule vacuum gauge range 0-50 mbar with least count of 1 mbar. 44) Tube: 5I/D transparent tube to use as oil gauge shall be capable of withstanding full vacuum.
4
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
4.2 General installation topics
center bolt may also be provided to easily turn the rollers by 900 on itself). The wheels are quite heavy. Therefore, the smaller the distance they have to be lifted, the easier the installation will be.
Although power transformers are designed and manufactured to National or International Standards, every transformer ends up being designed for a specific site, as well as for a specific electrical network. Hence they usually are of a completely unique design. For this reason, every transformer installation is a unique event as well.
• Once the wheels have been attached, use the jacks to raise the transformer just enough to remove the blocking.
People involved in the installation have to study the specific design and have to use their experience alongwith this Operation and Maintenance (O&M) manual for the installation.
• The transformer may be now rolled into position.
A well-prepared installation is the first condition to make it a successful event. Furthermore the installation of a transformer requires specialized equipment as well as services. These services may be sourced internal in your organization or may be sourced from the service department of CGL. Accurate scheduling is required in order to make efficient use of these sources. We assume in below text that the transformer is correctly positioned on its foundation according to the instructions in the previous chapter and that all necessary transformer components and accessories are available for installation. 4.3 locating transformer on a plinth The instructions below are meant as a guideline to position a transformer on plinth and its accessories safely and with a minimum of risk for damages. 4.3.1 Moving a transformer on wheels Transformers supplied with wheels can be moved in directions at right angles to the tank base. Usually these movements are executed on ground level on special tracks Assembling the wheels: • Jack up the transformer.Raise the transformer the height required just to install the rollers. Block the transformer with suitable timbers or support blocks (for safety purposes) placed near the jacking steps under the lateral skids or stiffeners. • Attach the wheels to the mounting pads located under the tank using the necessary four bolts (a
• Gently lower the transformer until it is resting on the rollers.
Moving at right angles • Place a jack under each of the jacking steps, and ensure that the surface under the jacks is solid and suitable for the weight to be lifted. Raise the transformer the height required just to clear the rollers above the ground. Block both ends of the transformer by placing suitable timbers or support blocks (for safety purposes) placed near the jacking steps under the lateral skids or stiffeners. • Unbolt each roller and turn 90deg. Bolt each roller into the new position using all available bolts. • Raise the transformer slightly, and remove the blocking. • Lower the transformer gently until it is resting on the rollers. • The transformer may now be moved in the new direction. • To remove the wheels, Follow the guidelines to assemble the wheels in opposite order. 4.3.2 Moving a transformer on steel rods A transformer is moved by "skidding" whenever lifting and moving by crane is impossible or unpractical. Transformers with a skid base are made to be skidded in directions at right angles to the tank base using steel rods. Transformers with a flat base can be moved in any direction. The estimated force to start horizontal movement is 15-20% of the weight to be moved.
5
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
Steel rods must all be the same diameter, evenly and closely spaced. Refer to the table below for the minimum required number of rods in relation to the weight being moved. • Use at least three sets of rods side by side. The rods must be of sufficient width to suit the transformer being moved. Do not use a single row or two rows of rods. • Rods are preferably iron-pipe profiles, double extra strong IPS pipe. • If rods are to be used with timbers, the timbers must be steel faced. Each set of rods must have its own set of timbers.
•
Ensure that the supporting surfaces are firm enough to support the weight of the transformer
•
Assemble the necessary tools (such as jacks, "tow and drag" winches etc...), support blocks, rods, greased turning plates or greased skids etc…, required for all events of the movement.
• Connect appropriately sized cables to the haulage eyes located near the transformer base. Only pull a transformer by the correct attachment points. Haulage eyes are mentioned on the general arrangement drawing. Utilize a spreader bar if required to limit the strain on the haulage eyes. • Raise the transformer using four hydraulic jacks. Place the rods on the steel faced timber (or on the rails in the event of using a transfer cart with embedded rails) and roll them under the transformer. The longitudinal skid members serve as stops for positioning the rollers. When all of the rollers are in place, carefully lower the transformer onto them. • Move the transformer into the next position.
Table NO.
Minimum number of rods required per set under the transformer
Remarks: • The table above assumes the use of 3 – 300 mm (3 - 12 inch) wide steel faced timbers • The table above gives the number of rods per set under the transformer. Different steps in moving a transformer on steel rods: • The first step is to prepare the route for moving the transformer: • The truck bed, the railcar deck or the transfer car bed must be jacked up and blocked so that it is level and firm.
Once the transformer is situated on its foundation: • Remove the haulage cables. • Jack the transformer to remove timbers and/or rollers from under the transformer. • Set the transformer onto its foundation. 4.4 Recommended steps for assembling & installation Below sequence is recommended during installation and energization of transformer though the steps followed depend on the situation and are different from case to case. 1. Installation and preparation of the transformer tank 2. Inspection of availability of all parts and equipment 3. Installation of main accessories:-Conservator, radiators, pipes, pumps, bushing turrets and bushings. When all metal parts have been installed the risk for damaging bushings while installing these parts is minimized.
6
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
Cable boxes Oil treatment (if necessary) Vacuum processing and initial oil filling Topping up the oil Installation of remaining accessories: fans, measurement devices, control cabinets, wiring on the transformer. When the transformer has been completely filled there is no more risk to spill any oil on electrical accessories. 9. Pre-operational tests and checks. 4.5 Installation of transformer main unit Once transformer has been located on the plinth, ground the transformer tank before proceeding for the installation of accessories. To install certain accessories, the transformer tank will have to be opened. Depending on the specific shipping or storage conditions: • Oil has to be (partially) drained and the removed oil has to be stored in dry and clean containers. • I nert gas has to be replaced with breathable dry gas. • Try to open only one manhole or hand hole at a time to prevent cross breathing of the tank (which lets in moisture) while opening a transformer. OR Open two covers and pass dry air through the transformer. • Do not open a transformer if bad weather threatens, and try not to open the tank during periods of high humidity. Temporary weather shields may be necessary as a last resort. • Besides following the above measures, always limit the exposure time of core and windings to 24 hours. This is the total allowable time the active part may be exposed to atmospheric conditions. If exposure time exceeds 24 hours, the vacuum pulling process has to be extended. 4.6 Installation of radiators Every transformer uses custom designed radiator assemblies to provide proper cooling for the specific design. The transformer might be shipped:
• completely assembled including radiators: no special installation or filling is required •when partially filled with oil: the radiators have to be filled with oil by the transformer tank one by one. Note that small amounts of oil may leak out of closed throttle valves, make sure that an oil can is placed underneath the throttle valves. Connect the radiators as soon as possible. • with an inert gas and without any oil: the radiators should be filled during the vacuum filling process of the main tank. Refer Figure 4.1 for radiator assembly. In case, there are separately mounted radiators, please refer OGA drawing to find out the location of ‘A’ frame on which radiators are to be mounted. 4.7 Installation of cooling fans If the transformer has air cooling then, cooling fans are mounted once the radiators are installed. Please note that if unit coolers are used, then the main unit does not have radiators nor any fans. There is one consolidated unit of radiator fins and fans called unit cooler. Each unit cooler has pumps to be mounted separately So, if main unit has unit coolers, then radiators, fans and pumps are not mounted but unit coolers are installed directly on the unit. In this case, please refer OGA drawing to ascertain the location of the unit coolers. Cooling fans are used where additional forced air capacities or up ratings have been specified. Their operation is automatically controlled by temperature measurement devices (manual control is possible). When the oil temperature or winding temperature reaches the temperature setting, it switches the fans on. The fan units are usually attached to the radiators, but may sometimes be mounted on brackets affixed to the main tank. We refer to the General Arrangement drawing for more details on the amount of fans used, the type and mounting positions
7
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
4.7.1 Mounting instructions 1. Unpack the fans and check them for damage. 2. Mechanically mount the fans on the radiators or on the brackets. If anti-vibration pads are used, careful stress-free mounting is required to prevent overstressing during operation. 3. Connect the fans to a temporary power supply and check for abnormal vibration. 4. Wire or plug the fans into the appropriate junction box and check for the right air flow. Correct direction of fan rotation is given with an arrow on the fan housing. 5. Remove drain plugs from the holes in the fan motors to allow condensation to escape. A typical fan mounting arrangement is shown in Figure 4.2 4.8 Installation of bushing turrets Due to shipping size restrictions, it may have been necessary to remove the bushing turrets from the transformer during transportation. These compartments are dismantled as an assembly and blind flanged. If there are CT’s in the turrets the same are to be inspected to ensure free of damage before installation of turret. For transformers shipped without oil it is important to open only a minimum number of compartments on the transformer at the same time in order to minimize exposure time of core and windings. Therefore remove blanking plates one by one and install one bushing turret at a time. 4.9 Installation of condenser bushings Condenser type bushings incorporate a capacitive voltage grading system to carefully control the electric field inside the bushing. This allows a minimum partial discharge design that is very important in many applications, especially when voltage ratings increase. Most condenser bushings are oil-filled and the internal parts are oil impregnated. Condenser bushings often incorporate a capacitive tap, where the final capacitive foil (the ground layer) is brought out through a special test tap. This test tap may be used for monitoring purposes as well as for testing the bushing. The test
tap must be directly grounded or fixed to the ground over the monitoring device Before proceeding with the installation of bushing, please keep the bushing drawing handy. Check the General Arrangement drawing to find out Which bushing type is used. Also find out how the lead connection is to be made. This is different for different bushings. The connection for draw-lead type bushing differs from that of draw-rod type of bushing. Some of the bushings may come with a corona shield that is usually manufactured from spun aluminum and is quite delicate. The shield must not be bended. The coronal shields are usually shipped separate from the bushings, in well-padded packaging. Ensure that the shield is properly attached to the bushing and all mounting bolts are tightened prior to installing the bushing. For mounting purposes, please follow the steps as listed below: 1. Unpack the bushing keeping it tilted with the top side higher than the bottom side to avoid air bubbles penetrating the insulation at the bottom. 2. Check the bushing carefully (for oil leaks as well). Check the center tube and remove the plastic sealing plugs if present. 3. Remove the outer terminal cap on the top of the bushing. 4. Clean the porcelain using clean rags. 5. If the terminals are dirty, clean them with clean, dry rags.. 6. Remove the blind flange on the transformer tank (cover), pull out the draw lead and check for damage, remove the shipping gasket and clean the gasket surface. 7. Sling the bushing at the correct angle according to Figure 4.3 9. Attach a strong cord or wire to the terminal stud and pull it through the central tube of the bushing. 10. Slowly draw the draw lead cable in the bushing while the bushing is placed into position. Fix the bushing flange into position and mount the upper terminal stud and cap (refer to the specific documentation for the bushing).
8
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
11. Tighten the top terminal arrangement and the flange bolts with the correct torque according to the specific documentation. 12. Ground the bushing for personnel safety as well as to ensure that the transformer will not be damaged due to lightning.
4.12 Installation of current transformers Turret mounted current transformers are installed along with the installation of bushings and turrets. However, for the CT details refer the Rating and Diagram Plate Drawing..
4.10 Installation of other bushings These bushings are low-voltage bushings are normally of oil – communicating type.
In case of outdoor current transformer, kindly consult appropriate drawing to understand the arrangement. 4.13
If the transformer main unit is already pre-installed with the bushing, just check the bushing physically for any damages in the transit. Otherwise, follow the same steps to mount the bushings in similar fashion. 4.11 Installation of conservator and pipes 1. Unpack all components, check them and clean all gasket surfaces. 2. Mount the conservator support(s). 3. Mount the conservator on its supports (bolts are not to be tightened at this time). 4. Mount the oil pipes on the cover, including new gaskets (bolts are not to be tightened at this time): The oil connection between tank and conservator. The oil connection between bushing turrets and the oil pipe (if any). The oil connection between the tap changer head and its conservator. 5. Mount the vertical oil pipes and their components including new gaskets (bolts are not to be tightened at this time): The oil drain valve(s) (LTC and main conservator). The pipe to the silica gel breather and the breather itself. If all components are in place, tighten the bolts on the pipe connections in the same sequence as you have mounted them. Then tighten the bolts on the conservator support(s). If the oil (vacuum) filling process cannot follow immediately, insert dry air or nitrogen (dew point < 510C) into the transformer and keep a slight positive pressure (± 0.2 bar) to prevent moisture ingress. Refer Figure 4.4 before installation of Conservator & pipes.
Wiring on the transformer
The wiring on the transformer is always completed and checked during assembly in the factory. However, the connection between transformer and remote control cabinets is only made as a temporary base for testing. During disassembly for shipment of the transformer, some parts with an electrical connection must be disconnected. This will result in free cable-ends (or free plug-ends) that can be situated on the dismantled part or on the transformer. Free cable ends will be coiled and protected by plastic bags or another protection and tied to the transformer tank or assemblies. The wires of free cable-ends are marked with the same terminal number as the terminal to which they have to be connected during the final wiring on site. Current transformer circuits have been shortcircuited before and during transportation for safety purposes. This short circuit wire has to be removed at the time of final wiring and/or testing. 4.13.1 Mounting instructions After mechanical installation of the parts that are to be electrically connected: 1. Remove the protection on the cable-end and check the wire marking with the wiring diagram. 2. Clean wire ends (and contact-pins of cable plugs, if any). 3. Fix the cable in the cable channel. 4. Introduce the cable into the cable gland. 5. Check with the wiring diagram. 6. Connect the wires to the right terminal. 7. Tighten the cable gland.
9
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
Once again, make sure that the right connection has been established. 4.14 Installation of other items
Usage: Prior to replacing a cover of an inspection opening, the gasket should be examined to make certain that it has not been damaged and that it has sufficient thickness to reseal the joint.
4.14.1 Gaskets for Liquid Filled Transformers: 4.14.2 Breather installation The gaskets used on our liquid filled transformers are flat Synthetic Resin Bonded Cork or Flat Nitrile or Nitrile ‘O’ rings. All are suitable for sealing oil, water and gases. Gaskets are of two types, retained and non retained. The retained gasket is preferred for cantilever loads and where dimensional tolerances must be held. The gasket stop assures the correct compression of the gasket, the proper dimensional positioning of the mating parts and a uniform pressure over the entire surface of the gaskets. Non-retained or flat gaskets are normally full width gaskets with the bolting holes equal distance from the edges of the gasket. Non-retained gaskets should be uniformly compressed. The recommended compression for the various gasket materials is: Synthetic Resin Bonded Cork 43% Compression, Nitrile Rubber 33% Compression Gasket Installation: The gasket surfaces must be thoroughly clean. Remove all oil grease, varnish, old gasket cement, dust and dirt by scraping surface and wiping out with a cloth wetted with a solvent. Cut the gasket to conform to the surfaces to be sealed. If the gasket is not a one piece gasket, scarf the ends of the gasket so that the length of the overlap will be equal to four times the thickness of the gasket material. The mitering should be done with a fine toothed saw and a miter box to assure a clean uniform cut and to obtain full gasket thickness at the lap joint. Dovetail joints may have been used at the factory. A special tool is required to make this joint. A scarf joint may be used if this tool is not available. ‘O’ Rings:
Breathers are dispatched loose. Assemble them as shown in Outline drawing. Check oil seal if necessary fill oil up to the level marked in oil cup. Also ensure breathing hole in oil cup is not obstructed. Check color of silica gel. Color (when dry) is BLUE, changes to PINK (with moisture) OR Color (When dry) is ORANGE, changes to COLORLESS (with moisture) 4.14.3 OTI and WTI The Bulbs of these Instruments should be fitted on thermometer pockets welded to cover or on main oil outlet pipes of tank top. Before mounting the bulbs, thermometer pockets must be cleaned from inside and transformer oil must be filled up to half depth of the pocket. Precaution should be taken so that capillary tubing is not damaged, pulled or stressed for routing and supporting the capillary tube. Oil must be filled into all thermometer/RTD pockets wherever those are specified. 4.14.4 PRD Pressure Relief Device (PRD): a) Mount PRD as per leaflet of PRD and as shown in Outline drawing. b) Check contact operation 4.14.5 Plate valves and their assemblies Radiator isolating valves are plate type. valves to tank as per Figure 4.5
Fix these
Clean the groove and then apply a very small amount of Grease at the top of the groove, before applying the ‘O’ ring.
10
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
the vacuum and calculate the leak rate as per formula given below:
4.15 Oil filling procedure i) Erection Sequence: Complete all erection work except those requiring opening of Main Unit. Radiators and Conservator mounting should be completed.
Change in pressure (millibar) Leak rate = ---------------------------------------- x Vol.ltrs. Time in seconds The leak rate observed at various points of time should not exceed the limits given below:
ii) Planning & arranging facilities: Time in Hours Make all necessary arrangements for oil filtration, evacuation, etc. so that once the bushings erection is completed, evacuation and oil filling will follow immediately. iii)
Controlling exposure:
Erect the bushings and complete the main Buscholz relay piping. Transformer exposure time should not exceed 12 hrs. It is advisable to start erection early in the morning on a day when rain is not forecast. It is good practice to inject dry air through one of the opening in order to reduce ingress of ambient air during installation. iv) Immediate evacuation: Drain oil to the level required for erection of bushings. As soon as bushing erection is complete, start evacuating the main unit. For this, it is necessary to keep the vacuum pump connected to the main unit in advance. Also, the efficiency of the vacuum pump should be checked in advance and necessary maintenance carried out before the bushing erection. Ensure Main tank and OLTC chamber are equalized prior to application of vacuum. v) Concentrate on potential leak points: There is a possibility of excess leakage of air through the various gasketted joints, through the drain plug/air release plug of radiators, the bushing air release plug and cap. vi) Ascertaining Leak rate under vacuum: Create vacuum of 70 millibar inside the tank and hold the vacuum by shutting the valve between tank and vacuum hose. Note down
-------------------
Allowable Leak Rate MBAR Liter/Sec --------------------------
After 1st hour
100
End of 3rd hour to end of 4th hr
75
End of 7th hour to end of 8th hr
50
End of 11th hour to end of 12th hr
25
If the leak rate is high, it indicates that there is excessive leakage. Then all gasketted joints should be attended to. As soon as 25 millibar-litre/second leak rate is achieved, pull vacuum further to achieve 1.3 millibar or less. vii)
Oil filling up to tank oil level gauge:
Transformer shall be filled under 1.3 mbar vacuum with purified and degassed oil through top filter valve up to tank oil level gauge. Estimate time required for oil filling to enable reduce the oil filling rate in last half hour. The oil filling rate shall be less than 6 kilolitres per hour. The temperature at the filter outlet shall be maintained below 65°C. As soon as oil level mark on tank oil gauge is reached, close top filter valve, switch off vacuum pump and break vacuum through breather by opening the valve. Refer Figure 4.6 viii)
Hot oil circulation:
Connect bottom filter valve of tank to inlet point of filter machine. Connect top filter valve of tank to outlet of vacuum filter machine and start oil circulation. The filter outlet temperature should be limited to 65°C. Continue filtration for two passes. Refer Figure 4.7
11
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
Drain out oil as quickly as possible after oil circulation, if possible, use a pump to avoid excessive drop in temperature of the transformer. ix)
Creating vacuum and maintaining:
Refer Figure 4.6 Pull vacuum 1.3 mbar or less. Maintain 1.3 millibar or less vacuum as given below : System voltage -------------------
Duration in hours ----------------------
Upto and including 145 kV
24
Above 145 kV & including 245 kV
24
Above 245 kV & including 420 kV
36
x)
Oil filling under vacuum:
Fill oil upto tank oil level gauge as described in (viii.). Measure dielectric absorption factor using 1 or 2 kV meggar and/or tan delta as given below: Resistance at 60 seconds Dielectric absorption factor = -----------------------------Resistance at 10 seconds Above value shall be at least 1.3. or Measure tan delta using 30 volts source. Tan delta shall be max. 0.5 % at 20°C. If the temperature at the time of measurement is higher than 20°C then extrapolate the value. If the above values are not within limits, repeat hot oil circulation vacuum and oil filling as above. xi)
Oil filtration :
(After oil filling operation) : Carry out oil filtration as given in (viii.) (Hot oil circulation) for two passes. Take oil sample. Check BDV and water content. Electric strength: BDV kV (Min)
Upto 145 kV (rms) Above 145 kV transformer (rms)
50 kV 60 kV
Water Content ppm (max) : Upto 72.5 kV 72.5 kV upto 145 kV Above 145 kV transformer
25 ppm 20 ppm 15 ppm
If BDV of oil sample is equal to or greater than the above value and water content is equal to or less than the above value, then the oil sample is O.K. otherwise carry out filtration for two more passes. Check again oil sample. If the oil sample is not O.K. then check if anything is wrong with filter machine. The above process cycle is for a maximum exposure of 12 hours. If the exposure is excess of 12 hours, repeat heating and vacuum cycle, if required. In any case exposure should not exceed 36 hours. xii) Oil filling in Main unit with separately mounted radiator (Refer Outline drawing): After the unit processing is complete as per procedure given above, for filling oil in coolers and main unit adopt following procedure. (Refer Figure 4.7 & Figure 4.8) a)
Keeping top & bottom valve between tank & coolers close, fill previously filtered oil at ambient temperature in each cooler bank through valves on bottom header. Precautions should be taken to open valves on radiator as well as air release plug on headers. Close air release plug after filling the oil.
b) Each bank should be filled separately. c) Immediately after filling oil, each bank should be filtered separately. For this, oil should be taken from storage tank, fed to filter machine and output of filter connected to top filter valve of cooler bank and drain out from valve on bottom header to storage bank. d) Take oil sample from each bank and check for BDV and water content. Values of BDV and water content should match as given earlier. Continue filtering for such duration, till BDV and water content are achieved.
12
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
xiii)
Air release :
Release air from cover, header, radiator, buchholz relay, cooler pipe and any other air release plug provided on Transformer after observing the standing time, given below. Ensure complete air release before applying voltage. Air release for main unit and separate cooler banks with pump: Adopt the same procedure given above but have additional air release as given below. Run the pumps in pipe work for 8 hours. Pumps in both pipe work should be run individually for 8 hours so that reverse flow blocking device should get operated. After the pump operations observe the standing time as given below. After observing the standing time, release air from cover, radiator, buchholz relay, cooler pipes, header and any other air release plug provided on transformer. Ensure complete air release before applying voltage. xiv) Standing Time: The Standing Time given below shall be strictly adhered to, after topping up oil in conservator & before aplication of voltage. Air release shall be done after observing the Standing Time. xv) Dew Point Measurement. During field installation, parts of a transformer may be subjected to exposure. Dew point measurement is one of the methods to measure the humidity inside the transformer tank. 4.16 Do’s and Don’ts during assembling and installation
2. Replace Nitrogen gas completely with air if it was filled in main unit for transport/storage. 3.
Make sure that nothing is kept inside the pockets before one enters inside main unit. Also take off the wrist watches and shoes.
4. List up all the tools and material to be taken inside and check it after coming out to make it sure that no tools is left inside. 5. There must be a protective guard for lamp to be taken inside. 6.
Keep inspection covers open for supply of fresh air, when working inside.
7. When one person is working inside, second person must be outside for emergency. 8. Use fix spanners and tie them to the wrist of the person or somewhere outside the tank. 9. Be careful during connections where bolted joints (jumper connection) are involved. So that, nuts/washers etc., are not dropped inside the tank. 10. Attach the caution tags "DO NOT OPERATE THE SWITCHES" while working on energized unit. 11. Make sure that the fire-fighting equipment are available at the oil- treatment equipment as well as work place and adjacent to the transformer. 12. Transformer tank as well as oil treatment equipment shall be connected with permanent earthing system of the station. 13. Check air cell in conservator
Strictly follow the below mentioned Do’s and Don’ts to avoid any kind of mishap, accidents and damage pertaining to goods as well as human life. 4.16.1 Do’s
14. Attend the leakages on the bushing.
1. IMP. : Insulating oil and insulation for windings and connections are inflammable. Watch for fire hazards.
16. Check the oil in transformer for di-electric strength and moisture content and take suitable action for restoring the quality.
15. Examine the bushings for dirt deposits and coats, and clean them periodically.
13
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
17. Check the oil level in oil cup and ensure air passages are free in the breather. If oil is less, make up the oil. 18. If inspection covers are opened or any gasket joint is to be tightened, then tighten the bolts evenly to avoid uneven pressure. 19. Check and clean the relay and alarm contacts. Check also their operation, and accuracy and if required change the setting. 20. Check the pointers of all gauges for their free movement. 21. Clean the oil conservator thoroughly before erecting. 22. Check the OTI and WTI pockets and replenish the oil, if required. 23. Fill the oil in the transformer at the earliest opportunity at site and follow storage instructions. 24. Check the door seals of Marshalling Box/Thermojunction Box. Change the rubber lining if required. 25. Ensure proper tightness of top terminal cap of condenser bushings to avoid rain water entry. 26. Check oil level in condenser bushing, any discrepancy should be reported to Manufacturer.
7. Do not Smoke on or near the transformer. 8. Do not use Fibrous cleaning material, as it can deteriorate oil when mixed with it. 9. Do not leave off circuit tap switch handle unlocked if any. 10. Do not use low capacity lifting jacks on transformer for jacking. 11. Do not change the settings of WTI and OTI alarm and trip frequently. The setting should be done as per the site condition. 12. Do not leave any connection loose. 13. Do not meddle with the protection circuits. 14. Do not leave Marshalling Box/Thermojunction box doors open, they must be locked. 15. Do not switch off the heater in Marshalling Box/Thermojuntion Box except to be periodically cleaned. 16. Do not leave a ladder unlocked, when the transformer is `ON' in service, in case it is provided. 17. Do not store transformer for long after reaching site. It must be erected and commissioned at the earliest.
4.16.2 Don’ts 1. Do not take any fibrous material such as cotton waste inside while repairing. 2. Do not drop any tools/materials inside. 3. Do not stand on leads/cleats. 4. Do not weld, braze or solder inside the tank. 5. Do not weld anything to tank wall from outside. 6. Do not weld anything to conservator vessel if bag is inside.
14
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
Figure 4.1 Radiator Assembly
RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
X
BRACING LUG
Y
VALVE HANDLE
TOP
BOTTOM DRAIN PLUG
VALVE HANDLE
RADIATOR MOUNTED ON PIPE WITH FLANGE
RADIATOR MOUNTED ON HEADER WITH WELDED STUD
HEX. FULL NUT SETSCREW
HEX. FULL NUT
VALVE
VALVE
WELDED STUD
GASKET
GASKET
RADIATOR
PLAIN WASHER
RADIATOR
PLAIN WASHER
DETAIL 'X'
DETAIL 'Y'
CAUTION NOTE NO.1 : RADIATOR LEAKAGE RADIATORS IF DRAGGED ON THE GROUND OR ANY OTHER SURFACE, INVARIABLY GET STRUCK SOMEWHERE CAUSING BENDING OF FINS, STRAINING WELDS, WHICH MAY LEAD TO OIL LEAKAGE. IN ORDER TO PREVENT DAMAGES OF SUCH NATURE, IT IS SUGGESTED TO HANDLE THE RADIATORS USING FORK LIFT FOR CARRYING TO THE TRANSFORMER AND RHEN RAISING IT TO THE POSITION USING
15
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
Figure 4.2 Fan Mounting Arrangement
16
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
Figure 4.3 Lifting of Bushing
Figure 4.4 Conservator & pipe assembly
17
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
Figure 4.5 Plate valve assembly
18
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
80 M.M. DIA. PLATE TYPE VALVE ASSEMBLY CAP SCREW
CAP WITH INDICATOR
PLATE TYPE VALVE 80 M.M. DIA.
GASKET
PLAIN WASHER HEX. FULL NUT
PLATE TYPE VALVE 80 M.M. DIA.
GASKET
PLATE TYPE VALVE 80 M.M. DIA.
GASKET
Figure 4.6 Oil filling arrangement
19
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
Figure 4.7 Arrangement for hot oil circulation and filteration
20
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
Figure 4.8 Vacuum arrangement
21
VACUUM PUMP
OIL STORAGE TANK
VACUUM FILTER
FILTER VALVE ON TANK
SHUT-OFF VALVE BETWEEN BUCHHOLZ RELAY AND TANK
CONSERVATOR
BOTTOM VALVE BETWEEN TANK AND COOLER
TRANSFORMER
VACUUM GAUGE
AND SEPARATELY MOUNTED COOLER BANK
ARRANGEMENT FOR OIL FILLING UNDER VACUUM OF MAIN UNIT
BOTTOM HEADER
RADIATORS
TOP HEADER
BREATHER
SEPARETELY MOUNTED COOLER BANK
TANK TOP SAMPLING VALVE
TANK AND COOLER
TOP VALVE BETWEEN
VALVE ON TOP HEADER
VALVE ON BOTTOM HEADER
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD;
POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
22
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
SECTION - 5 Pre- Commissioning Checks
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 5.1
Overview
•
Now that installation of transformer with all its accessories & fittings is complete, we need to conduct some pre-commissioning checks to ensure safe & successful energization. In case of substantial time lag between installation and commissioning of transformer, it is recommended that transformer installation be fully completed with assembling of all accessories and oil filling for Safety and Completeness. It will also allow easy check before commissioning.
•
•
Mechanical and Electrical precommissioning checks are essential to ensure entire Transformer Functionality.
•
Pre-Commissioning checks involve a thorough check of transformer and accessories as well as external checks on installation system.
•
5.2 •
• •
• •
•
General Guidelines The transformer tank, all external metal parts and accessories should be permanently grounded according to the correct safety and operation practice and in accordance with instructions for the specific equipment being used. Tank should be earthed at atleast two points. All bushings have to remain grounded until final energization of the unit (except to perform the electrical tests). All cables that are connected to the transformer should be adequately grounded. Check all the gasketed joints to ensure that there is no leakage of transformer oil at any point. Release trapped air through air release plugs and valves fitted for the purpose on various fittings likeheaders, radiators and oil communicating bushings, buchholz petcock etc. Check direction of rotation of fan blades to ensure air blast to radiators.
• • • •
5.3
Check direction of Oil pump by switching on the pump and the oil flow indicator to indicate the pump on condition. If stand-by pump provided check all the pumps. Each pump should be operated for at least 8 hours at least and subsequently the air is again released from all points. Ensure conservator is filled upto the filling oil level mark on plain oil gauge side and corresponding to the pointer reading on MOG side. Ensure that silica gel in the breather is active and color is blue and oil in the breather cup. Check that the thermometer pockets on tank cover, header, etc., are filled with oil. Oil filling is not required in case of dry type probe arrangement. CTs secondary terminals must be shorted and earthed, if not in use. Also check that the CT terminals in Marshalling Box/Thermo Junction Box are connected to WTI CT terminals, as indicated in the rating and diagram plate and open the shorting link of the terminal block. Check for tightness of all external electrical connections. Clear off extraneous materials like tools, pieces of cloths, waste, etc. Check alarm/trip contacts of all accessories, instruments flow meters, differential pressure gauges etc. In the case of water cooled transformers, the pressure gauge readings on both water and oil sides to confirm that the water pressure is less than the oil pressure. The oil and water flow should not be less than that specified. Mechanical Checks
5.3.1 Location on Foundation Locate the transformer on the plinth precisely and anchor the unit with anchoring bolts. Confirm position with Outline Drawing.
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 5.3.2 Bushings and Terminal Connectors • Check bushings for any crack or breakage of porcelain • Oil level in condenser type bushings should be up to the level marked on oil gauge on side of top cap. Also check tightness of top cap for condenser bushing • Check for the arcing horn gap on bushings, if provided • Ensure that all bushings and bushing turrets are correctly air bled. Check for leaks, especially on bolted flanges and the bushing top terminals. • Ensure that capacitive test taps on condenser type bushings are correctly grounded or connected. • Check for sufficient voltage clearances. • Confirm correct position of turrets with Outline Drawing. 5.3.3 Valves and Pipe-Work • Check that all bolted joints are correctly tightened and that there are no leaks. • Make sure that all valves (including radiator valves) are in the operation position. • Ensure that all venting openings are closed. 5.3.4. Radiators and Cooling systems • Check oil pumps, fans and their control system. Check for leaks. Observe operation for at least two hour. • Check if all condensation release plugs are removed on electrical motors. • Overcurrent motor protections. • Check and set temperature controllers. • Check the flow indicators for the correct flow direction. • Other trip and alarm functions as per specification. • Remote control function (if present). 5.3.5
Leak Test
The simplest method for testing for leaks is by gas pressure. The gas space in the unit should be pressurized at 5 PSI with dry nitrogen. The gas pressure should be monitored for a period of approximately 24
hours. A change in pressure does not necessarily indicate a leak. Any temperature increase or decrease in the transformer will result in a subsequent increase or decrease of the gas pressure in the unit. Ambient temperatures and tank pressure should be monitored for a 24 hour period. If there is a significant drop in pressure during the 24 hour period, without any accompanying significant decrease in ambient temperature, the tank must be checked for leaks. Re-pressurize the tank at 5 PSI if necessary. Using a solution of liquid soap and soft water, brush all weld and threaded joints above the oil level, all bushing gasket flanges, and all hand hold cover gaskets. Any leaks in the gas space above the liquid will be shown in the form of soap bubbles. Paint welds with chalk dust dissolved in alcohol. Apply the chalk dust below the liquid level to check for leaks of liquid from the tank. All soap solution must be rinsed off or wiped off with a clean wet rag before removing pressure. 5.4 Tests Accessories
on
Transformer
and
Refer to Rating and Diagram Plate and all other instruction plates before tests. Refer section 5.5 on instruments for electrical tests before commencing below tests. 5.4.1
Oil Sampling and Testing
Oil Sampling Oil takes up moisture readily and its condition should always be checked before use. Water and water-saturated oil are both heavier than dry oil and sink to the bottom of any container. Samples shall, therefore, be taken from the bottom. Samples should not be taken unless the oil has been allowed to settle for 24 hours
3
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== Samples from Tank: Dirt from the draw-off valve or plug should be removed. To ensure that the valve is clean, some quantity of oil should be allowed to flow into a separate container before collecting samples for testing. Samples shall be collected either in glass bottle (refer IEC 60567) or in stainless steel bottle. Oil must be taken from both top and bottom sampling valves and while drawing the sample the corresponding top oil temperature must be furnished. Test oil sample for BDV, PPM, Resistivity, Tan δ. It is a good practice to conduct DGA before commissioning to serve as a record for future. Sample from Oil Drum: The drum should first be allowed to stand with the bung vertically upwards for at least 24 hours. The area around the bung should be cleaned. A clean glass or brass tube long enough to reach to within 10 mm of the lowermost part of the drum should be inserted, keeping the uppermost end of the tube sealed with the thumb whilst doing so. Remove the thumb, thereby allowing oil to enter the bottom of the tube. Reseal the tube and withdraw an oil sample. The first two samples should be discarded. Thereafter, the samples should be released into a suitable receptacle. Sample from Diverter switch of OLTC: Oil of diverter switch should be checked for BDV at the time of commissioning and subsequently yearly or 5000 operations, whichever is earlier. Refer OLTC Manual for detailed instructions For further details on oil tests, refer section 4.14 5.4.2 Test
voltage on the low voltage side at all tap positions. Polarity and inter-phase connections are checked while measuring the ratio. This can be checked by the voltmeter method. The primary and secondary windings are connected together at one point. A low voltage three phase supply is then applied to the terminals. Voltage measurements are then taken between various pairs of terminals and vector group is verified. 5.4.3 Winding Resistance Measurement Kelvin Bridge meter or automatic winding resistance measurement kit (ohm meter, preferably 25 A kit) should be used for the measurement of resistance. Tapped winding resistance shall be measured at all tap positions. Absolute steady reading should be obtained for minimum 1 minute. Pre-commissioning values are to be compared with factory values after applying temperature correction factors. 5.4.4
Continuity Impedance Test
The continuity impedance test is meant to check the impedance and all internal connections, including the continuity of the current for the windings and all tap connections. Test to be conducted at Principal tap. Apply 3-phase 415V or preferably single phase 230V to the transformer HV side with LV side shorted. Calculate ohmic value i.e. V/I and convert to percentage impedance. Where practical, measure frequency and convert value by direct proportion.
Ratio, Polarity and Vector Group
The ratio should be checked on all taps and between all the windings and the results should tally with factory test reports as well as the rating and diagram plate details. Ratio shall be checked by applying a single phase 230-300 V supply on the high voltage side and measuring the
Test to be done for each pair of windings taken at a time for a 3 winding transformer. Compare the values with respect to precommissioning values. Any deviation beyond 1-2% needs further analysis.
4
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 5.4.3.1
Insulation Resistance Test
5.4.4.2
Core Grounding Meggar Test
The purpose of the insulation resistance test is to detect internal movement of parts that may have shorted out some of the insulation on the core and on the windings and leads, as well as to check for excessive moisture contamination. Compare values obtained with the factory test figures.
This test is used to determine the status of the core clamping structure. 2500 Volts meggar is used for this test. Insulation resistance is measured between: (i) Core to Frame (ii) Frame to Tank (iii) Core to Tank
Note:
Tested values should be more than 10 MΩ at 20 °C.
•
Insulation resistances measured without oil filling on a dry air-filled transformer are not comparable with the measured values in the factory.
5.4.4.1 Winding Insulation Meggar Test The insulation resistance between windings and between windings and earth should be measured with 5000/2500/1000 volts megger and the values should be compared to the test report values. If there is much variation, the same should be intimated to the manufacturer. IR at 600 sec The Polarization Index = --------------------IR at 60 sec should be ≥ 1.3 It is preferable to have a motor operated megger and the readings taken after one minute from starting. Prechecks: •
• •
Before measuring the insulation resistance, it should be made sure that the bushings are cleaned thoroughly with clean cotton cloth. They should also give reading of infinity before connecting up. No external lines, lightning arrestors, etc, should be in circuit. Ensure that the lead wires of the megger do not have joints.
5.4.5 Measuement of Magnetising Current A single phase low voltage supply is given to the HV winding of the 3 phase transformer and current readings of the phases are taken using low range A.C. ammeters. Reading should be recorded for future reference. 5.4.6
Magnetic Balance Tests
Apply single phase 230V supply to each phase of a star connected winding, and measure voltage induced in other phases. When centre phase is applied the other phase voltage should be 30 to 70%. When extreme phase is applied, centre phase voltage to be 50 to 95%. 5.4.7 Power Factor Measurement of Transformer Windings and Bushings (a) For Transformer windings, measurements shall be done after opening the jumpers and isolating the transformer from other equipment and the ground. (b) The test kit should be suitable to work in charged switchyard environment i.e. induction suppression unit should be provided. (c) Test modes shall be selected as below : Bushings
5
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== UST mode between HV and test tap. Windings (i) Between two windings – UST mode (ii) Between winding to Earth-GSTg mode with other winding (s) guarded.
The contacts of WTI and OTI for alarm and trip are checked and set at required temperatures depending upon ambient temperatures and loading conditions. 5.4.9
Notes • While carrying out the test, all 3 phases of the same winding are to be shorted to compensate/nullify the effect of winding reactance. • The bushing porcelain and test tap are to be properly cleaned before the commencement of test. • Pre-commissioning values are to be compared with factory values after applying temperature correction factors. • Tan Delta/ Power Factor values should be more frequently monitored if faster deterioration trend is observed. 5.4.8 Tests on Auxiliary Instruments 5.4.8.1 Oil and Gas Operated Relays (Buchholz relay) Check whether the gas operated relay is mounted as per supplier’s catalogue. Confirm that the relay does not operate when pumps are switched on in forced oil cooled transformers. Check the operation of the alarm and trip contacts to the relay independently by injecting air through the top cocks using a hand pump. The air should be released after the tests. 5.4.8.2
Magnetic Oil Level Gauge :
The float level of the oil level indicator is moved up and down between the end position to check the mechanism does not stick at any point. If the indicator has got signaling contacts, they should be checked at the same time for correct operation.
5.4.8.3
Tests on Tap Changer
The sequence of operation of the tap changers shall be checked for : (a) Manual Operation. (b) Local Electrical Operation. (c) Remote Electrical Operation. (d) Group Operation, if applicable. 5.4.10
Checking of Fans and Pumps
It shall be checked that the specified number of fans are mounted on radiators as per general arrangement drawing. IR values and settings for operation of fan motors and oil pumps are checked. Check also that the direction of rotation of fans and pumps is correct. 5.4.11
Checking of Marshalling Box
The wiring from various accessories to marshalling box shall be checked. 5.4.12
Checking of oil
The oil samples from the actual oil being used in the transformer shall be tested for oil properties and DGA analysis shall be performed. This data will be useful as a reference signature in future. 5.4.13
SFRA test
SFRA (Sweep frequency response analysis) test shall be performed and the results compared with factory test results, if any.In any case this record will be useful as a signature for future.
Temperature Indicators
6
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 5.5 Instruments used for Pre - Commissioning Test Use the instruments with valid calibration certificates for conducting the tests at site Sr. Test Measuring Instrument Required Least Count Instrument Range Accuracy No. 1) 2)
Ratio, Polarity, vector group and Magnetic balance Resistance
3)
Insulation Resistance
V-I method or Bridge Megger
4)
Excitation Current
Ammeter
0-200 mA
±0.5%
1 mA
5) 6)
Impedance Oil BDV
BDV Meter 2.5 mm gauge
0-100 kV 2.5 mm
±2% ±0.1 mm
2 kV Go - No go
7) 8)
SFRA Capacitance and tan delta
5.6
Voltmeter
0 to 500 V
±2%
5V
0-100 Ω
±2%
1 x 10 Ω
0-50,000 M Ω
±5%
5 M Ω at the lowest scale
-6
Start up Instructions
Step No.
Description
Test equipment/ Controls
Inspection/ Action
Acceptance Norms
1)
Oil
BDV tester
BDV
BDV ≥ 60 kV
2)
Air release plugs
Spanner
Release air
All air expelled
3)
Circuit breaker incoming/outgoing
Alarm/trip circuit
Verify correctness
Satisfactory operation of breaker
4)
Breathers
Visual check
Oil level in cup
At designated level
5)
Thermometer pockets
Visual check
Oil pocket
To maximum
6)
Earthing pad
Spanner size M12
Tightness
To be light at earthing terminal and the earth
7)
Heater switch in control
Visual check
Switch ON
Switch ON
8)
Incoming breaker
Remote control to close the incoming breaker
Energise from incoming side keeping lowest voltage top
No abnormal humming
9)
Outgoing breaker
Remote control to close outgoing breaker
Synchronise
Load current as per load shared
inside
7
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
SECTION - 6 Commissioning
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 6.1
Repeating Checks
Pre Commissioning
The transformer is ready for commissioning after completion of installation with all its accessories and Pre-commissioning checks and tests as per Section 5. Pre-operational tests need not be repeated if transformer is commissioned within 4 weeks of conducting Pre-commissioning checks and tests. If energisation is done 4 weeks after installation and testing, air venting and all Pre-commissioning checks and tests are to be repeated on transformer and accessories as in Section 5.
6.2.3
Trip Circuits and Contacts
Trip contacts on the transformer or its accessories immediately place the transformer out of service in case of any abnormal situation that can damage the equipment/ environment. Check breaker tripping by closing all trip contacts. Commonly used Trip contacts are: • Buchholz Relay • Oil Surge Relay • Pressure Relief Device (PRD) • Sudden Pressure Relay • Winding Temperature Indicator and Oil Temperature Indicator (WTI & OTI) .
6.2 Operational System Tests
6.2.4
Before transformer energization, some operational tests are to be performed on the system including network, protection system and remote control facilities.
Confirm settings (alarm/ trip) of Winding Temperature Indicators and Oil Temperature Indicator are as marked in the Schematic Control drawings.
6.2.1
Relay Settings
Recheck all relay settings associated with switchgear and other transformer, associated equipments in the installation system. Refer technical documents/ specifications supplied by respective vendors. 6.2.2 Alarm circuits and Contacts Alarms provide a warning for an abnormal condition on the transformer or its accessories. All alarm indications should be checked by closing alarm contacts. Following are commonly used alarms: • • • • •
Buchholz Relay Winding Temperature Indicator and Oil Temperature Indicator Oil Level Alarms Oil flow indicator. Oil Level Gauge
Temperature Settings
Temperature ≤ Values in Schematic Settings Control drawings
6.2.5 Rating of Pressure Relief Devices Confirm rating of all overpressure relief devices are as marked in drawings. 6.2.6 System Voltage, frequency & Phase Sequence Check Check incoming and outgoing system voltages, frequency and phase sequence again before energizing the transformer. 6.2.7 Oil Sampling and Checking Repeat procedure of Oil sampling and testing as in section 5 to confirm oil is as per norms before energization.
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 6.3 Transformer Energization
Post – Energization Checks
If the ambient temperature is < -20°C, special precautions should be taken before energization. Refer IEEE Std C57.12.00.
After energization, conduct a general surveillance of transformer and other substation equipments for any abnormalities such as :
6.3.1
Minimum Settling Time after Final Oil Filling
The transformer oil should be stabilized after final oil filling i.e, allowed to stand for atleast 24 hours. Release air from all venting points before energization. Transformer with forced oil circulation using pumps Have the pumps run for at least 2 hours and wait for: • minimum 8 hours if high voltage _ 245 kV • minimum 24 hours if high voltage > 245 kV Transformers without forced oil circulation using pumps Wait for : • minimum 16 hours if high voltage _ 245 kV • minimum 48 hours if high voltage > 245 kV 6.3.2
First Energization on No-Load
The transformer is first energized under noload condition. Set the tap changer to obtain correct voltage ratio. Ensure drive mechanism of no-load tap changer is locked to prevent mal operation under voltage. After energization, check the secondary and no-load current. A noise-peak mayl be heard immediately after energization. It shall subside within an hour.
• • • •
• •
• •
Abnormal noise/ humming/ vibration from transformer or accessories Monitor temperature of oil, recording to be taken at regular time intervals (every hour) until stabilization Monitor temperature of winding hot spots, recording to be taken at regular time intervals (every hour) until stabilization Monitor ambient temperature Operate and check performance of LTC through all positions within rated voltages (if applicable) Operate and check performance of cooling pumps and fans (if applicable) Check Oil leaks
After few hours of no-load energization, switch of the transformer and • Check Buchholz relay for air/ gas collection • Abnormalities noted above to be investigated and corrected. Transformer can now be re-energized and loaded gradually. 6.3.3 •
•
•
Loading the Transformer
Set the tap-changer at right tap position and check secondary voltage. If an Automatic Voltage Regulator (AVR) is provided, the tap changer will automatically run to the right tap position. In case of parallel operation, ensure voltage ratio and voltages match at all taps, principal and extreme tap impedances match, vector groups and phase sequence on all transformers is the same. Close incoming breaker and gradually raise the load on the transformer.
3
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== Post – Loading Checks •
•
• • •
Note transformer voltages and load currents, ambient temperature, oil levels. Record temperature of oil and winding hot spots at regular time intervals until stabilization. Also note loading. Monitor condition of accessories like breather, fans, pumps, bushings etc It is recommended to collect oil for DGA 24 hours after loading. In case of parallel operation, current should be carefully monitored between both units to make sure that one unit is not carrying a larger portion of the load under parallel operation. The units should be monitored for an additional period of at least one week to make sure that there is no abnormal temperature rise on either.
4
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
SECTION - 7
Maintenance
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 7.1
Introduction
If a transformer is to give long and troublefree service it should receive a reasonable amount of attention and maintenance. A rigid system of inspection and preventive maintenance ensures long life, trouble free service and low maintenance cost. Maintenance consists of regular inspection, testing and reconditioning where necessary. The principal objective of maintenance is to maintain the insulation in good condition. Moisture, dirt and excessive heat are the main causes of insulation deterioration and avoidance of these will in general keep the insulation in good condition.
•
•
•
• 7.2
Safety During Maintenance •
Maintenance activity is to be undertaken on the transformer following all safety precautions and under supervision. • Follow below safety measures: • Always ensure transformer is grounded during inspections. • The transformer is disconnected and isolated from both incoming and outgoing ends. Connect discharge rods on transformer terminals to remove static and induced charges and earth the same. • Confirm that all possible “remote” operations have been changed to “Manual mode”. • Place locks/ warning cards stating breakers should not be operated during inspection period. • Disconnect supply to control cabinet. • Before entering the tank, ensure air is present inside. Also make arrangements for ventilation while working inside. Use dry air circulation and oxygen meter. • Use only explosion proof lamp-s inside the tank and verify insulation condition of electrical cord. • Do not allow persons to get close to the bushings in air while power is on. This can cause an electric shock. Before getting close to the bushing in air,
•
•
•
•
•
disconnect transformer from both ends, discharge the line terminals and earth the terminals. Do not remove the cap of bushing test terminal or cover of voltage measuring terminal. This may cause an electric shock or deteriorate the performance of moisture-proof seal. In case of accident inside the transformer, do not get close to the transformer. Do not climb the transformer under energized condition or immediately after shutdown. High temperature sections can prove hazardous. Do not leave open the secondary circuit of the current transformer. Do not use fire around the transformer or insulating oil as this can cause fire/ explosion due to insulating oil or decomposed gas leaks. Before inserting manual handle into the manual shaft of motor-driven mechanism, change operation mode to local from remote. Do not touch movable section (main driving axle, gear etc) in the motor driven operating mechanism when power is on. Do not touch circuit sections inside marshalling box when power is on. Keep the marshalling box doors closed when transformer is in operation. Do not touch cooling fans even when they are not rotating. They may start rotating from an internal signal without warning. Do not operate any valves when the transformer is in operation. It may prevent free flow of oil and consequently raise oil temperature. Do not stop all coolers when the transformer is in operation.
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 7.3 Periodic Inspection during Service
and
Checks
Transformer Logbooks: It is recommended to record readings and observations during inspections in a logbook. This serves as reference for planning future maintenance activity and investigation during breakdown. Unusual Service Conditions: If a transformer is relocated to another site from its initial installation location with a different environment and different system configuration (like in parallel), The original parameters like temperature rise, loading limit etc may not be met. The permissible performance characteristics should be reworked. 7.3.1
External Cleaning
time, the transformer valves should be sealed with gaskets and covered with suitable plates. This also applies to the radiator-cooler openings. All breathers and small openings in pressure relief valves (and pressure vacuum bleeders on sealed tank system and inert gas system units) must be kept clean and in operating condition. All ground buses and wiring leads to ground must be kept in good condition. Proper relay operation depends on low ground resistance. Ground resistance must be measured annually. 7.3.2 •
Use an oil solvent to thoroughly remove all oil that appears on the outside of the tank or on the gaskets. This oil, later showing up on the painted surface, often gives the false impression of a leak. The bushing porcelains must be kept free from dust and dirt and have to be inspected at least once a year. Abnormal conditions such as sandstorms, salt deposits, dust, or chemical fumes require regular cleaning to avoid accumulations to the external surface. Accepted methods of hot line washing or cleaning with solvents may be used. Keep the heat radiating surfaces of the transformer clean. External surfaces of forced oil heat exchangers should be periodically cleaned as a particular dusty location may dictate. Transformers near the seacoast or in corrosive atmosphere areas should be painted regularly to prevent corroding or rusting of metal parts. If it becomes necessary to remove a radiator or air cooled oil cooler, first close the valves, top and bottom, and bolt them in the closed position. Next, drain the oil from the radiator by removing the drain plug from the bottom header and the vent plug from the top. After draining the oil, remove the radiator. If the radiator/cooler is removed for any length of
•
•
Transformer Body
Leaks & Painting: The transformer tank and other parts should be inspected periodically for any rust or and oil leak. Rusted portions, if any, should be cleaned thoroughly and repainted with proper paints. Transformer should be completely painted at proper intervals. If any leak is found, it should be investigated. If it is due to defective welding, the same should be rectified after consulting the manufacturer. Leaking joints can be rectified by tightening the bolts to the correct pressure or by replacing the gaskets. Refer Table 7.1 and Table 7.2 for maximum recommended torque are given here on the basis of the material properties. Groundings: Check the transformer grounding connections and all groundings of accessories. Valves: In case leakage is detected on the driving shaft, re-tighten the compression gland. Use only graphitefree sealing material when changing packings.
3
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== Table 7.1 : Maximum recommended Torque for Bolts marked 4.8 on the head
Bolt size
Unplated Torque N-m
Zn Plated Galvanised
20
25
M12
36
40
M16
90
110
M20
175
210
M24
300
360
M30
600
720
M36
1050
1260
Table 7.2 : Maximum recommended Torque for Bolts marked 8.8 or higher on the head or of Stainless Steel Unplated Torque N-m
Zn Plated Galvanised Torque N-m
M10
35
40
M12
60
70
M16
145
170
M20
280
340
M24
490
590
M30
970
1160
M36
1700
2040
7.3.3 •
•
Bolt size
Torque N-m
M10
Bolt size
Recommended Torques for bolts/studs only for gasketed joints
Gaskets
Gaskets sometimes shrink during service. It is, therefore, necessary to check the tightness of all bolts fastening gasketed joints. The bolts should be tightened evenly round the joints to avoid uneven pressure. Leaking gaskets should be immediately replaced.
7.3.4
Unplated Torque N-m
M10
20
M12
30
M16
50
M20
70
M24
100
Oil
Oil Level and Quantity The oil level should be checked at frequent intervals and any excessive leakage of oil investigated. There may be slight loss of oil by evaporation; this need cause no concern if the tank is topped up at regular intervals. Oil for topping up should comply with IS 335 / IEC60296. New insulating oils and preferably oil from the same source as the original oil should be used. All leaks should be repaired as quickly as possible so as to avoid possible trouble caused by low oil level. Oil Inspection Samples of the oil should be taken at regular intervals preferably yearly and tested for DGA and other oil parameters If oil fails to meet standards, it should be reconditioned by suitable means i.e, filtration or the oil be changed. Note: Vacuum filtration only improves BDV, moisture content and dust/dirt/suspended materials etc from oil. This process does not improve any other parameters of oil.
4
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 7.3.5 •
•
The bushings should be inspected for any cracks or chippings of the porcelain at regular intervals and kept free from dust and dirt. In location where special and abnormal conditions prevail, such as sand storm, salt deposits, cement dust, oil fumes etc., bushings should be cleaned at more frequent intervals. Oil level in oil filled bushings should be checked periodically.
7.3.6 Gauge •
•
•
Bushings
Conservator and Magnetic Oil
Conservators are so arranged that the lower part acts as a sump in which any impurities entering the conservator will collect. A valve/plug is fitted at the lowest point of the conservator for draining and sampling. The inside of the conservator should be cleaned every two to three years. A removable end is generally provided for this purpose. The oil level indicator should be kept clean. Generally the oil level is visible through a transparent material. In case of breakage immediate replacement is essential. When conservator is stripped for cleaning, the mechanism of the oil gauge should be cleaned.
7.3.7
Tap Changer
General guidelines given below. Refer manufacturer’s catalogue for further details.
•
Do not allow dirt to accumulate between contact rings of notching controller. Do not use oil/ grease on contacts rings on notching controller. Check the operation of anticondensation heater If the contacts of contactors are silver faced, no touching up be ever done, if any is worn out, it should be replaced. Copper contacts may be lightly touched up with a file when they become rough. The pole faces of electromagnet must be kept clean. Do not oil/grease the contact surface of radial multi-contact switches, unless a special contact lubricant is used. The space between the rings should be cleaned occasionally. If necessary, a few drops of Benzene be used. • Selector Switch: The contacts do not make/break current. As such, the wear is only due to mechanical movement of moving contacts. These may be inspected once in 2/3 years. 7.3.7.2
No-Load Tap Changer
Perform switching operation on each tap and repeat 10 cycles. This is to be done atleast twice in a year. 7.3.8 •
7.3.7.1 On-Load Tap Changer •
Motor Driving Mechanism
Diverter Switch: The maintenance primarily consists of servicing of diverter switch contacts, checking the oil level in the diverter switch chamber, and replacement of diverter switch oil when the same becomes unsuitable for further service. •
Dehydrating Breather
Silicagel is blue in color in its active stage but gradually turns pale pink as it becomes saturated with moisture. The gel should then be replaced or reactivated. The saturated gel can be regenerated by heating up to 110-130°C for 8 to 10 hours or 150-200°C for two to three hours and can be used again. The frequency of inspection depends upon local climatic and operating conditions. The level in the oil seal must be maintained at the level marked in the cup.
5
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== •
7.3.9
Cooling System
Radiators: Maintenance includes replacing damaged elements, cleaning the outer surface to remove settled dust, cleaning inner surface by oil flushing for removing sludge and repainting if required.
•
Fans • Fan blades are cleaned to remove dust; bearings of the fan motors should be lubricated occasionally. • During extended periods of reduced transformer loading, the fans tend to remain non-operational. Operate the fans on a periodic basis (biweekly for 1 hour) to ensure satisfactory operation.
•
Unit Coolers and Heat Exchangers: Refer manufacturer’s catalogue. 7.3.10 •
• •
Temperature Indicators
The level of oil in the pockets holding thermometer bulbs should be checked and the oil replenished, if required. The capillary tubing should be fastened down again if it has become loose. Dial glasses should be kept clear and if broken, replaced. Recalibrate with standard thermometer immersed in hot oil bath if readings are found to be incorrect.
7.3.11 External equipment
circuits
and
control
•
alarm contacts, thermometer contacts, etc. Check the heaters in the control cabinets. Also check temperature settings. These settings can be lower than the ones indicated on the schematic diagrams but never higher. Evidence of water or liquids in control cabinets and in air-filled cable boxes.
7.3.12
Buchholz Relay
Routine operation and mechanical inspection tests should be carried out at one and two yearly intervals respectively. During operation if gas is found to be collecting and giving alarm, the gas should be tested and analysed to find out the nature of fault. The internal faults can be identified to a great extent by chemical analysis of collected gas. 7.3.13
Explosion Vent
The diaphragm, which is fitted at the open end of the vent should be inspected at frequent intervals and replaced, if damaged. Failure to replace the diaphragm quickly may allow the ingress of moisture which will contaminate the oil. If the diaphragm has broken because of a fault in the transformer an inspection must be carried out to determine the nature and cause of the fault.
Check: • Control circuit voltage. • Excess heating of parts - evidence by discoloration of metal parts, charred insulation, or odor. If connections appear to be blackened or corroded, the same can be cleaned or replaced. • Freedom of moving parts (binding or sticking is not allowed). • Excessive noise in relay coils. • Excessive arcing in opening circuits. • Proper functioning of timing devices, sequencing of devices, relief device
6
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 7.4 Preventive Maintenance Inspection Chart Sr. Periodicity No. 1)
--
Item/Area
Maintenance Required
Porcelain insulator such as bushing, lightning arrester, supporting insulator
Cleaning should be done periodically. Interval depends on actual condition at site
Special Tools --
2)
5 Yearly
Radiator
Oil flushing inside
Oil filter machine
3)
5 Yearly
Paint
Repainting
--
4)
10 Yearly
Gasket
Change
--
5)
5 Yearly
Conservator
Cleaning
--
6)
Yearly
Buchholz relay
Operation and mechanical inspection tests
7)
Yearly
On Load Tap changer
As per supplier’s catalogue
8)
--
Condenser Bushings
Test set
Consumables Required Water
Warning Safety arrangement for hot line washing
Transformer oil
--
Emery Paper
--
--
Transformer oil
Caution --
-Outermost coat is Polyurethane
Gaskets in contact with oil are Nitrile based
Use teflon for plugs
No welding allowed on tank
Take care of COPS bag
--
--
--
As per catalogue
7
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
SECTION – 8 Trouble shooting
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 8.1 Indication signals of malfunction or abnormality A structured and objective oriented trouble shooting is required when a transformer is tripped on some protective relay or when routine electrical tests shows some deviation. Below table shows major indication signals of malfunction. Location
Signal
1)
Main Tank Buchholz Relay
Alarm/Trip
2)
OLTC Buchholz Relay
Alarm/Trip
3)
WTI
Alarm/Trip
4)
OTI
Alarm/Trip
5) 6)
MOG PRD/Diaphragm
Alarm/Trip Tripped/Operated
7)
Overcurrent Relay
Trip
8)
Differential Relay
Trip
9)
Earth Fault Relay
Trip
10)
Whether there is gas collection in buchholz relay of transformer. If yes, colour of gas. Quantity of the gas in 3 cm Test results of Buchholz Relay Gas
Yes/No
Whether there is gas collection in the OLTC Buchholz relay If yes, colour of gas. 3 Quantity of the gas in cm Test results of OLTC Buchholz gas
Yes/No
11)
Colourless/Dark Inflammable/Non-inflammable, its nature and composition.
Colourless/Dark Inflammable/Non-inflammable
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 8.2
Trouble shooting chart
8.2.1
Having received some indication of abnormality in functioning of transformer, detailed trouble shooting steps are requisite for the fault diagnosis. Symptom Differential relay and Buchholz relay or pressure relief device operate simultaneously Buchholz relay and pressure relief device operate simultaneously Only differential relay operates
Over-current, ground arrestor and other relays operate
Abnormal operation in the system or other recording device
The table below depicts the flowchart of trouble shooting procedures.
Possible Cause
Item to be checked
Shut down of the transformer
Only Buchholz relay (trip) operates
Only Buchholz relay (alarm) operates
Trouble shooting flow
Internal fault in the transformer
Electrical tests and DGA
Excessive inrush current when the transformer is energized Faulty operation of relay or device
Threshold values of relays Level of inrush current
Trapped air or build up of gas
Gas analysis Any sudden drop in oil temperature Choking in breather If heavy current is flowing through the windings Whether OLTC is interrupting heavy short-circuit current The duration and value of short-circuit current
External fault such as system short-circuit
Wiring continuity and condition Contacts Oil-stop valve position between tank and conservator
3
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== Symptom Buchholz relay and pressure relief device operate simultaneously
Possible Cause Shut down of the transformer and the tap changer
Operation of incomplete tap changing relay Either Buchholz relay or pressure relief device operates
Incorrect stopping positions because of incomplete tap changing of out-of-step tap positions
Shutdown of the transformer and the tap changer
Drive motor not operating
Drive motor operates but incomplete tap changing takes place Excessive drive torque
High oil level of OLTC conservator
Item to be checked
Electrical tests, including measurement of insulation resistance, voltage ratio, exciting current, and winding resistance Gas analysis Operation of relays Any external short circuits Faulty Faulty diverter operation Whether trip due to simultaneous start of switch of relay or both pumps device Faulty divertor switch Simultaneous start of pumps
Oil leakage from main tank to OLTC compartment Faulty operation of oil level auge
Integrity of all circuits and contacts Malfunctioning of pressure relief device Operation of any circuit breakers Incorrect voltages Motors, pilot switches and relays Control circuit Closing and opening positions of switch contacts Time setting for relay
Tap position where excessive torque occurs Torque value when using the manual crack handle on the drive mechanism and the number of times the handle must be turned Oil level of main tank and OLTC and oil temperature Operation of oil level gauge
4
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 8.2.2
Trouble shooting flow chart for abnormal level of fault gases.
Possible Cause
Item to be Checked
Local overheating of oil and insulating materials
1)
2) 3)
4)
Partial discharge and arcing Deterioration caused by aging Oil leakage between OLTC compartment and main tank
Perform the gas dissolved gas analysis. In particular, reaffirm that there are combustible gases detected by repeating the analysis. Also perform consecutive analysis at regular intervals to monitor changes in combustible gas concentration. Check the condition of the load being placed on the transformer. There should be no overloading, over excitation or irregularity in the oil temperature. Check that the transformer has suffered no system faults, such as external short circuits, ground lightning strikes, or operation of protective relays. Check the condition of ancillary equipment for the transformer, such as overheating of oil pumps. In the case of pump, check the motor current.
Check that the oil level of the divertor switch compartment is correct for the oil temperature. 2) Drain oil from the divertor switch compartment, and check the insulating cylinder, and gasketed joints for leakage. External facts (caused by Check the history for the tank, such as whether it was welded welding and use of recently. Date of oil replacement, etc. contaminated oil for example)
8.3
1)
Trouble shooting process Having followed the trouble shooting steps and having identified the fault, the actual flow of activities is as shown in the next page
5
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
TRANSFORMER TRIPPED MALFUNCTIONED UNFIT FOR USE
ROUTINE TESTS SHOW DEVIATION FROM PAST BENCHMARKS
ANALYSIS OF DATA
SELECTED TESTS
MONITOR FAILURE INDICATION DATA COLLECTION
NO
YES PROBLEM
YES
RETURN TO SERVICE
NO DAMAGE IS OBVIOUS
TESTING SELECTED TESTS
YES REPAIR FOCUSSED TESTS ANALYSE TEST RESULTS
TESTING
SCRAP INTERNAL INSPECTION ANALYSIS
FIELD REPAIR
NO
FACTORY REPAIR
YES PROBLEM FOUND YES
YES
PERFORM CORRECTIVE ACTION
NO
NO
FURTHER TESTING
DISASSEMBLY ANALYSIS
6
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
=============================================================== 8.4
Emergency response for unexpected events In case of any emergency concerning potential threat to human life and/or towards loss or damage to assets and properties, following steps are to be followed. 1) Do not panic. 2) De-energize the transformer. 3) Trip the circuit breaker to trip the transformer from line. 4) Switch on the fire fighting system in case any fire is detected. Also keep all fire fighting equipments ready and call fire fighting personnel. 5) Do not go near the transformer or touch any parts until authorized service personnel do not arrive.
8.5
Energizing transformer after fault. Follow all the steps that are followed during pre-operational checks and energizing of transformer.
7
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
SECTION - 9 End of life disposal
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
===============================================================
9.1
Planning for disposal
9.3
Environmental safety
When the transformer has reached the end of its useful life, it is important to ensure that it is disposed of activity is done in a safe and secure way without damage to environment. Once the decision is reached to scrap the transformer, the following steps may be followed.
9.3.1
The oil from the transformer is removed in a safe way and stored in containers for reprocessing. Ensure that there is no spillage of oil into the environment or water drainage systems.
9.3.2
The core laminations and the copper windings shall be separated out carefully for further processing/scrapping.
9.3.3
The insulation components are soaked in transformer oil and are potentially inflammable. Hence they should be incinerated in controlled conditions, avoiding leakage of hazardous fumes to the atmosphere.
9.3.4
Particular attention shall be paid while handling transformers contaminated with PCB if any. Agencies having experience in disposal of PCB in line with the local protocols should be contacted.
Important: Since these events may occur many years after the writing of this manual, it is important for the user to consult latest the safety and regulatory requirements at the time of disposal. 9.1.1
Assessment of physical condition, to decide the location and method of dismantling.
9.1.2
Identifying major materials which can be separated out and the cost/benefit of the operation.
9.2
Human safety
9.2.1
Ensure that the persons are equipped with all the tools and protective equipments to safeguard them from injury during the dismantling process
9.2.2
The dismantling operation shall be carried out in a location which is approved by the local authorities
9.2.3
Ensure that the persons are well aware of the general construction of the transformer components, to avoid injuries due to heavy objects and sharp edges.
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
10.1 Transformer Details Sl. No.
Description
Details
1)
Transformer type
POWER
2)
Applicable standard
IEC 60076
3)
Rating (MVA)
80 MVA
4)
Voltage ratio (kV)
220 / 13.8 / 6.9 kV
5)
No of phases / frequency
3 ph / 50 Hz
6)
Vector group
YNyn0d1
7)
Type of cooling
ONAN / ONAF
8)
Tapping details
+10% to -10% in steps of 0.625%
1
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
10.2 List of Approved Drawings
Sl. No.
Description
Drawing No.
1)
Outline and General arrangement
T61B010412F
2)
Foundation detail
T63B062422Q
3)
Transport Outline
T64B082421Q
4)
Rating and Diagram plate
T62B080933H
5)
245kV/1600A RIP Bushing (HV)
2751377 - 10
6)
73kV/2000A Oil Communating Bushing (HVN)
2751362 – BBBr1
7)
24kV/3150A Bushing (LV & LVN)
H - 0385
8)
24kV/5000A Bushing (TV)
H - 0382
9)
Valve Location Plate
T62B082423Q
10)
Schematic Wiring Diagram of Transformer Cooler Control
T30B110412E
11)
LV Cable Box
T60B082424Q
2
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
10.3
List of Reference Drawings
Sl.No.
Description
Drawing No.
1.
Buchholz Relay Pipe Work
T57B086189Q
2.
List of Fittings
T62B088768Q
3.
Tag Identification Drawing
T57B086192F
4.
Pipe Work Assembly
T57B086187F
5.
Safety Hand railing
T57B086214H
3
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
10.4 List of Brochures 1)
Operating Instruction for OLTC MR GERMANY
Leaflet
2)
Installation and Maintenance Instructions of Temperature Indicators (WTI/OTI) perfect control make.
Leaflet
3)
Transformer Temperature Indicator (WTI/OTI)
Leaflet
4)
Tech. Specification on Temperature Detector (RTD System) Perfect Control Make.
Leaflet
5)
Pressure Equalizing Between OLTC & tank
T005-0497
6)
Plate Valve Assembly
T010-0497
7)
Gas and Oil Actuated Relay
T016-0497
8)
Silica gel Breather
T020-0799
9)
Magnetic oil level gauge
T025-0497
10)
Gas Collecting Device
T029-0897
11)
Constant Oil Pressure System (COPS) Conservator
T034-0201
12)
Long Term Storage of Gas Filled Main Unit & Accessories
T035-0998
4
Smart Monitor Operation and Maintenance Manual www.siemens.com.br/energia/tlm
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Índice 1
GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................................. 1-1 1.1 INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................1-1 1.1.1 Data processing structure .......................................................................................... 1-1 1.1.2 Monitored Variables ...................................................................................................1-3 1.1.3 Storage strategy ......................................................................................................... 1-4 1.2 MODELS AND CORE MODULE..................................................................................................... 1-6
2
WEB PAGE .................................................................................................. 2-1 2.1 GENERAL SCREENS ...................................................................................................................2-1 2.1.1 Login ...........................................................................................................................2-1 2.1.2 Home........................................................................................................................... 2-2 2.1.3 General Functions ...................................................................................................... 2-3 2.2 EQUIPMENT MENU ................................................................................................................... 2-4 2.2.1 Equipment selection...................................................................................................2-4 2.2.2 Main variables.............................................................................................................2-5 2.2.3 All variables.................................................................................................................2-6 2.2.4 Charts ........................................................................................................................2-10 2.2.5 Duval’s triangle .........................................................................................................2-13 2.2.6 Diagnostics................................................................................................................2-14 2.2.7 System Events...........................................................................................................2-17 2.2.8 Notes .........................................................................................................................2-22 2.2.9 Maintenance .............................................................................................................2-22 2.2.10 Maintenance - History ..............................................................................................2-24 2.2.11 Parameters ................................................................................................................2-24 2.3 E VENTS MENU .......................................................................................................................2-30 2.4 CONFIGURATION MENU ..........................................................................................................2-31 2.4.1 User ...........................................................................................................................2-31 2.4.2 Change Password .....................................................................................................2-33 2.4.3 Status ........................................................................................................................2-34 2.4.4 Loaded modules .......................................................................................................2-34
3
SENSORS .................................................................................................... 3-1 3.1 TEMPERATURES ........................................................................................................................ 3-1 3.1.1 Pt100 (ambient temperature).................................................................................... 3-1 3.1.1.1 Technical data............................................................................................................. 3-1 3.1.1.2 General procedures and maintenance ......................................................................3-1 3.1.2 Pt100 (oil temperatures) ............................................................................................3-1 3.1.2.1 Technical data............................................................................................................. 3-2 3.1.2.2 General procedures and maintenance ......................................................................3-2 3.2 LOAD CURRENT........................................................................................................................ 3-2 3.2.1 SIMEAS T .....................................................................................................................3-2 3.2.1.1 Technical data............................................................................................................. 3-3 3.2.1.2 General procedures and maintenance ......................................................................3-3 3.3 COOLING GROUP CURRENT ........................................................................................................ 3-4 3.3.1 MCR-SL-S .....................................................................................................................3-4 3.3.1.1 Technical data............................................................................................................. 3-4 3.3.1.2 General procedures and maintenance ......................................................................3-4
4
HARDWARE ................................................................................................ 4-1 4.1 IM151-8 PN/DP CPU INTERFACE ............................................................................................. 4-1 4.1.1 Technical Data ............................................................................................................4-3 4.2 ET200S I/O SYSTEM ............................................................................................................... 4-3
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
I
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
4.3 SIMATIC MICROBOX IPC ......................................................................................................... 4-3 4.3.1 Technical Data ............................................................................................................4-5 4.3.2 Basic software ............................................................................................................. 4-5
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
II
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Important Information Safety Notices Security warnings in general are disposed prominently by the text and may or may not be preceded by markings, depending on its level of criticality. Indicates critical point in the installation and / or system configuration. Do not install or operate the equipment without first carefully reading the operating manual. Updated Information Updated information about the product is found or can be requested via: Internet – http://www.siemens.com.br/energia/tlm Fax: +55 11 4585-1278 Smart Monitor customer support: Email:
[email protected] Phone: +55 11 4585-1100 About the manual This manual describes the Smart Monitor and all its functions. The availability of the functions described is linked to the presence of appropriate sensors and the project itself. Product disclaimer: The customer expressly understands and agrees that Siemens and its subsidiaries, affiliates, directors, employees, gents, partners and licensors shall not be liable for any direct, indirect, incidental, special, consequential or exemplary damages, including but not limited to, lost profits, goodwill, use, data or other intangible losses (even if Siemens has been advised the possibility of such damages), resulting from: (i) the use or misuse of the Smart Monitor system, (ii) the cost the acquisition or replacement of goods and services resulting from any goods, data, information and services obtained or transactions resulting from the use of the system, (iii) the failure or damage of any transformers their property, or (iv) any problem with the Smart Monitor system. The liability of Siemens and its subsidiaries, affiliates, directors, employees, agents, partners and licensed for any direct damage caused by its proven guilty will be limited to 10% (ten percent) of contract value.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
1
General Description 1-1
General Description 1.1 Introduction Smart Monitor expert system primarily aims to aid the user with the registration and assessment of relevant data pertaining to early detection of incipient fault formation inside the transformer. The system helps prevent major and catastrophic failures by providing vital lead time in order to plan Smart Monitor recommended actions or even, at its extreme, transformer replacement, at a minimum overall cost which can include system disturbance cost, energy not served cost, failure cost, etc.
1.1.1 Data processing structure Smart Monitor is a transformer expert system, based on multiple engineering models (mathematical formulations to assess transformers physical parameters) which are implemented using the logic structure for data flow and analysis illustrated in Figure 1-1.
Figure 1-1 – Generic structure of data processing. According to Figure 1-1, the data flow process is:
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
General Description 1-2
Phase 1 – Data input On-line data incorporated into Smart Monitor database and integrated with off-line values previously configured on the system (transformer profile, parameters, limits, etc.). Phase 2 – Calculation The data is processed by the engineering models applicable to the specific monitored variables. For more details about all available models on the system go to item 1.2. Phase 3 – Data Assessment Objective data analysis performed based on acquired data processed by the engineering models in order to assess possible deviations from normality and to determine the significance of such deviations. Smart Monitor also correlates the present value of a given variable (or acquired parameter) to its historical behavior which is duly stored into the database. Phase 4 – Diagnostic In case a deviation is detected and a significant level of importance is also attributed to the parameter by Smart Monitor expert knowledge, then the user is notified of such an occurrence. Before sending an alarm message, however, Smart Monitor implements a historical investigation of all possible correlated variables which could influence the observed deviation and also makes that correlation available to the customer. Phase 5 – Recommendation On detecting an incipient disturbance or deviation from normality and its relative importance, Smart Monitor also generates a set of recommendations (e.g. on detecting a high rate of rise of combustible gas formation inside the transformer main tank Smart Monitor immediately recommends confirmation through a complete off-line Dissolved Gas Analysis to be carried out by the customer), particularly with respect to maintenance and operation criteria, to mitigate the problem. Phase 6 – Prognostic Smart Monitor notifies the user about the implications of keeping the current operation conditions, particularly on keeping the faulty variable at the current level or rate of increase. Phase 7 – Trend When applicable, the statistical behavior of variables is compared to their acceptable limits. The system then informs possible trends which will lead to future alarms in case the current conditions are retained`.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
General Description 1-3
1.1.2 Monitored Variables This section describes the individual values monitored by the Smart Monitor, expert system and their significance in gaining in-depth knowledge about the transformer operating conditions. The sensors or IED’s required for each of them are optional. The software is configured to include them and the respective engineering models. Dissolved gas in oil The main sources of dissolved gases in the transformer oil are thermal and electric in nature and generally relate to a minimum level of disturbance. Usually, fault gases are associated to continuous gas generation (relative increase) and to certain absolute levels that are indicative of a problem. Results are confirmed by laboratory investigations. Moisture in oil Excess of moisture in oil leads to accelerated ageing of the isolation materials, reducing their isolation capability. Usually, the mechanical resistance of the isolation is reduced as its water content increases. Also, the thermal deterioration rate is proportional to the water content. It has been demonstrated that the water contained in the paper may escape under the form of steam bubbles. These bubbles may move with the oil flow, or get trapped inside the windings, in both cases breaking the isolation. Temperatures (ambient, top and bottom oil) and load current The load capability of power transformers is limited principally by the winding temperature. But the true limiting factor is the hottest winding section, since the winding temperature isn’t uniform over its extent. This section is called winding Hot Spot and it is located around the top of the winding. The Hot Spot temperature may be determined by a mathematical model with ambient temperature, top and bottom temperatures and the load current as inputs. The isolation temperature is the main cause of transformer ageing. The cellulose isolation undergoes “despolymerization”, caused by temperature and time. As the cellulose chain becomes smaller, the mechanical properties of the paper, like traction resistance and elasticity are degraded. It’s possible that the paper becomes fragile and is incapable to withstand the short-circuit forces and the normal vibrations. This is points to the end of the life of the solid isolation, thus determining the end of transformer life. The hot spot monitoring allow taking advantage of cold ambient temperature, to extend the transformer lifetime, providing the capacity of urgent overload. Oil flow
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
General Description 1-4
The knowledge of oil flow on the pump pipe is necessary to assure the correct cooling of the circulating oil inside the transformer. Cooling system current The measurement of fans and pumps current is necessary to verify the correct operation of each fan and pump group. Measurement of voltage or current at the tap of the bushing Bushing failures usually occur in a sequence of small defects which impose the loss of intermediary capacitive layers, frequently caused by short-circuit between two conductive aluminum sheets. This progression is irreversible and provokes the elimination of one capacitive layer thus causing an increase in the overall capacitance of the bushing. By monitoring the voltage or current on the capacitive tap (voltage or test tap) of the bushings, it is possible to verify the variation on the capacitance relative deviation between the phases and identify a possible fault. Oil Level The knowledge of oil level is necessary to calculate the total volume of the transformer oil. By comparing this measured oil volume to the calculated (determined by the oil temperatures), possible oil leaks on the transformer tank can be detected.
1.1.3 Storage strategy In order to optimize the memory usage on the servers (hard disk) and avoid large amount of inconsequential data Smart Monitor does not store every data point received (frequency recording). Instead, it defines a threshold for each variable above/below which this variable should be stored (event recording). The limit defined for each variable is shown on the table below:
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
General Description 1-5
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Table 1-1 – Standard threshold of monitored variables Variable type
Standard threshold
Voltage
1% of nominal voltage (kV)
Overvoltage
1 kV
Load current
5% of nominal current (A)
Temperature
2º C
Relative capacitance deviation
0,1 %
Power
10% of nominal power (MVA)
Individual gases (C2H2, H2, etc)
1 ppm
Combined gases
5 ppm
Moisture in oil (relative saturation) 1% Moisture in oil
1 ppm
Ageing rate
0,1 p.u.
Oil level
5%
Oil volume
100 liters
Air/oil flow on cooling groups
10%
Tap changer position
1 position
Tap changer number of operation 1 operation
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
General Description 1-6
1.2 Models and Core Module Core Module, responsible for the execution of the mathematical models performs data handling in the Smart Monitor expert system. The Core Module also generates the charts, makes the variables available on the pages, calculates variables which are not handled by any model, issues system self-diagnostics and manages all diagnostics and system events. The models are responsible for the calculation of the relevant variables, evaluation of trends and correlation between the input parameters (online and offline), issuing diagnostics and recommending actions when an abnormality is detected. Data treatment will be done by mathematical models that allow the correlation between several input parameters, inferring diagnostics and indicating recommended actions when an anomaly is detected. Based on the scope of the project the following models are available with Smart Monitor. Table 1-2 – Models available on Smart Monitor. Model
Main Functions
Bushing relative Evaluation of bushing insulation condition, based on online and statistical learning. capacitance deviation Insulation moisture
Evaluation of oil moisture condition and estimated moisture in paper, including trend analysis.
Load Guide
The system calculates the future expected hot spot with the user defined values and actual operations conditions, assisting in equipment load management.
Thermal
Hot spot evaluation by ANSI / IEC and Siemens methods.
Ageing and life expectancy
Evaluation of relative loss of life and relative ageing by ANSI, IEC or ABNT methods.
Cooling System
Checks the adequate cooling system operation by monitoring the load current of the fan groups and oil/water flow (depending on the cooling system)
Conservator oil volume
Allows the incipient fault indication before reaching the lowest acceptable level, comparing the estimated insulating oil volume in the conservator based on the transformer temperatures distribution with the calculated volume based on the oil level sensor indication.
Cooling Control
Only by defining the desired transformer operation temperature, this model controls the cooling system calculating the future hot spot as a function of the current loading. Also factored in is the number of hours of fans and pumps usage, in order to balance the wear of each group (rotational use). Additionally, the system executes periodical cooling groups exercise.
LTC Monitoring
Monitoring of average and maximum power on each tap change in order to detect alteration on the motor drive torque. Acceptable limit for each tap position is defined based on learning of tap transitions. It also calculates the wear of contacts.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
General Description 1-7
Combined dissolved gas-in-oil
Dissolved gas-in-oil ratios, trends and limit values evaluation, based on an online statistical learning.
Three-gas online Chromatography
Evaluation and indication of incipient faults using standardized methods, including the Duval’s triangle. Evaluates ratios, trends and limit values, based on an online statistical learning.
Eight-gas online Chromatography
Evaluation and indication of incipient faults using standardized methods, including the Duval’s triangle. Evaluates ratios, trends and limit values, based on an online statistical learning. Includes the evaluation of the CO2/CO concentration ratio, for enhanced troubleshooting.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-1
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
2
Web Page In this section, all available pages of the Smart Monitor website are detailed with comments to ease the system usage. All functions available in the Smart Monitor Software are presented and some may not be available with the purchased software configuration due to its scope. Smart Monitor web pages are not automatically refreshed and if necessary the function key “F5” can alternatively be used.. When entering or modifying parameters of the system, the exclamation signal (!) may come up at right of a data field, indicating an improper or out of limits value.. In this case, enter an appropriated value to proceed.
2.1 General Screens 2.1.1 Login
Selection of the languages available for SM web site To open this initial windows, open a new web browser tab, type Smart Monitor IP address or DNS name (if available within the intranet) and “enter”.
After typing Login and Password, click here to connect to Smart Monitor.
Figure 2-1 – Login Internet Explorer must be 6.0 or higher and Java plug-in available for charts.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-2
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
If a user does not have a Login and Password, the customer system administrator must be contacted. Usually SIEMENS provides a initial system administration login/password and then various users can be created (refer to 2.4). If the customer system administrator does not have a Login and Password, contact the vendor at Siemens.
2.1.2 Home Home page provides information for each monitored equipment, the latest active diagnostic and system event. These messages remain active until they are acknowledged. Diagnostic messages relates to the transformer condition or status. System Events relates to autodiagnostic of Smart Monitor software and hardware issues, including sensors or IEDs, communication, cabling and panel (like open door microswitch or an opened circuit breaker). If there are no active diagnostics and/or system events, “No occurrence” caption shall be displayed under the Description column. In case the equipment is on Maintenance mode (see item 2.2.9 for more details), system indicates “Maintenance” under Description. From this page, the user can access the diagnostic/event of any equipment or use the menu on top of the page to access other pages.
Smart Monitor status
Click on the menu items to access the respective page
Click on the text in column Description to access the diagnostic/event page
Figure 2-2 – Home.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-3
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
The operation status can indicate: Online: Smart Monitor service is running normally. Offline: Smart Monitor service is stopped. Turn off the SM microbox (microcomputer) and restart. Wait 5 minutes and if the status remains the same, contact Siemens for support. No service: The service used to publish the Smart Monitor page is not communicating with the system data bank. Turn off the SM microbox (microcomputer) and restart. Wait 5 minutes and if the status remains the same, contact Siemens for support. Maintenance: The selected equipment was set to Maintenance mode. If the maintenance has been finished, change the maintenance mode (refer to section 2.2.9).
2.1.3 General Functions The screen below illustrates details of the system which are available during navigation:
Click here to log off from Smart Monitor website
Click here to print the currently displayed page
Connected user name
Figure 2-3 – General Functions.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Click here to access Smart Monitor manual
Web Page 2-4
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
2.2 Equipment Menu After selection of the monitored equipment, the left side Menu becomes available.
2.2.1 Equipment selection This page shows the Substation and the transformer Denomination. A brief description of the equipment – nameplates data and main characteristics - are displayed for surely identify the transformer.
Menu After selecting the substation and transformer denomination, the rated nameplate and main characteristics are displayed for surely identify the unit Click Confirm to proceed.
Figure 2-2 – Equipment selection Note: Smart Monitor is intended to monitor only one transformer at a time although this page includes the Substation and Transfomer Denomination with scroll down box. The reason is due to the software code which is exactly the same for TMDS – multiple transformers and substations monitoring –, only preparing a different configuration.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-5
Main variables The screen provides a picture of the equipment with current values of the main variables super imposed over the transformer picture. This page is automatically updated every minute. The automatic log off after 5 minutes don’t apply here.
Figure 2-3 –Main variables.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-6
2.2.2 All variables All Variables page shows directly measured and calculated variables by the engineering models, and displays the the last value stored in the system database.
Figure 2-4 – All variables. The variables are joined in groups to ease the visualization. The following table lists all variables that can be monitored by the system with an indication of its group. The table also lists the origin of each variable. This page can be easily configured for each project according to customer preference and of course according to the available sensors and models.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-7
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Table 2-1 – All variables. Group
Variable
Voltage
Phase-to-ground voltage - HV
kV
Bushing sensor
Voltage
Phase-to-ground voltage - LV
kV
Bushing sensor
Voltage
Phase-to-ground voltage - Phase A - HV
kV
Bushing sensor
Voltage
Phase-to-ground voltage - Phase B - HV
kV
Bushing sensor
Voltage
Phase-to-ground voltage - Phase C - HV
kV
Bushing sensor
Voltage
Phase-to-ground voltage - Phase A - LV
kV
Bushing sensor
Voltage
Phase-to-ground voltage - Phase B - LV
kV
Bushing sensor
Voltage
Phase-to-ground voltage - Phase C - LV
kV
Bushing sensor
Overvoltage
Overvoltage HV
kV
Bushing sensor
Overvoltage
Overvoltage - LV
kV
Bushing sensor
Overvoltage
Overvoltage phase A - LV
kV
Bushing sensor
Overvoltage
Overvoltage phase B - LV
kV
Bushing sensor
Overvoltage
Overvoltage phase C - LV
kV
Bushing sensor
Overvoltage
Overvoltage phase A - HV
kV
Bushing sensor
Overvoltage
Overvoltage phase B - HV
kV
Bushing sensor
Overvoltage
Overvoltage phase C - HV
kV
Bushing sensor
Capacitance
Relative capacitance deviation - HV
%
Bushing model
Capacitance
Relative capacitance deviation - LV
%
Bushing model
Capacitance
Relative capacitance deviation phase A - HV
%
Bushing model
Capacitance
Relative capacitance deviation phase B - HV
%
Bushing model
Capacitance
Relative capacitance deviation phase C - HV
%
Bushing model
Capacitance
Relative capacitance deviation phase A - LV
%
Bushing model
Capacitance
Relative capacitance deviation phase B - LV
%
Bushing model
Capacitance
Relative capacitance deviation phase C - LV
%
Bushing model
Current
Current HV
A
Current transducer
Current
Current LV
A
Current transducer
Current
Tertiary Current
A
Current transducer
Power
Power
Temperatures
Smart Monitor local panel temperature
ºC
RTD sensor
Temperatures
Core temperature - Measurement 1
ºC
RTD sensor
Temperatures
Core temperature - Measurement 2
ºC
RTD sensor
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Unity
MVA
Origin
SM Core Module
Web Page 2-8
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Temperatures
Top oil temperature - Measurement 1
ºC
RTD sensor
Temperatures
Top oil temperature - Measurement 2
ºC
RTD sensor
Temperatures
Bottom oil temperature - Measurement 1
ºC
RTD sensor
Temperatures
Bottom oil temperature - Measurement 2
ºC
RTD sensor
Temperatures
Ambient temperature
ºC
RTD sensor
Temperatures
Hot spot temperature HV - Calculated
ºC
Thermal model
Temperatures
Hot spot temperature LV - Calculated
ºC
Thermal model
Temperatures
Tertiary Hot spot temperature - Calculated
ºC
Thermal model
Temperatures
Hot spot temperature HV - Measured
ºC
FO Direct measurement
Temperatures
Hot spot temperature LV - Measured
ºC
FO Direct measurement
Temperatures
Tertiary Hot spot temperature - Measured
ºC
FO Direct measurement
Temperatures
Water temperature
ºC
RTD sensor
Gas in oil
Hydrogen - H2
ppm
Gas sensor
Gas in oil
Methane - CH4
ppm
Gas sensor
Gas in oil
Acetylene - C2H2
ppm
Gas sensor
Gas in oil
Ethylene - C2H4
ppm
Gas sensor
Gas in oil
Ethane - C2H6
ppm
Gas sensor
Gas in oil
Carbon Monoxide - CO
ppm
Gas sensor
Gas in oil
Carbon dioxide - CO2
ppm
Gas sensor
Gas in oil
Oxygen - O2
ppm
Gas sensor
Gas in oil
Nitrogen - N2
ppm
Gas sensor
Gas in oil
Total Dissolved Combustible Gases (TDCG)
ppm
Gas model
Gas in oil
Gas in oil
ppm
Gas sensor
Moisture
Oil moisture (relative saturation)
Moisture
Oil moisture
Moisture
%
Gas/moisture sensor
ppm
Moisture model
Moisture in paper at hot spot
%
Moisture model
Moisture
RSoilper_calc
%
Moisture model
Moisture
Woil_calc
%
Moisture model
Moisture
Wcell_cold_bot_insul
%
Moisture model
Moisture
Wcell_cold_top_insul
%
Moisture model
Moisture
Wcell_bot_cond_insul_surf
%
Moisture model
Moisture
Wcell_top_cond_insul_surf
%
Moisture model
Moisture
Wcell_ bot_ cond_ insul
%
Moisture model
Moisture
Wcell_top_cond_insul
%
Moisture model
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-9
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Moisture
Wcell_avg
%
Moisture model
Moisture
GPAOIL
bar
Moisture model
Moisture
Temp Bubble
ºC
Moisture model
Ageing
Relative aging rate - IEC
p.u.
Thermal model
Ageing
Relative aging rate - ABNT
p.u.
Thermal model
Ageing
Relative aging rate - IEEE
p.u.
Thermal model
Ageing
Aging hours
h
Thermal model
Loss of life
Accumulated aging rate - IEC
p.u.
Thermal model
Loss of life
Accumulated aging rate - ABNT
p.u.
Thermal model
Loss of life
Accumulated aging rate - IEEE
p.u.
Thermal model
DECT
TAP position
-
Position indicator
Oil level
Oil level of main tank conservator
%
Oil level indicator
Oil level
Oil volume calc. as function of oil level
liters
Oil level model
Oil level
Oil volume calc. as function of temperature distribuition in the tank and conservator
liters
Oil level model
LTC
Oil level of LTC conservator
%
Oil level indicator
LTC
TAP position
-
Position indicator
LTC
LTC motor current
A
Current transducer
LTC
LTC oil temperature
ºC
RTD sensor
LTC
Operations number of LTC
-
LTC model
LTC
LTC oil moisture
-
Moisture sensor
Cooling
Air flow - Fan group 1
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Air flow - Fan group 2
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Air flow - Fan group 3
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Air flow - Fan group 4
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Air flow - Fan group 5
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Air flow - Fan group 6
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Current - Fan Group 1
A
Current transducer
Cooling
Current - Fan Group 2
A
Current transducer
Cooling
Current - Fan Group 3
A
Current transducer
Cooling
Current - Fan Group 4
A
Current transducer
Cooling
Current - Fan Group 5
A
Current transducer
Cooling
Current - Fan Group 6
A
Current transducer
Cooling
Hour counter - Fan group 1
h
SM Core Module
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-10
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Cooling
Hour counter - Fan group 2
h
SM Core Module
Cooling
Hour counter - Fan group 3
h
SM Core Module
Cooling
Hour counter - Fan group 4
h
SM Core Module
Cooling
Hour counter - Fan group 5
h
SM Core Module
Cooling
Hour counter - Fan group 6
h
SM Core Module
Cooling
Oil flow - Pump 1
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Oil flow - Pump 2
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Oil flow - Pump 3
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Oil flow - Pump 4
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Oil flow - Pump 5
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Oil flow - Pump 6
%
Flow sensor
Cooling
Hour counter - Pump 1
h
SM Core Module
Cooling
Hour counter - Pump 2
h
SM Core Module
Cooling
Hour counter - Pump 3
h
SM Core Module
Cooling
Hour counter - Pump 4
h
SM Core Module
Cooling
Hour counter - Pump 5
h
SM Core Module
Cooling
Hour counter - Pump 6
h
SM Core Module
2.2.3 Charts In the Charts page, the user can select as many variables as needed, using a scrolling menu of all variables. In order to ease the visualization not more than 3 variables should be selected at a time. Selecting more than 3 can be useful only for downloading the values to a .csv file.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-11
Select the period Click the onscreen icon “double arrow” to generate the chart
Selection of other transformers
Selection of variables
Click on the link to open the values table
Figure 2-5 – Charts To select (or unselect) multiple variables for the chart, hold down the “Ctrl” key before toggling the mouse left button over the item. Variables from other monitored transformers can be selected for comparision purposes. Select the period and click the onscreen button “double arrow” to generate the chart. . Every time the selections of variables or period are changed, it is necessary to click the onscreen button “double arrow” to update the chart selections. To zoom a portion of the chart, hold the left button of the mouse, drag the desired region and then release the button. To zoom in, drag from the left to the right and to zoom out, drag from the right to the left. Values Table link opens a window with all values selected for the chart in a tabular format. From there, it is possible to export the data in a .csv file by clicking on the link Export shown below. Before downloading the file, the operational system software will open a window to choose the local, directory and file name.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Figure 2-6 – Data table.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-12
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-13
2.2.4 Duval’s triangle This feature is only available for Smart Monitor configurations with dissolved gases in oil device capable of measuring the Duval’s triangle key gases (CH4, C2H2 and C2H4). The red dot indicates the region of fault based on current gas concentrations and grey dots the previous concentrations. Duval’s Triangle can only indicate the type of an ongoing fault, for any concentration of its key gases. The diagnostic of an incipient fault need additional analysis, like concentration of gases, trends, transformer fingerprints for comparison, etc. Do not make conclusions based only on Duval’s triangle.
Figure 2-7 – Duval triangle
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-14
2.2.5 Diagnostics This page shows all the Diagnostics issued by the system for this transfomer. Diagnostics are related to the transformer condition while system events are related to the monitoring hardware and software. Each engineering model of Smart Monitor analyses accordingly the data available by filtering the raw data from sensors/IEDs, storing values, performing statistics, learning from previous collected data, trend calculations, comparison with proven or standardized limits and correlation with other variables. The aim of the models is to indicate a possible fault or a developing fault as early as possible. In order to detect these incipient faults sometimes is not possible to avoid false positives. By default, clicking on Diagnostics link on the side menu, the system will show only the active diagnostics (not yet acknowledged by any user). To view all diagnostics - active and acknowledged - issued by the system click on the onscreen “Enable filters” button and select the box “All Diagnostics”.
Figure 2-8 – Enable diagnostic filter.
Select the period
Figure 2-9 – Performing diagnostics filtering
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-15
Select the desired period and click the onscreen icon “double arrow” to perform the search. To detail each diagnostic, click on View link to open a new window. Here we can find the description of the diagnostic event, the prognostic or further analysis, recommended actions and if applicable, the detected trend.
Figure 2-10 – Diagnostic presentation. To include comments to the issued diagnostic, just type the desired text in the white box and click on the button “Save Comments”. There is no limit for the number of added comments. It is recommended to acknowledge the diagnostic just after the issue has been properly addressed, the measurement values returned to normal conditon and comments have been inserted. Dependign on an
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-16
expert technician analysis, some condfigured values can be changed because it can be normal for this transformer fingerprint. In case the conditions for a diagnostics persist after the acknowledgement the system will issue the same diagnostic with values which could be newly calculated. Generate Report button allow to Open or Save a report of this specific diagnostic.
Choosing Open, the system will open a new window to display the report in .html format, with all the diagnostic information, including the added comments. To print it, click on the Print link.
Figure 2-11 – Diagnostic report
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-17
2.2.6 System Events System Events are related to the monitoring hardware and software and are generated by the Smart Monitor Core Module. It can be triggered by any problem with sensor/IEDs integrated to the monitoring system, malfunction of the computers or inconsistence of the calculations of the engineering models. This page allows access to System Events issued for the selected equipment only (to visualize System Events from all monitored equipment go to item Table 2.2). By default, clicking the link System Events link on the side menu, only the active system events will be shown. Active are those whose condition/alarm still persist. To visualize all system events - active and inactive -, toggle the “Enable filters” button and then select the box “All Events”. Afterwards, select the desired period and click the onscreen icon “double arrow” to perform the search. Unlike Diagnostics, the system events do no require acknowledgement. It will automatically turn inactive as the issue has been solved.
Figure 2-12 – Enabling System Events filtering. The list of all events includes one line for the date/time when the system event turned active and another line for the date/time when it was released (inactive). Hence, when “All events” is selected, take care of not interpreting a released event as active.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-18
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Figure 2-13 – System events. To help the user to identify the root cause of the problem, the system indicates the origin of the event detected on the column Origin shown above: Table 2-2 – Available System Events on Smart Monitor and recommenedd actions.
LTC sensors
Bushing sensor
Origin
Description
Recommended actions
Bushing monitoring device - Action alert
This event is obtained directly from the bushing sensor and is related to the bushing conditions. For more details, refer to the sensor manual
Bushing monitoring device - Warning alert
This event is obtained directly from the bushing sensor and is related to the bushing conditions. For more details, refer to the sensor manual.
Bushing monitoring device - Information alert
This event is obtained directly from the bushing sensor and is related to the bushing conditions. For more details, refer to the sensor manual.
Bushing monitoring device - System fault
This event is obtained directly from the bushing sensor and is related to the sensor conditions. For more details, refer to the sensor manual.
Communication failure with bushing monitoring device
Ensure that there is communication between local and central panel. In case this communication is faulty, this event will come up among others. If the communication is established, verify if the bushing sensor is on and the LEDs of the respective module on ET200s are blinking. If not, check the wiring and the power supply.
Communication Failure TM100
Ensure that there is communication between local and central panel. In case this communication is faulty, this event will come up among others. If the communication is established, verify if TM100 sensor is on and the LEDs of the respective module on ET200s are blinking. If not, check the wiring and the power supply.
Output overflow - Oil level indicator – LTC Output overflow - Motor current sensor - LTC Wire break - Oil level indicator – LTC Wire break - Motor current sensor - LTC
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is out of 4-20mA range, the sensor may be defective. If it is within this range, the ET200s module may be defective. Ensure that there is communication between local and central panel. In case this communication is faulty, this event will come up among others. If the communication is established, verify if TM100 sensor is on and the LEDs of the respective module on ET200s are blinking. If not, check the wiring and the power supply.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Load Current sensor
Output overflow - Load current sensor – HV Output overflow - Load current sensor – LV Output overflow - Load current sensor - Tertiary Wire break - Load current sensor – HV Wire break - Load current sensor – LV Wire break - Load current sensor - Tertiary
Web Page 2-19
Turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is out of 4-20mA range, the sensor may be defective. If it is within this range, the ET200s module may be defective.
Verify if the sensor is on and the wiring between the ET200s module and sensor is ok. If so, turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is below 4mA, the sensor may be defective. Otherwise there may be a fault on the ET200s module.
Open circuit breaker - 24V DC power supply
Breakers
Open circuit breaker - AC power supply Open circuit breaker - Gas in oil monitoring device Open circuit breaker Bushing monitoring device
Make sure there is communication between local and central panel. In case this communication is faulty, this event will come up among others. If the communication is established, try to close the circuit breaker. If it goes off again, make sure there is no short-circuit on the wiring from the circuit breaker and all components on the circuit are functional.
Gas in oil sensor
Open circuit breaker Light, heater and fan from local panel Hydran sensor alarm System failure
This event is obtained directly from Hydran and is related to the sensor conditions. For more details, refer to the sensor manual.
Hydran sensor alarm - Gas high
This event is obtained directly from Hydran and is related to the gas in oil conditions. For more details, refer to the sensor manual.
Hydran sensor alarm - Gas high-high
This event is obtained directly from Hydran and is related to the gas in oil conditions. For more details, refer to the sensor manual.
Hydran sensor alarm Moisture in oil
This event is obtained directly from Hydran and is related to the moisture in oil conditions. For more details, refer to the sensor manual.
Helium low pressure Siemens Gas-Guard
Verify the pressure of helium cylinder. If it is around 150 psi, it should be replaced.
Communication failure with gas in oil monitoring device
Ensure that there is communication between local and central panel. In case this communication is faulty, this event will come up among others. If the communication is established, verify if the gas sensor is on and the LEDs of the respective module on ET200s are blinking. If not, check the wiring and the power supply.
Output overflow - Hydran sensor
Turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is out of 4 - 20mA range, the sensor may be defective. If it is within this range, the ET200s module may be defective.
Wire break - Hydran sensor
Verify if the sensor is on and the wiring between the ET200s module and sensor is ok. If so, turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-20
Cooling system sensors
Control cubicle signals
Oil level indicator
Smart Monitor
IM151-8
terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is below 4mA, the sensor may be defective. Otherwise there may be a fault on the ET200s module. Power relay - Siemens GasGuard
Ensure that there is communication between local and central panel. In case this communication is faulty, this event will come up among others. If the communication is established, verify that the power supply of the gas sensor is ok.
Programmable relay Siemens Gas-Guard
This event is obtained directly from Gas Guard and can be related to the sensor or gas in oil conditions. For more details, the sensor manual shall be verified.
Communication failure
Verify if the IM151-8 is connected.
Local panel door open
Verify if the local panel door is open. Make sure there is communication between local and central panel. In case this communication is faulty, this event will come up among others. If necessary, verify wiring and status of micro-switch responsible for this alarm.
Output overflow - Oil level indicator - Main tank
Turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is out of 4 - 20mA range, the sensor may be defective. If it is within this range, the ET200s module may be defective.
Wire break - Oil level indicator - Main tank
Verify if the sensor is on and the wiring between the ET200s module and sensor is ok. If so, turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is below 4mA, the sensor may be defective. Otherwise there may be a fault on the ET200s module.
High Pressure
This event is related to the protection system of the transformer.
Low Pressure
This event is related to the protection system of the transformer.
OLTC blocked
This event is related to the protection system of the transformer.
Protection - Buchoolz Alarm
This event is related to the protection system of the transformer.
Protection - Buchoolz - Trip
This event is related to the protection system of the transformer.
Protection - Tank pressure relief - Trip
This event is related to the protection system of the transformer.
OLTC Overpressure
This event is related to the protection system of the transformer.
Transformer Overpressure
This event is related to the protection system of the transformer.
Empty Tank
This event is related to the protection system of the transformer.
Output overflow - Current sensor of fan group 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6
Turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is out of 4 - 20mA range, the sensor may be defective. If it is within this range, the ET200s module may be defective. Turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals.
Output overflow - Air flow sensor of fan group1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Output overflow - Oil flow sensor of pump1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6 Wire break - Current sensor of fan group 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6 Wire break - Air flow sensor of fan group1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6
Web Page 2-21
Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is out of 4 - 20mA range, the sensor may be defective. If it is within this range, the ET200s module may be defective.
Verify if the sensor is on and the wiring between the ET200s module and sensor is ok. If so, turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is below 4mA, the sensor may be defective. Otherwise there may be a fault on the ET200s module.
Wire break - Oil flow sensor of pump 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6
Output overflow - Hot spot temperature – HV, LV or Tertiary
Temperature sensors
Output overflow - Core temperature - Spot1 or 2
Turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is out of 4 - 20mA range, the sensor may be defective. If it is within this range, the ET200s module may be defective.
Wire break - Ambient or local panel temperature sensor Wire break - Hot spot temperature – HV, LV or Tertiary Wire break - Core temperature - Spot 1 or 2 Wire break - Bottom oil temperature - Sensor 1 or 2
Verify if the sensor is on and the wiring between the ET200s module and sensor is ok. If so, turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is below 4mA, the sensor may be defective. Otherwise there may be a fault on the ET200s module.
Wire break - Top oil temperature - Sensor 1 or 2 Local panel temperature above maximum limit
Moisture sensor
Output overflow Temperature - Moisture in oil sensor Output overflow - Relative humidity - Moisture in oil sensor Wire break - Temperature Moisture in oil sensor Wire break - Relative humidity - Moisture in oil sensor
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Make sure local panel fan is working properly and the temperature sensor is not defective. If no problem is found, the cooling of this panel may be redefined. Turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is out of 4 - 20mA range, the sensor may be defective. If it is within this range, the ET200s module may be defective. Turn the respective circuit breaker off and insert an ammeter in series with the ET200s module that is causing the event. Be careful not to short-circuit the module terminals. Turn the circuit breaker on and measure the current. If it is out of 4 - 20mA range, the sensor may be defective. If it is within this range, the ET200s module may be defective.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-22
2.2.7 Notes This function allows the user to record general comments and notes regarding modifications or changes made to the monitoring system or the monitored equipment. All the comments eventually added to diagnostics are also available at this section.
After typing the note, click here to save it.
Figure 2-14 – Adding notes.
2.2.8 Maintenance If the user clicks on the Start Maintenance button, the Smart Monitor system would be taken off line, then the user would enter what maintenance activity was performed on the Smart Monitor system. This function must be used every time an action that may lead to interference with the monitoring system is being taken. The purpose is to avoid improper alarms and data recording.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-23
Figure 2-15 – Starting maintenance. To Start Maintenance click the onscreen button and the status indicator of this transformer will change to Maintenance and the values in Main Variables and All Variables will be frozen with the last readings, in order to show the last situation before the maintenance period. From this moment on, the data acquisition/recording and diagnostic/event issuing will be paused. Additional information/comments can be added during maintenance status condition, without breaking this condition. Type the information/comments and click onscreen button “Save message”. To end the maintenance status condition, type a brief description (obligatory) and click onscreen button Stop maintenance.
Figure 2-16 – Stopping maintenance.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-24
2.2.9 Maintenance - History Use this link to view all maintenance periods that were recorded in the system for this transformer.
2.2.10 Parameters This page shows the parameters used by Smart Monitor engineering models and also, for authorized users, the modification of them. Inadequate modifications of parameters can cause erroneous calculations and diagnostics.
Figure 2-17 – Changing parameters. After the modification of any parameter, it is necessary to click the onscreen button Modify at the bottom of the page in order to confirm the modification. Here you are not just saving new values but introducing new behavior to the system.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-25
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
i.
Parameters – Transformer The basic transformer parameters are shown below:
Table 2-3 – Thermal Model parameters Parameter
Description
Origin
Un.
Default
Serial number
Transformer serial number. For identification purpose.
Nameplate
-
NA
Technical data
Transformer description and caractheristics. identification purpose.
-
NA
Energization date
Transformer first energization date. Used in ageing model.
date
NA
Nominal voltage Rated voltage (at center tap) of the transformer – HV. (phase-to-ground) – Nameplate Used in various models. HV
kV
NA
Nominal voltage Nominal voltage of the transformer – LV. Used in (phase-to-ground) – Nameplate various models. LV
kV
NA
Voltage HV (phaseto-phase) for ratio
Used for HV/LV voltage ratio calculation (*).
Nameplate
kV
NA
Voltage LV (phaseto-phase) for ratio
Used for HV/LV voltage ratio calculation (*).
Nameplate
kV
NA
High Voltage Current CT – Max Range
Highest current value of HV CT primary. Related to secondary current of 5A. For example, a TC ratio of Nameplate 600/5A has max range of 600. For a TC ratio of 600/1A the max range must be 3000.
A
NA
High Voltage Current CT – Min Range
Lowest current value of HV CT primary. Value is 0 Nameplate (zero). For compatibility purpose.
A
NA
Low Voltage Current CT – Max Range
Highest current value of LV CT primary. Related to secondary current of 5A. For example, a TC ratio of Nameplate 1200/5A has max range of 1200. For a TC ratio of 1200/1A the max range must be 6000.
A
NA
Low Voltage Current CT – Min Range
Lowest current value of LV CT primary. Value is 0 (zero). Nameplate For compatibility purpose.
A
NA
For Nameplates values and customer tags
(*) Specific for CenterPoint project.The ratio is used to estimate the HV line current from LV line measured current. HV line current is not measured but necessary for the thermal model calculations.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-26
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Parameters – Cooling Control Model For the cooling control, the following parameters must be configured: Table 2-4 – Parameters Cooling Mode Parameter
Description
Hot-spot temperature for control
Reference temperature for the cooling control model. It estimates the steady state hot spot temperature for all cooling mode and compares with this reference. The cooling mode which has the closest steady state hot spot temperature of this reference is then selected. Hence the cooling groups are activated accordingly. If the calculated ongoing hot spot temperature surpasses this value the cooling groups are also activated and only deactivated when the temperature is return to a value lower than this reference. There is no hysteresis (see next item)
Origin of value
Default
ºC
85ºC
minutes
30 min
minutes
30 min
days
7 days
Customer choice The default value is considered low by Siemens, but has been adopted for compatibility with usual customer choice.
Delay time for cooling groups control being revaluated (activation or deactivation) by the Minimum working period Customer choice cooling control model. It is necessary to avoid excessive activation/deactivation. Interval of time the cooling groups will remain Duration of cooling exercise activated during the periodic exercise. Preventive Customer choice maintenance purposes. To adjust how frequent all the cooling groups Time interval between will be activated for preventive maintenance Customer choice exercises purposes.
ii.
Un.
Parameters – Thermal Model The table below shows all necessary parameters for Smart Monitor Thermal Model:
Table 2-5 – Thermal Model parameters Parameter
Description
Un.
Default
Model for hot spot calculation
Hot spot temperature algorithm calculation selection (IEEE, IEC or SIEMENS model). When using Dynamic Customer choice Loading Guide, select Siemens model for compatibility.
NA
SIEMENS
Maximum winding temperature
Limit for the highest (among the windings) hot spot Based on standard temperature, directly measured or calculated. A recommendation or diagnostic will be issued as an alert. customer choice
ºC
120ºC
Maximum aging rate
Limit of ageing rate for issuing a diagnostic as an alert.
Based on standard recommendation or customer choice
p.u.
2.7 p.u.
Maximum accumulated loss of life Loss of life prior to the monitoring (ABNT NBR, IEC or IEEE)
Limit of equivalent aging factor (refer to IEEE standard). For issuing a diagnostic as an alert. Some authors use the term “accumulated loss of life in p.u.” Equivalent aging factor from the period since the first energization date and the start date of the on-line monitoring system. For compatibility 3 standards are available, although they can be considered equal by
Based on standard recommendation or customer choice
p.u.
1.2 p.u.
Evaluated by the customer according to the standard
p.u.
NA
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Origin
Web Page 2-27
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
approximation. For example if the transformer has been in operation for any number of years at exactly 110°C (hot spot temperature and using thermally upgraded paper), this value is 1.0. If the hot spot temperature is 89°C, this value is 0.1.
Monitoring start date
Start date of monitoring on the selected equipment. Used to include the loss of life prior to the monitoring to the Aging hours.
Maximum ambient temperature
Maximum expected ambient temperature of the site. Customer input. Used for calculations within the Thermal Model. Estimated.
date
NA
ºC
NA
ºC
105ºC
p.u.
1.3 p.u.
p.u.
1,3 p.u.
Supplied by the manufacturer. Should be mentioned and used in the heat run test report.
-
1.3
Supplied by the manufacturer or estimated from the routine test report..
%
NA
kW
NA
kW
NA
Choice of the customer and based on standards. Choice of the Limit of Load factor for issuing a diagnostic. The same Maximum operation customer based on limit is applicable to HV, LV and tertiary currents of each overload technical design and cooling mode. operational pratices Maximum top oil temperature
Maximum design overload
Hot Spot Factor (HV, LV or Tertiary)
Winding Eddy Losses (HV, LV or Tertiary)
Limit of top oil temperature for issuing a diagnostic.
Load factor above which a diagnostic will be issued. Supplied by the This limit is applicable just for the cooling mode of manufacturer greatest power. Ratio of hot spot and average winding-oil gradient temperature. For some and average radientValue . Essential for an adequate estimation of the hot spot temperature. They are different for each winding and if not available from the manufacturer refer to IEC 600767 for a default value. The percentage of eddy losses over the ohmic losses of the winding. As the temperature increases, the ohmic losses increases and the eddy losses decreases. To correct the temperature gradients (copper-oil and oil longitudinal) at a certain temperature of the windings the model need to evaluate the losses being dissipated by them. With this parameter this evaluation is improved.
Core Losses at 100% of rated voltage Core Losses at 110% of rated voltage
Used to improve the estimations of the Dynamic Routine test report Loading Guide. Used to improve the estimations of the Dynamic Routine test report Loading Guide.
Standard for loss of life diagnostic
Loss of life is calculated according to IEC, IEEE and ABNT standards. This selection only defines which of them Customer choice will be considered for a diagnostic.
-
IEEE
Paper type
Used to select the aging rate and loss of life formulas from Standards. If the specified hot spot temperature Technical data of the rise is 80°C (110°C if the ambient is 30°C), the cellulosic transformer insulation is thermally upgraded.
-
NA
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-28
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
iii.
Parameters – Cooling Modes For each cooling mode and each winding, the following parameters must be configured to achieve an adequate estimation of hot spot temperature:
Table 2-6 – Parameters Cooling Mode Parameter
Reference losses
Exponent for cooling system temp. calculation
Average oil time constant
Description Rated total losses at which other parameters are referenced. Used in the Dynamic Loading Guide to estimate the cooling system average oil temperature rise over ambient in steady state load. Used in the Dynamic Loading Guide to estimate the average temperature rise over ambient of the cooling system in steady state for the new load. Used in the Dynamic Loading Guide to estimate the ongoing cooling system average temp. oil rise over ambient by the transitory thermal model.
Or average temperature rise over ambient at the reference losses above mentioned. Used in the Dynamic Loading Guide to estimate the cooling system average oil temperature rise over ambient in steady state for the new load. Or rated top oil minus the bottom oil temp. in the cooling system(radiators) at the reference Longitudinal gradient of oil losses mentioned above. temp. in the cooling system Used in the Dynamic Loading Guide to estimate the cooling system bottom oil temperature after corrected by the transitory thermal model. Exponent for winding Used to calculate the new steady state copper-oil temp. calculation temperature gradient on each winding and then the hot spot temperature Average increase of oil temperature in the cooling system
Longitudinal time constant of the windings oil
Percent of total eddy losses
Rated current HV, LV or Tertiary
Rated average copper-oil gradient HV, LV or Tertiary
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Time constant of the exponential temperature rise/decay of the longitudinal oil temperature gradient in the ducts of the windings. Used for hot spot partial calculations acc. to the transitory thermal model The percentage of total additional losses (eddy and stray of the active part) over the ohmic losses of all the windings together. Used to correct the sum of winding losses at a certain temperature in the Dynamic Loading Guide. Reference currents for other parameters below. Used to calculate the load factor on windings, necessary for hot spot partial calculations. At the reference current above for each winding. Used as partial calculation of the hot spot to estimate the the copper-oil gradient on each winding in steady state of the ongoing load factor and then corrected by the transitory
Origin of value
Un.
Default
Equipment heat run test
kW
NA
Standard IEEE C57.911995/2002
-
ONAN: 0,8 ONAF: 0,9 ODAF: 1,0
Extracted from heat run test report or calculated acc. Standards and weights from nameplate.
minutes
NA
Heat run test report.
ºC
NA
Heat run test report.
ºC
NA
-
ONAN: 0,8 ONAF: 0,8 ODAF: 1,0
minutes
NA
Routine test report or heat run test report.
%
NA
Heat run test report.
A
NA
Heat run test report.
ºC
NA
Standard IEEE C57.911995/2002 Extracted from heat run test report. Can be also estimated as 1/5 of the oil time constant.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-29
thermal model.
Oil rated longitudinal gradient HV, LV or Tertiary
Winding time Constant HV, LV or Tertiary
Reference losses HV, LV or Tertiary
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
At the reference current above for each winding. Used as partial calculation of the hot spot to estimate the the longitudinal oil temp. gradient Heat run test ºC in winding oil ducts at steady state of the report. ongoing load factor and then corrected by the transitory thermal model. Extracted from heat run test Time constant of the exponential temperature report. Can be rise/decay of the copper-oil temperature also estimated minutes gradient. Used for hot spot partial calculations acc. to IEC 60076acc. to the transitory thermal model 7. Usually 5-15 min. At the rated current above mentioned. Used in the Dynamic Loading Guide as part of Routine test report the estimation of the total losses after load or heat run test kW factor and temperature correction. The result is report. part of the calculation of the cooling system average oil temperature rise over ambient.
NA
NA
NA
Web Page 2-30
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
iv.
Parameters – Cooling Group (fans) On this item, besides hard limits for cooling diagnostics, it is possible to modify the hour counter of each cooling group. To do so, type the new value for the counter at Hour counter field and click Modify at the end of the page – see table 2-6.
Table 2-7 – Thermal Model parameters Parameter
Maximum current
Minimum current
Period for maintenance Number
v.
Description Maximum cooling group normal current. In general close to the rated current of each fan times the number of fans. It can be evaluated on-site and an adequate tolerance be added in order to guarantee a correct diagnostic without false positives. A diagnostic will be issued if the measured value is above this limit. Can be calculated by subtracting the current of one fan from the evaluated minimum current of the group of fans during on-site measurements. A diagnostic will be issued if the group current is lower than this limit. Partial operation time of the group of fans which requires maintenance action. A diagnostic will be issued. Number of fans per group.
Origin
Un.
Default
Technical data of equipment
A
NA
Technical data of equipment
A
NA
Technical data of equipment
hour
30000 hours
-
NA
Origin of value
Un.
Default
Customer choice based on Standards
ºC
120ºC
Customer choice based on Standards
hour
2 hours
Customer choice
-
NA
-
Dynamic Loading Model For dynamic loading mode, the following parameters must be configured:
Tabla 2-8 – Dynamic Loading Model parameters. Parameter
Description
Maximum hot-spot temperature to be reached after the “Loading period in emergency” below at Maximum temperature of the load calculated by the Dynamic Loading hot-spot in emergency Model. In fact the model consider this temperature to iteractively calculated the maximum final load in a emergency situation. Maximum time period for the overload Loading period in calculated by the Dynamic Loading Model in emergency order to reach the above configured hot spot. The Dynamic Loding Model can increase the load linearly from the ongoing load to a final load, How to increase the current which is the output of the model. Alternatively it can increase directly to the final load (step).
2.3 Events Menu On this menu it is possible to access Diagnostics and Events of all monitored equipments.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-31
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Figure 2-18 – Visualization of diagnostics from all monitored equipments. The column marked above identifies the equipment of each Diagnostic or System Event. Each page lists 10 Diagnostic/Events. If the diagnostic/event to be visualized is not on the first page, click on the desired page number as indicated on the figure below.
Click on the page number to access older diagnostics/events
Figure 2-19 – Pages of diagnostics/system events.
2.4 Configuration Menu Following are the pages that can be accessed using the Configuration menu.
2.4.1 User This item is only available for users with Administrator privileges. On this item, it is possible to add new users of the system, search existent users, include email address for notification of diagnostics and system events and change the level of access for existing users. The figure below illustrates the fields that can be used to refine a search. After defining the search criterion, click on Refine list. To visualize all existent enabled users, choose Enable on Status and click on Refine list without adding any other search criterion.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-32
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Fields for search criterion
Click here to execute the search
Click here to add a new user
Figure 2-20 – Searching and adding users To create a new user, click on Create. The following screen will come up:
Figure 2-21 – New user entry. For Login, enter the name that will be used to login onto Smart Monitor and for User name, type the entire name of the user. Choose Enable for Status selection in order to allow the user to access the system. Choose one of the following access levels for the new user under the Group field. The available levels are: Visitor: Can view monitored variables, charts, diagnostics and parameters. Monitor: Has the Visitor rights and additionaly can acknowledge Diagnostics, export data, start maintenance and change parameters.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Web Page 2-33
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Administrator: Has the Monitor rights. Additionally can create or delete users and change equipments (item 2.4.3). On Password and Password confirmation fields enter the password according to the following Standards: The first letter must be capital. Must contain at least one numeric character. Must contain at least one symbol within dot (.), comma (,) and asterisk (*). Examples:
Aaa11.aa Peter.123
E-mails list: e-mail addresses which will receive the notification whenever there is a new diagnostic/event available or there is a diagnostic acknowledgement. To include more than one address use comma (,) to separate them. E-mail notification box: The user can be enabled or disabled for receiving the notifications e-mails. Finally, choose whether the password shall expire or not on the selection box Does the password expire? If Yes is chosen, the password will expire in 90 days. After entering all data, click on Save. The Access to the database of the system is legally limited to five (5) users. Above this limit, it is necessary to acquire additional licenses.
2.4.2 Change Password All users can modify their passwords.
Figure 2-22 – Changing user password. Fill in the blanks and click on screen button “Modify password” to confirm.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | April 2012
Web Page 2-34
2.4.3 Status This item is useful when eventual maintenance or remote access is required. Under normal operation, the status on the first line will display Waiting for next solicitation and on the second line it will show Active.
Figure 2-23 – System status.
2.4.4 Loaded modules This information is useful for upgrading and tracking features and bugs already solved in the system, although SIEMENS maintains this information for each supplied system.
Figure 2-24 – Loaded modules on the system.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | December 2010
3
Sensors 3-1
Sensors 3.1 Temperatures 3.1.1 Pt100 (ambient temperature) It consists in a RTD sensor (Resistance Thermometer Detector), 100 Ohm at 0 ºC type, encapsulated in a steel tube. Installed inside Smart Monitor panel.
3.1.1.1 Technical data Typical range: Communication with SM: Protection:
-40ºC to +100ºC RTD Analog IP65
3.1.1.2 General procedures and maintenance Pt100 sensors don’t need specific maintenance procedure.
3.1.2 Pt100 (oil temperatures) It consists in a RTD sensor (Resistance Thermometer Detector), 100 Ohm at 0 ºC type, encapsulated in a steel tube and assembled in an aluminum wiring box – Figure 3-1. It allows the measurement of the top and bottom oil temperatures.
Figure 3-1 – Pt100 for oil temperature.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | December 2010
Sensors 3-2
3.1.2.1 Technical data Operation range: Tube length: Communication with SM: Protection:
-50ºC to +300ºC 80mm RTD analog IP55
3.1.2.2 General procedures and maintenance Pt100 sensors don’t need specific maintenance procedure.
3.2 Load Current 3.2.1 SIMEAS T The passive SIMEAS T transducer converts the alternating input current (from the secondary of a CT) to a load-independet direct output current. The input and output are highly insulated (5 kV) and auxiliary power is not required .
Figure 3-2 – SIMEAS T working principle. Transformer (1) transmits the input signal IE via the rectification and smoothing circuit (2) to the signal evaluation (3), which controls the output amplifier (4). Supplied by the smoothing module, the output amplifier delivers a load independent current IA, proportional to the input signal IE. The protective circuit (5) provides the output with open circuit and transient overvoltage protection.The measuring range of the alternating voltage transducer with expanded end range is adjusted via the expansion circuit (6). The sensor is installed in the transformer main control cubicle to avoid cabling of the secondaries of the TCs from main control cubicle to Smart Monitor, increasing safety to the circuitry – open secondaries may damage bushing CTs and/or connections. For more information, consult the sensor manual
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | December 2010
Sensors 3-3
Figura 3-3 – SIMEAS T.
3.2.1.1 Technical data Model: Provider: Insulation: Short duration current withstand Accuracy: Power/Working range: Temperature: Nominal frequency: CT nominal current: Communication with SM: Setting time (t99): Protection:
7KG6111-3EK10 (60Hz) / 7KG6111-2EK10 (50Hz) Siemens AG Ueff= 5.5 kV 50Hz U= 5kV 1.2/50us (input against output) 200A for 1 s Ien to 0,05Ien : <0,5% 0,9VA – maximum / 0.05Ien to 1.2Ien -10ºC to +60ºC 50 Hz or 60 Hz 5A Analog 0..20mA <1 second IP40
3.2.1.2 General procedures and maintenance SIMEAS T doesn’t need specific maintenance procedure. Before any intervention in the current measurement circuit, short-circuit the secondary of the bushing CT at the main control panel.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual | December 2010
Sensors 3-4
3.3 Cooling Group Current 3.3.1 MCR-SL-S MCR-SL-S is a current measuring transducer for sinusoidal and non-sinusoidal alternating currents. The input current is from 0 to100 A, with loop-powered output with 4...20 mA – Figure 3-4. The sensor has a switch to control the current input range. The transducer is installed in the main control cublicle, near the cooling group circuitry. The output signal is sent to the monitoring system. For more information, consult the sensor manual – see section 2.1.3.
Figure 3-4 –MCR-SL-S transducer.
3.3.1.1 Technical data Model: Provider: Power supply: Operation temperature: Frequency range: CT nominal current: Communication with SM: Precision: Setting time (t99): Protection:
MCR-SL-S-100-I-LP Phoenix Contact 24VDC -20ºC to +60ºC 30 – 600Hz 50, 75 and 100A – with a switch selector Analog 4..20mA <1% <340ms IP20
3.3.1.2 General procedures and maintenance MCR-SL-S doesn’t need specific maintenance procedure.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual| April 2012
4
Hardware 4-1
Hardware 4.1 IM151-8 PN/DP CPU Interface The IM 151-8 PN/DP CPU interface module is an "intelligent preprocessor for TMDS software". It decentralizes control tasks, has all the PLC functionalities and can be integrated to ET200S I/O system modules.
Figure 4-1 – IM151-8 The IM151-8 program, which is edited with Siemens STEP 7 language, controls all the IO cards connected to the sensors/devices. It perform the readings, converts the readings into engineering values and filters the the converted values. The filters algorithms remove spurious, overflow/underflow, outliers values in accordance with the behavior of each device – marking them as unavailable. The PLC program is loaded into a memory card and thus can be easily inserted in a new hardware if necessary to replace. The communication with the Microbox is via PROFINET port (P1/P2/P3 ports are internally connected to an ethernet switch).
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual| April 2012
Hardware 4-2
Table 4-1 – IM151-8 general description. Position 1 2
Description RJ45 socket (port 1 of the PROFINET) R: Ring port for creation of ring topology with media redundancy. RJ45 socket (port 2 of the PROFINET interface) R: Ring port for creation of ring topology with media redundancy.
3
RJ45 socket (port 3 of the PROFINET interface)
4
Mode selector switch
5
Status and error displays of the IM 151-8 PN/DP CPU interface module
6
Status displays of the PROFINET interface
7
Slot for the SIMATIC Micro Memory Card
8
Connection for supply voltage
The Figure 4-1 and the Table 4-1 show a general view of IM151-8. The table 4-2 and 4-3 present the mode select settings and the error leds. Table 4-2 – Mode selector switch settings. Posición
Description
RUN
The IM 151-8 PN/DP CPU interface module processes the user program.
STOP
The IM 151-8 PN/DP CPU interface module does not process the user program
MRES
Mode selector switch setting for Memory reset of the IM 151-8 PN/DP CPU interface module Backing up the firmware to the SIMATIC Micro Memory Card Resetting to the as-supplied state A memory reset using the mode selector requires a number of steps to be carried out in a set order.
Table 4-3 – General status and error displays of the IM 151-8 PN/DP CPU interface module. LED
Color
Description
SF
Red
BF-PN
Red
MT ON
Yellow Green
FRCE
Yellow
Group fault for hardware or software error Lit: Bus fault (no cable connection to a subnet/switch; cable break or short-circuit). Flashes: Check IP addresses ; failure of a connected IO device Maintenance information Supply voltage for the IM 151-8 PN/DP CPU LED is lit: Active force job LED flashes at 2 Hz: Node flash test function.
RUN
Green
IM 151-8 PN/DP CPU in RUN The LED flashes during STARTUP at a rate of 2 Hz, and in HOLD state at 0.5 Hz.
STOP
Yellow
IM 151-8 PN/DP CPU in STOP or in HOLD or STARTUP The LED flashes at 0.5 Hz when the CPU requests a memory reset, and during the reset at 2 Hz.
Note: engineering configuration issues are not included once the system has already worked before.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Hardware 4-3
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual| April 2012
4.1.1 Technical Data Model: Provider: Power supply: Work memory (RAM): Memory card: Bit rate: Communication: Communicaton with Microbox:
6ES7151-8AB01-0AB0 Siemens AG 24VDC 192kB 2MB 10...100Mbps MPI/DP and PROFINET RJ-45 (female)
4.2 ET200S I/O System The ET200S distributed I/O system is a discretely modular, highly flexible DP slave for connection to process signals on a central controller or a field bus. ET200S supports field bus types PROFIBUS DP and PROFINET IO. ET200S has protection class IP 20. Depending on the interface module, each ET200S can consist of up to 63 modules - for example, power modules, I/O modules, and motor starters. These modules are connected to the IM151-8 and translate the sensor data in PROFIBUS/PROFINET compatible data – for communication. The Table 4-4 shows all modules that can be found in Smart Monitor. Table 4-4 –ET200S Modules. Type Analog Analog Digital Digital Serial Serial Power Source PROFIBUS DP
0..20mA / 4..20mA RTD Input output Modbus RTU Modbus ASCII 24VDC -
Module Name 2AI 2RTD 4DI 4DO USS ACSII PM-E DP Master
Input / Output 2 2 4 4 1 1 1
4.3 SIMATIC Microbox IPC The SIMTAIC Microbox IPC is an industrial PC system for high-performance and space-saving applications in particular in the field of machine, systems and control engineering.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual| April 2012
Hardware 4-4
Figure 4-2 – SIMATIC Microbox IPC (front).
Figure 4-3 – SIMATIC Microbox IPC (rear). The Table 4-4 describes the Microbox components shown in the Figure 4-3. Table 4-5 – Location of connection elements– SIMATIC Microbox IPC Position
Designation
Description
1 2 3 4
24 VDC DVI/VGA USB PN/IND. ETHERNET
5
PN/IND. ETHERNET
Connection for a 24 V DC power supply. DVI/VGA connection for CRT or LCD monitor with DVI interface. 4 USB 2.0 connections, high-speed / low current. RJ45 Ethernet connection 1 (exclusive PCI interrupt) for 10/100/1000 Mbps. RJ45 Ethernet connection 2 (shared PCI interrupt) for 10/100/1000 Mbps (not for PROFINET versions).
6
PROFIBUS DP/MPI
PROFIBUS DP/MPI interface (RS 485 electrically isolated), 9-pin D-Sub socket.
7
COM1
8
PE Terminal
Serial port (RS232) 9-pin D-Sub connector. The PE terminal (M4 thread) must be connected to the protective ground conductor of the plant, in which the device is to be installed. The minimum conductor cross-section may not be less than 2,5 mm2.
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
SM – Operation and Maintenance Manual| April 2012
4.3.1 Technical Data Model: Provider: Power supply: Main memory: Processor: Instalation / mouting:
SIMATIC Microbox IPC427C Siemens AG 24VDC 4 GB DDR3-SDRAM SODIMM Intel Pentium Core 2 Duo 1.2 GHz, 800 MHz FSB, 3 MB SLC DIN rail
4.3.2 Basic software Microsoft Windows Embedded 5.1 Microsoft IIS 5.1 Java RTE 6 Microsoft SQL Server Express 2005 or 2008 Microsoft .NET Framework 1.1 / 2.0 SP2 / 3.0 SP2 / 3.5 SP1 Microsoft ASP.NET 2.0 Ajax extensions 1.0 SIMATIC NET V6.3 Smart Monitor – TMDS software V 2.16 Microsoft IE 7.0 (other internet browsers are compatible).
© Siemens 2012. E T TR TLM.
Hardware 4-5
SIEMENS
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide 810-1733-00 Rev A
Corporate Office: +1 (800) 880-2552 Technical Support: +1 (866) 273-7763 E-mail:
[email protected] Copyright © 2006 Serveron Corporation All rights reserved
Serveron, TrueGas, and LoadGuide are registered trademarks of Serveron Corporation. All other trademarks, registered trademarks, service marks, and trade names are the property of their respective owners.
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Table of Contents Customer Information............................................................................................................................................ 3 Transformer Information ................................................................................................................................................ 4 Transformer Oil ................................................................................................................................................................ 4 Required Photographs..................................................................................................................................................... 4
Product Overview................................................................................................................................................... 5 Environmental Conditions .................................................................................................................................... 6 Items Needed for Installation................................................................................................................................ 7 Configured Items ............................................................................................................................................................. 8 Optional Accessories ....................................................................................................................................................... 8
Site Preparation Procedure .................................................................................................................................... 9 Choosing an Oil Supply and Return Port...................................................................................................... 10 Oil Supply Port............................................................................................................................................................... 10 Bleed Fixture/Oil Return Port...................................................................................................................................... 11
Choosing a Mounting Location....................................................................................................................... 12 Mounting Stand.............................................................................................................................................................. 12 Mounting the Stand to a Concrete Pad ....................................................................................................................... 12 Transformer or Wall Mounting.................................................................................................................................... 13 Mounting to the Transformer or Wall......................................................................................................................... 13
Providing power ............................................................................................................................................... 13 Determining need for Oil Inlet Cooler ........................................................................................................... 14 Choosing a Communication Interface & Protocol........................................................................................ 14 Connections - Power, Sensor and Communication cables .......................................................................... 15 LoadGuide.......................................................................................................................................................... 16 Oil Moisture and Temperature (optional) ..................................................................................................... 16 Helium Cylinder ............................................................................................................................................... 16 Ordering Helium............................................................................................................................................... 16 Ordering Stainless Steel Tubing and Required Fittings .............................................................................. 17 Site Checklist...................................................................................................................................................... 18 Appendix................................................................................................................................................................ 19 GAS-Guard Dimensions .................................................................................................................................. 19 Concrete Pad Layout ........................................................................................................................................ 20 Wire Termination Drawing ............................................................................................................................. 21 Helium Specification and Ordering Information ......................................................................................... 22 Helium Suppliers ........................................................................................................................................................... 22
Tubing Specification and Ordering Information .......................................................................................... 23 Tubing Suppliers ............................................................................................................................................................ 23
Shipping Containers ......................................................................................................................................... 24
1 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Table of Figures Figure 1: Oil circulation and gas extraction schematic ...................................................................................... 5 Figure 2: Installation schematic............................................................................................................................. 9 Figure 3: Oil Supply Port Assy............................................................................................................................ 10 Figure 4: Installed bleed fixture .......................................................................................................................... 11 Figure 5: GAS-Guard and mounting stand ....................................................................................................... 12 Figure 6: GAS-Guard wall mount....................................................................................................................... 13 Figure 7: Junction Box panel................................................................................................................................ 15 Figure 8: Overall dimensions .............................................................................................................................. 19 Figure 9: Concrete pad dimensions .................................................................................................................... 20 Figure 10: Wire termination drawing................................................................................................................. 21 Figure 11: Shipping containers............................................................................................................................ 24
Table of Tables Table 1: Customer information form.................................................................................................................... 3 Table 2: Transformer information form ............................................................................................................... 4 Table 3: Transformer oil information form.......................................................................................................... 4 Table 4: Required photographs checklist............................................................................................................. 4 Table 5: Items shipped............................................................................................................................................ 7 Table 6: Configured Items...................................................................................................................................... 8 Table 7: Optional Accessories................................................................................................................................ 8
2 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Customer Information In order to facilitate installation of your GAS-Guard, please fill out the following customer information form and mail, fax, or e-mail it to: mail:
Serveron Corporation Attn: Customer Support 3305 NW Aloclek Hillsboro, OR 97124 USA
fax:
+1 (503) 924-3290
e-mail:
[email protected] Customer Information
Company Installation Site Site Address City
State
Zip
Country
State
Zip
Country
Primary Contact Title Address City Phone
Mobile
Fax
Email
Pager
Secondary Contact Title Address City
State
Zip
Phone
Mobile
Fax
Email
Country Pager
Table 1: Customer information form
3 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Transformer Information Make:
Type:
Year:
Years in Service:
kVA Rating:
kV Rating:
conservator
nitrogen blanketed
other:
Total Dissolved Gas (ppm): (sum of all measured gases, including nitrogen)
attach all available DGA data Table 2: Transformer information form
Transformer Oil gallons
Oil Capacity:
liters
Manufacturer: Certified PCB free:
/
Type:
yes
/
no Table 3: Transformer oil information form
Required Photographs Attach photographs of the following items and illustrate them in the space provided:
Oil Supply Port
Note thread size and units of measure:
Oil Return Port
Note thread size and units of measure:
Control Panel
Mounting location of GAS-Guard
Table 4: Required photographs checklist
4 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Product Overview This section describes the basic operational essentials for the Siemens GAS-Guard and the most common methods of collecting data. The GAS-Guard technology from Siemens is a remotely deployed laboratory grade gas chromatograph which can be safely installed on an energized or non-energized transformer. The purpose of this Gas-Guard is to detect and measure fault gases found in electrical power transformer‘s insulating oil. The GAS-Guard is designed and constructed to resist environmental conditions relevant to a transformer substation. The GAS-Guard is a precision device. The heart of the GAS-Guard is a specially constructed gas chromatograph designed to measure fault gases. Siemens offers two versions of products, application dependant. The GAS-Guard 8 measures eight IEEE recommend fault gaseshydrogen (H2), oxygen (O2), carbon dioxide (CO2), carbon monoxide (CO), methane (CH4), ethylene (C2H4), ethane (C2H6), and acetylene (C2H2). The GAS-Guard 3 measures the three Duval Triangle fault gases- methane (CH4), ethylene (C2H4), and acetylene (C2H2). The GASGuard may be used on conservator or nitrogen blanketed transformers; however, in all cases the sample of gas is extracted directly from the oil within the transformer. Oil is circulated from the transformer to the GAS-Guard, and then returned to the transformer through ¼-inch O.D. stainless steel tubing. Stainless steel tubing is used in conjunction with compression fittings to minimize the risk of leaks. The GAS-Guard is outfitted with an internal gas extraction system which removes dissolved gases from the circulating transformer oil. Helium is used as a carrier gas to help transport the extracted sample gases through the gas chromatograph. The oil circulation and gas extraction paths in the GAS-Guard are shown below. Data is collected in the GAS-Guard each time a gas chromatograph (GC) analysis is completed. The GC analysis takes approximately 40 minutes. Once an analysis has been completed, the optional Serveron Monitoring Service (SMS) or GAS-Guard View software can be used to view the GAS-Guard’s data. The GAS-Guard is set up to perform a sample analysis once every four hours (default). All data captured during an analysis is stored on compact flash memory within the GAS-Guard. The compact flash memory holds approximately (2) years of data. The GASGuard View software or Serveron Monitoring Service (SMS) will allow the end user to track the gas ppm levels over time and monitor the gas levels against user defined caution and alarm settings. The GAS-Guard includes Ambient Temperature and LoadGuide® sensing devices. An optional Oil Moisture and Temperature sensor is available along with spare 4-20ma inputs for use with other external devices. External sensor information can also be correlated with fault gas information to allow a Oil Gas Gas Chromatograph Side Side complete diagnostic overview of the transformer’s condition. Gas supply to GC
Gas supply to GC
Gas Extractor Unit
Oil Return to Transformer Oil Supply from Transformer
Figure 1: Oil circulation and gas extraction schematic 5 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Environmental Conditions The GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 are designed to operate within the following outdoor conditions: Altitude up to 4572 m
Humidity Range 5% to 95%
Temperature Range -50C to 55C
Installation Category II
Pollution Degree 2
Please note that the altitude, humidity, and temperature ranges indicated are considered extended environmental conditions from the minimum ranges required by UL 61010-1, Clause 1.4.1.
6 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Items Needed for Installation Upon receipt of your GAS-Guard it is important to verify the contents of the shipping carton with the packing list. Inspect the contents Please notify Siemens directly if there are any signs of damage that may have occurred in transit. Part #
Description
140-0170-XX
Sunshield
250-0130-XX
(2) In-line Oil Filters, 1/4” SS Swagelok
250-0144-XX
(2) Nut and Ferrule Set, 1/4” OD, SS
252-0013-XX
(3) 10-32 Nut
253-0066-XX
(6) 10-32x3/8” Screw
254-0075-XX
(1) 1/4” Lock Washer
270-0004-XX
(1) Helium Dryer, Q5 Copper Catalyst (GAS-Guard 8 only)
290-0017-XX
(1) Verification gas cylinder (GAS-Guard 8 only) OR
290-0021-XX
(1) Verification gas cylinder (GAS-Guard 3 only) Note: The verification gas cylinder is shipped separately from the GAS-Guard because of UN1956 classified non-flammable gas shipping requirements and may ship at a later date depending upon installation.
291-0014-XX
(2) Helium Dryer Mounting Clips (GAS-Guard 8 only)
292-0018-XX
(1) Helium Regulator, high purity, for cylinder valve type CGA-580
300-0004-XX
(1) LoadGuide, Current Transformer
456-0022-XX
(1) Valve, Oil Return Assy.
456-0023-XX
(1) Valve, Sample Port / Secondary Shutoff Assy.
456-0026-XX
(1) Oil Supply Port Assy.
610-0110-XX
(1) Cable, 14’, RJ45, 8 Cond.
610-0121-XX
(1) Adapter Assy., RS232
750-0088-XX
(1) 10” Helium Supply Line (GAS-Guard 8 only)
750-0089-XX
(1) 120” Helium Supply Line
900-0080-00
(1) GAS-Guard 8 (115V) OR
900-0081-00
(1) GAS-Guard 3 (115V) OR
900-0083-00
(1) GAS-Guard 8 (230V) OR
900-0084-00
(1) GAS-Guard 3 (230V)
900-0053-XX
(1) Bleed Fixture
910-0025-XX
(1) GAS-Guard Software CD (English) •
Includes User’s Manual, Site Prep, Install, Ops & Maintenance Guides
Table 5: Items shipped
7 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Configured Items Part #
Description
900-0064-XX
(1) Kit, Junction Box with Cables OR
900-0059-XX
(1) Junction Box
610-0179-XX
(1) AC Power Cable (black 3-wire)
610-0180-XX
(1) Sensor Cable (black)
610-0181-XX
(1) Communication Cable (gray)
900-0063-XX
(1) Kit, External 23 ft. Cables
610-0182-XX
(1) AC Power Cable 23 ft. (black 3-wire)
610-0183-XX
(1) Sensor Cable, 23 ft. (black)
610-0184-XX
(1) Communication Cable, 23 ft. (gray)
900-0057-XX
(1) Transformer Pad Mount OR
900-0066-XX
(1) Transformer Tank Mount
Table 6: Configured Items
Optional Accessories Part #
Description
900-0082-XX
Kit , Oil Moisture and Temperature Sensor
900-0058-XX
Oil Inlet Cooler
900-0060-XX
GSM Cellular Modem, USA
900-0085-XX
GSM Cellular Modem, Europe
900-0062-XX
Kit, Fiber Optic Ethernet
900-0067-XX
Kit, Wireless Radio, Serial
Table 7: Optional Accessories
8 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Site Preparation Procedure Site Preparation consists of the completing the following steps:
Choosing an oil supply and return port
Choosing a mounting location
Providing power
Determining need for (optional) Oil Inlet Cooler
Choosing a communication interface & protocol
Communication/Power/Sensor Cable Connections
LoadGuide
Moisture and Oil Temperature sensor (optional)
Ordering Helium
Ordering stainless steel tubing
Site Checklist
Figure 2: Installation schematic
9 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Choosing an Oil Supply and Return Port The GAS-Guard removes oil from the transformer, analyzes the oil, and then returns the oil to the transformer. The locations where the oil is removed (oil supply port) and returned (oil return port) are vital for the accurate analysis of the gases within your transformer. Typically, oil is removed at the top of the transformer, and returned at the bottom of the transformer. The location of the oil supply port should produce a sample that is a well-mixed representation of the transformer oil. In this section we will discuss how to select the locations and what fittings are required. CAUTION: Maximum Oil Inlet Pressure to the GAS-Guard is 45 psi (3 bar)
Oil Supply Port An Oil Supply Assy, part # 456-0026-XX, is provided with the GAS-Guard. The assembly consists of a 2” black iron tee, 2” x ½” reducing bushing, ½” plug, ½”ball valve, and a ½”NPT x ¼”Tube fitting (see figure 3). The assembly is integral to the installation and commissioning process to help remove air and bubbles from entering into the transformer tank when the transformer oil supply port is opened. It is important to sample oil from a location on the tank where the oil is constantly mixing in order to provide a well-mixed representation of oil within the transformer. Typically a top tank valve is used for the oil supply. For Nitrogen blanketed transformers the oil supply port must be at least 6” below the transformer’s oil level at all times. If the optional Moisture and Oil Temperature sensor is to be installed, please refer to the Moisture and Oil Temperature Sensor section below for additional configuration of the oil supply port. 1)
Select an appropriate oil supply port on the transformer
2)
Verify the port valve is closed and remove any plugs or caps securing the end of the port
3)
Thoroughly clean the inside of the port of any residue or pipe sealing compound
4)
Determine the thread size of the selected oil supply port
5)
Purchase the necessary nipple and reducing bushing, as required to mount the 2” Oil Supply Assy, part # 456-0026-XX. Note: Depending on the Oil Supply Port valve size, alternate parts can be purchased instead of using the 2” assembly provided. If parts are purchased for the transformer valve size, they must be black iron, brass or stainless steel and the street side to the tee should be ½” NPT.
6)
Install nipple and reducing bushing as required to the oil supply port using Teflon tape or pipe dope. Note: It is important for the street side of the tee be oriented in the vertical direction
Siemens does not recommend sampling oil from cooling loops or pressurized oil passages; doing so may void the warranty.
Figure 3: Oil Supply Port Assy
10 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Bleed Fixture/Oil Return Port Typically the bottom drain valve is used for the oil return port. The return port should not be located on the transformer cooling system or any pressurized oil passage. An air bleed fixture and bubble trap is required at the oil return port to allow air removal during commissioning of the GAS-Guard. This fixture is referred to as a “Bleed Fixture.” The Bleed Fixture assembly is included with the GAS-Guard. 1)
Select an appropriate oil return port on the transformer
2)
Verify the port valve is closed and remove any plugs or caps closing the end of the port
3)
Thoroughly clean the inside of the port of any residue or pipe sealing compound
4)
Determine the thread size of the selected oil return port
5)
Acquire necessary fittings to attach the bleed fixture to the oil return port Note: The Bleed Fixture is designed to fit on a 2” NPT nipple. When using the Bleed Fixture, adapt the oil return port to accommodate a 2”NPT female thread.
6)
Secure the bleed fixture to the oil return port using Teflon tape or pipe dope Siemens does not recommend sampling oil from cooling loops or pressurized oil passages; doing so may void the warranty.
Oil Return Assy Part # 456-0022-XX
Figure 4: Installed bleed fixture
11 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Choosing a Mounting Location The GAS-Guard should be located in a position where it will not interfere with transformer maintenance or access requirements. The front of the GAS-Guard must be accessible for commissioning and maintenance. There at two types of mounting types for the GAS-Guards; pedestal mounting stand or transformer mounting kit. Items to consider when choosing a location for the GAS-Guard are:
Location of oil supply and oil return ports
Location of power supply
Transformer maintenance points
Access to the GAS-Guard
Mounting of the GAS-Guard stand The GAS-Guard must be mounted and operated in an upright position. Failure to do so will void the warranty.
Mounting Stand The Mounting Stand is a post style, requiring some assembly, and is intended to be mounted to a concrete pad. The hardware required for assembly and fastening to the concrete pad are included. Figure 5 illustrates a typical mounting. See the appendix for mounting and layout dimensions. For stand assembly, refer to the GAS-Guard Installation Guide, part # 810-1732-XX.
Mounting the Stand to a Concrete Pad 1)
Position the stand in the predetermined mounting location
2)
Using the stand as a template, mark four holes onto the concrete pad
3)
Remove the stand and drill four 3/8-inch x 3-inch deep holes in the marked locations
4)
Insert the four 3/8-inch concrete anchors included with the stand into the holes
5)
Position the stand over the four mounting bolts and secure the stand checking to make sure the stand is plumb and level
6)
Tighten retaining nuts/concrete anchors
Figure 5: GAS-Guard and mounting stand
12 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Transformer or Wall Mounting The transformer mounting kit includes the necessary hardware to mount the GAS-Guard, junction box, helium dyer and helium cylinder to unistrut (unistrut is not included). Siemens recommends using 1, 5/8-inch deep channel unistrut. To mount the GAS-Guard and its components a quantity of two 4-foot lengths of unistrut are required. The figures below are examples of tank and wall mount applications.
Mounting to the Transformer or Wall 1)
The bottom rung of unistrut must be mounted a. A minimum of 40-inches from grade if the helium cylinder will be secured to the unistrut. b. A minimum of 12-inches above grade or water threat if helium will not be secured to the unistrut.
2)
Secure the bottom unistrut rung in the predetermined mounting location in accordance with the appropriate height suggested in item 1.
3)
Measure up from the center of the bottom rung 19.85-inches and mark the mounting location for the second rung.
4)
Secure the top unistrut rung.
SIEMENS GAS-Guard 8
Figure 6: GAS-Guard wall mount
Providing power The GAS-Guard has a built-in AC to DC power converter and surge protector capable of utilizing 115 or 230 VAC ± 15% (50/60Hz); 6A max. @ 115 V; 3A max @ 230V. NOTE: Siemens recommends installing a properly rated and marked switch or circuit breaker in close proximity to the GAS-Guard as a mains voltage disconnect device.
13 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Determining need for Oil Inlet Cooler The GAS-Guard operates with transformer inlet oil temperatures ranging between 0°C to +55°C. If your transformer oil temperature frequently deviates outside of this range please notify the Siemens technical support team for assistance in determining whether or not an Oil Inlet Cooler is needed.
Choosing a Communication Interface & Protocol The GAS-Guard offers a range of communication options. The GAS-Guard can communicate over multiple interfaces and protocols simultaneously. The different communication options are as follows:
Internal modem - connects to any standard analog phone line (POTS).
RS-232 - connection is provided to allow serial communications with an external computer as well as interface to a cellular or external modem.
RS-485 - connection is provided.
Ethernet – connection can be configured as DHCP or a static IP address. The GAS-Guard is supplied with a copper interface. A fiber optic interface kit can be purchased using part # 900-0062-XX.
Modbus or DNP3 – connection can be configured over all hardware interfaces including Ethernet, RS-232, RS-485, and modem. For more information regarding these protocols, please contact Technical Support. An active communication channel is required for Serveron Monitoring Service (SMS) or to enable Siemens access for remote calibration and troubleshooting. All communications require an authenticated username and password.
14 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Connections - Power, Sensor and Communication cables The standard GAS-Guard package includes (3) short cables used in conjunction with the Junction Box. If longer cables are required, 23 ft cables can be purchased as an option using part # 900-0063-XX. Typically these cables are terminated at the junction box terminal strip that is included with the standard GAS-Guard package or at the transformer control cabinet. If the junction box was not purchased, a terminal strip will be required for cable termination. A 27position terminal strip is recommended for flexibility of wiring connections. Depending on the wiring connections used, a larger terminal strip maybe required. See the appendix for the recommended wiring diagram. Cable names and part numbers;
Power Cable, (black 3-wire) #610-0179-XX or #610-0182-XX 115 to 230 VAC ± 15% (50/60Hz) 6A max @ 115 V; 3A max @ 230V
Communications Cable, (gray) #610-0181-XX or #610-0184-XX Modem
Junction Box
RS-232 RS-485 Auxiliary 12VDC, 1A max. (isolated)
Sensor Cable, (black) #610-0180-XX or #610-0183-XX LoadGuide (Transformer Load) Programmable Relay (NO/NC/C) Power Relay (NO/NC/C) (3) 4-20mA inputs (2 used for optional Oil Moisture and Temperature) Helium Pressure Switch (optional with regulator) Figure 7: Junction Box panel
15 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
LoadGuide The GAS-Guard LoadGuide can be used to correlate transformer load to transformer gassing. The LoadGuide sensor consists of a current clamp that is placed over a 0 to 5 amp high or low side CT. It is important that the CT give a good representation of total transformer load. Transformer load will be displayed on a relative scale with 0 indicating no load and 100% indicating full load. The standard cable length is 8 ft. Additional cable of 22 AWG or larger can be added to the LoadGuide sensor cable if required.
Oil Moisture and Temperature (optional) An optional sensor is available to provide oil moisture in parts per million (ppm) or as percent relative saturation (%RS) and oil temperature (°C). Depending on the location of the sensor, the oil temperature can be representative of top oil temperature. It is recommended the Oil Moisture and Temperature Sensor be installed on the top valve of the transformer. The necessary adapters are provided with the moisture sensor to install the moisture sensor at the Oil Supply Assy. If the moisture sensor will be installed in an alternative location, a reducing bushing made from black iron, brass, or stainless steel may be required.
Helium Cylinder The helium gas cylinder should be securely mounted to the GAS-Guard mounting stand or some other permanent surface. A mounting bracket that meets all compressed gas cylinder restraining requirements is provided. Siemens also provides the necessary 1/8-inch O.D. SStubing to connect the helium cylinder to the GAS-Guard.
Ordering Helium Helium carrier gas is vital to the performance of the chromatograph within the GAS-Guard. Using helium that does not meet the described specifications will substantially reduce the life of the GAS-Guard and void the warranty. See the appendix for ordering information.
16 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Ordering Stainless Steel Tubing and Required Fittings Stainless steel tubing is used to connect the GAS-Guard to the transformer for circulating the transformer oil for measurement. The amount of tubing you will need to purchase is based on the location of your GAS-Guard in relation to the valves on your transformer. Note: Stainless steel is the only material that should be used. The use of any other tubing material will void the warranty of your GAS-Guard. It is recommended that the tubing between the transformer and the GAS-Guard be installed as one continuous piece, reducing the possibility of oil leaks. Listed below are items to consider when choosing where to route the tubing to the GAS-Guard:
Make sure tubing will not interfere with regular maintenance of the transformer
Avoid long unsupported tubing runs
Route tubing so that it will not be tripped over or damaged by activities in the vicinity of the transformer
If the length of the oil supply or return path exceeds 20-feet, a 1/4-inch stainless steel union will have to be purchased and on site at the time of installation
It is recommended that your tubing be secured every 2~4-feet using stainless steel cable ties or other adequate clamps
Carefully measure the predetermined tubing route from the transformer oil supply port to the GAS-Guard. Take into consideration any corners or other obstacles that may add to the overall length of tubing. Tubing is typically supplied in 20-foot lengths and will require a union if any section exceeds 20-feet. Determine the number of 20-foot lengths and unions required for the installation. If the overall tubing length exceeds 50-feet “supply and return” contact Siemens for assistance. Tubing and fittings must be on site the day of installation. See the appendix for ordering information.
17 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Site Checklist The following is a checklist that will help ensure that all the proper steps have been completed.
Customer Information form filled out and returned to Siemens A location for mounting the GAS-Guard has been identified, and the GAS-Guard mounting stand is secured in place
The transformer oil supply valve (GAS-Guard oil supply port) and the transformer oil return valve (GAS-Guard oil return port) have been selected
Bleed fixture and oil supply fittings installed (additional fittings required if Oil Moisture sensor is to be installed)
Power is present and available at the installation site for the GAS-Guard Communication is available to the GAS-Guard A cylinder of chromatographic grade helium (99.9999% pure with < 0.2 ppm of H2O) has been purchased and is on location
A 0-5 Amp CT has been identified for the LoadGuide sensor All shipped items and optional accessories have been located Electrical conduit and enclosures have been installed (as required)
18 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Appendix GAS-Guard Dimensions
Figure 8: Overall dimensions
19 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Concrete Pad Layout
Figure 9: Concrete pad dimensions
20 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Wire Termination Drawing
Notes:
(Red) He Pressure Switch(optional) Helium NC
4-20mA Input Channel 2 Sensor Cable (black) PN # 610-0180-00 (3.5ft) PN # 610-0183-00 (23ft)
4-20mA Input Channel 1 4-20mA Input Channel 3 LoadGuide Programmable Relay
From Analyzer
Power Relay
RS232 Communication Cable (gray) PN # 610-0181-00 (3.5ft) PN # 610-0184-00 (23ft) RS485
Internal Modem 12V@1A AC Power Cable (black 3-wire) PN # 610-0179-00 (2ft) PN # 610-0182-00 (23ft) Communication Cable Violet - Not Used White - Not Used
1
GND (White/Red) SGND (Black) +24vdc (Violet) Input (White/Violet) +24vdc (Orange) Input (White/Orange) +24vdc (White) Input (White/Black/BRN) LoadGuide (Brown) AGND (Blue) COM (Yellow) NC (Grey) NO (Green) COM(White/Yellow) NC (White/Grey) NO (White/Green) TXD (Yellow) RXD (White/Yellow) RTS(Green) CTS (White/Green) DCD(White/Violet) DSR (WhiteGrey) RI (White/Red) DTR(Grey) GND(White/Black) TXA (-) (White/Brown) TXB (+) (Brown) RCVA (-) (White/Orange) RCVB (+) (Orange) GND (White/Black/BRN) RING (Blue) TIP (White/Blue) +12V (Red) 12V GND (Black)
2 3 4 5 User Defined
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Communications Input/Outputs
13 14 15 User Defined
16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
LINE (Brown)
25
NEUTRAL (Blue)
26
EARTH GND (Green/Yellow)
27
AUX 12VDC Output
AC Power
Sensor Cable White/Black - Not Connected White/Brown - Not Connected White/Blue - Not Connected
Figure 10: Wire termination drawing
21 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Helium Specification and Ordering Information Helium Specification:
99.9999% pure, Chromatographic or Research Grade NO MORE than 0.2ppm H2O
Cylinder Size:
49.6-liter water capacity 9 inches x 60 inches including cap
Depending on vendor, cylinder size is indicated by:
300, 049, 49, 1L, A, K, T or UT
Cylinder Material:
High-pressure steel
Cylinder Valve Type:
CGA 580
Table 8: Helium specification and ordering information
Use of helium other than 99.9999% pure research grade or chromatographic grade with less than 0.2-ppm H2O content will greatly decrease the life of the GAS-Guard system components and VOID the warranty.
Helium Suppliers (800) 772-9247
www.praxair.com
When ordering, please specify part number HE 6.0 RS – T. (323) 568-2201
www.airgas.com
When ordering, please specify part number HER – 300-CT.
Table 9: Helium suppliers
22 of 24
810-1733-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
Tubing Specification and Ordering Information Specification:
1/4-inch OD x 0.028 (or 0.035) wall T316 seamless steel tubing.
Order Information:
Purchase in 20-foot lengths
Table 10: Tubing specification and ordering information Contact tubing suppliers for tube unions.
Stainless steel is the only material that should be used with the GASGuard; the use of any other tubing material will VOID the warranty of your GAS-Guard.
Tubing Suppliers www.swagelok.com See website for local sales contact number
Table 11: Tubing suppliers
23 of 24
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Site Preparation Guide
810-1733-00 Rev A
Shipping Containers GAS-Guard
Figure 11: Shipping containers
24 of 24
SIEMENS
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Installation Guide 810-1732-00 Rev A
Corporate Office: +1 (800) 880-2552 Technical Support: +1 (866) 273-7763 E-mail:
[email protected] Copyright © 2006 Serveron Corporation All rights reserved
Serveron, TrueGas, and LoadGuide are registered trademarks of Serveron Corporation. All other trademarks, registered trademarks, service marks, and trade names are the property of their respective owners.
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Table of Contents Product Overview ...................................................................................................................................................4 Product Symbols......................................................................................................................................................5 Environmental Conditions .....................................................................................................................................6 Items Needed for Installation ................................................................................................................................7 Items Shipped ................................................................................................................................................................... 8 Configured Items.............................................................................................................................................................. 9 Optional Accessories........................................................................................................................................................ 9
Preparatory Tasks for Installation ...................................................................................................................10 Site Preparation Guide Checklist ................................................................................................................................. 10
Installation Procedures .........................................................................................................................................11 Stand Mounting and Assembly .......................................................................................................................12 Stand Post Mounting ..................................................................................................................................................... 12 Assembling the Stand .................................................................................................................................................... 13 Junction Box Mounting.................................................................................................................................................. 14 Oil Cooler (Optional) ..................................................................................................................................................... 15
Mounting the GAS-Guard................................................................................................................................16 Mounting with the Transformer Pad Mount Stand................................................................................................... 16 Mounting without the Transformer Pad Mount Stand............................................................................................. 17 Attaching the Sunshield ................................................................................................................................................ 17
Oil Connections..................................................................................................................................................18 Inline Oil Filters .............................................................................................................................................................. 18 Oil Plumbing................................................................................................................................................................... 19
Top-Oil Moisture/Temperature (optional)....................................................................................................21 Oil Transmitter Unit Mounting .................................................................................................................................... 22
Gas Connections ................................................................................................................................................23 Helium Gas Cylinder and Dryer Mounting (GAS-Guard 8 only) ........................................................................... 23 Verification Gas Cylinder.............................................................................................................................................. 25
Cable Connections .............................................................................................................................................26 Power Cable, (black 3-wire) 610-0179-00 2-ft/610-0182-00 23-ft.............................................................................. 26 Sensor Cable, (black) 610-0180-00 3.5-ft/610-0183-00 23-ft....................................................................................... 26 Communication Cable, (gray) 610-0181-00 3.5-ft/610-0184-00 23-ft ....................................................................... 27
External Sensors.................................................................................................................................................28 Oil Moisture and Temperature Connections.............................................................................................................. 28 Ambient Temperature ................................................................................................................................................... 28 LoadGuide (750-0058-XX) ............................................................................................................................................. 28
Relays ..................................................................................................................................................................29 Mounting Stand Assembly Drawing ..............................................................................................................30 Installation Checklist.........................................................................................................................................31 Forms.......................................................................................................................................................................32 Verification Cylinder Data Sheet.....................................................................................................................32
2 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Table of Figures Figure 1: Installation schematic ...........................................................................................................................11 Figure 2: Stand Post...............................................................................................................................................12 Figure 3: Stand Assembly.....................................................................................................................................13 Figure 4: Junction Box Installation ......................................................................................................................14 Figure 5: Oil Cooler mounting.............................................................................................................................15 Figure 6: GAS-Guard mounting ..........................................................................................................................16 Figure 7: Sunshield mounting..............................................................................................................................17 Figure 8: Oil Filter Housing .................................................................................................................................18 Figure 9: Bleed Fixture and Siemens Oil Return Valve ....................................................................................19 Figure 10: Sample port/Secondary Shutoff Assy. ............................................................................................20 Figure 11: Top-Oil (Moisture/Temperature) Sensor Fixture ..........................................................................21 Figure 12: Transmitter Unit..................................................................................................................................22 Figure 13: Mounting Base.....................................................................................................................................22 Figure 14: Helium Dryer.......................................................................................................................................23 Figure 15: Helium Regulator................................................................................................................................24 Figure 16: Installed Verification Cylinder..........................................................................................................25 Figure 17: Wiring Terminations...........................................................................................................................27
Table of Tables Table 1: Product Symbols .......................................................................................................................................5 Table 2: Items Shipped............................................................................................................................................8 Table 3: Configured Items ......................................................................................................................................9 Table 4: Optional Accessories ................................................................................................................................9 Table 5: Oil Moisture and Temperature connections .......................................................................................28 Table 6: Verification cylinder datasheet .............................................................................................................32
3 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Product Overview The Siemens GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 are on-line laboratory-grade gas chromatographs which can safely be installed on an energized or non-energized transformer. The GAS-Guard detects and measures fault gases found in the oil of power transformers. The GAS-Guard is designed and constructed to resist the environmental conditions typical of a power substation or generation facility.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to install your Siemens GAS-Guard until you have read and fully understand the procedures outlined in this document.
4 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Product Symbols The following symbols are used throughout the GAS-Guard or accessories. They are defined by the International Electrotechnical Commission, IEC 878 and IEC 417A. It is important for safety reasons to have an understanding of their representation.
Voltage Output Voltage Input Fuse High Voltage Caution: Refer to GAS-Guard Installation Guide and accompanying documentation. Protective earth (ground)
V~ H L __I__ O
Alternating Current and Voltage Connect to mains live conductor (brown) Connect to mains neutral conductor (blue) The I position indicates the power switch is ON The O position indicates the power switch is OFF This device has been tested and certified by the Canadian Standards Association International to comply with applicable U.S. and Canadian safety standards. Table 1: Product Symbols
WARNING statements in this manual identify conditions or practices that could result in personal injury. CAUTION statements in this manual identify conditions or practices that could result in damage to the equipment or other property. NOTE statements provide additional important information.
5 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Environmental Conditions The GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 are designed to operate within the following outdoor conditions: Altitude up to 4572 m Humidity Range 5% to 95% Temperature Range -50C to 55C Installation Category II Pollution Degree 2 Please note that the altitude, humidity, and temperature ranges indicated are considered extended environmental conditions from the minimum ranges required by UL 61010-1, Clause 1.4.1.
6 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Items Needed for Installation Note: As each transformer is different, some items may need to be provided by the installer. Upon receipt of your GAS-Guard it is important to verify the contents of the shipping carton with the packing list. Inspect the contents for any sign of damage that may have occurred in transit. Please notify Siemens directly if there are any concerns. For return shipping instructions please see the Operation and Maintenance Guide (Part # 810-1734-XX).
7 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Items Shipped Part #
Description
140-0170-XX
Sunshield
250-0130-XX
(2) In-line Oil Filters, 1/4” SS Swagelok
250-0144-XX
(2) Nut and Ferrule Set, 1/4” OD, SS
252-0013-XX
(3) 10-32 Nut
253-0066-XX
(6) 10-32x3/8” Screw
254-0075-XX
(1) 1/4” Lock Washer
270-0004-XX
(1) Helium Dryer, Q5 Copper Catalyst (GAS-Guard 8 only)
290-0017-XX
(1) Verification gas cylinder (GAS-Guard 8 only) OR
290-0021-XX
(1) Verification gas cylinder (GAS-Guard 3 only) Note: The verification gas cylinder is shipped separately from the GAS-Guard because of UN1956 classified non-flammable gas shipping requirements and may ship at a later date depending upon installation.
291-0014-XX
(2) Helium Dryer Mounting Clips (GAS-Guard 8 only)
292-0018-XX
(1) Helium Regulator, high purity, for cylinder valve type CGA-580
300-0004-XX
(1) LoadGuide, Current Transformer
456-0022-XX
(1) Valve, Oil Return Assy.
456-0023-XX
(1) Valve, Sample Port / Secondary Shutoff Assy.
456-0026-XX
(1) Oil Supply Port Assy.
610-0110-XX
(1) Cable, 14’, RJ45, 8 Cond.
610-0121-XX
(1) Adapter Assy., RS232
750-0088-XX
(1) 10” Helium Supply Line (GAS-Guard 8 only)
750-0089-XX
(1) 120” Helium Supply Line
900-0080-00
(1) GAS-Guard 8 (115V) OR
900-0081-00
(1) GAS-Guard 3 (115V) OR
900-0083-00
(1) GAS-Guard 8 (230V) OR
900-0084-00
(1) GAS-Guard 3 (230V)
900-0053-XX
(1) Bleed Fixture
910-0025-XX
(1) GAS-Guard Software CD (English) •
Includes User’s Manual, Site Prep, Install, Ops & Maintenance Guides
Table 2: Items Shipped
8 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Configured Items Part #
Description
900-0064-XX
(1) Kit, Junction Box with Cables OR
900-0059-XX
(1) Junction Box
610-0179-XX
(1) AC Power Cable (black 3-wire)
610-0180-XX
(1) Sensor Cable (black)
610-0181-XX
(1) Communication Cable (gray)
900-0063-XX
(1) Kit, External 23 ft. Cables
610-0182-XX
(1) AC Power Cable 23 ft. (black 3-wire)
610-0183-XX
(1) Sensor Cable, 23 ft. (black)
610-0184-XX
(1) Communication Cable, 23 ft. (gray)
900-0057-XX
(1) Transformer Pad Mount OR
900-0066-XX
(1) Transformer Tank Mount
Table 3: Configured Items
Optional Accessories Part #
Description
900-0058-XX
Oil Inlet Cooler
900-0060-XX
GSM Cellular Modem, USA
900-0085-XX
GSM Cellular Modem, Europe
900-0062-XX
Kit, Fiber Optic Ethernet
900-0067-XX
Kit, Wireless Radio, Serial
900-0082-XX
Kit , Oil Moisture and Temperature Sensor
Table 4: Optional Accessories
9 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Preparatory Tasks for Installation There are certain tasks that must be completed prior to installation of the GAS-Guard. These tasks are outlined in the “GAS-Guard Site Preparation Guide” that was sent to you upon acceptance of your order. Please review the Site Preparation Guide and ensure all items on the Site Preparation Guide checklist below have been completed.
Site Preparation Guide Checklist Customer Information form filled out and returned to Siemens A location for mounting the GAS-Guard has been identified. The transformer oil supply port (GAS-Guard oil supply port) has been selected The transformer oil return port (GAS-Guard oil return port) has been selected Confirm use of Siemens bleed fixture or customer has constructed their own bleed fixture Oil supply port fittings determined and provided. Additional fitting are required if Oil Moisture sensor will be installed.
Oil return port fittings determined and provided. Power is present and available at the installation site for the GAS-Guard Communication protocol (RS232, RS485, Ethernet, or Modem) selected A cylinder of chromatographic grade helium (99.9999% pure with < 0.2 ppm of H2O) has been purchased and is on location
A 0-5 Amp CT winding has been identified on the transformer for the LoadGuide sensor All shipped items and configurable accessories have been located Electrical conduit and enclosures have been installed (as required)
10 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Installation Procedures Installation consists of completing the following steps:
Stand Mounting and Assembly
Mounting the GAS-Guard
Oil Connections
Gas Connections
Cable Connections
External Sensors
Relays
Installation Checklist
Existing transformer valve (Oil Supply Port)
Oil Moisture and Temperature Sensor
Oil supply line to analyzer ¼" SS tubing
Serveron Supply/Sample Shutoff Port SampleOil Port/Secondary Valve Assy 456-0023-XX 456-0023-XX
Serveron Optional Oil Supply Port Secondary Oil Supply Assy. 456-0026-XX Valve 456-0024-XX
Transformer Tank
Helium Dryer 270-0004-XX Oil return line to transformer ¼" SS tubing
Serveron Bleed Bleed Fixture Fixture 900-0053-XX
Electrical Panel
900-0053-XX
Existing transformer valve (Oil Return Port)
Helium Tank & Regulator Serveron Oil Return Oil Return Assy. Assembly 456-0022-XX
456-0022-XX
Analyzer Stand Stand 900-0057-XX
AC ACPower Mainscable, power cable
Communications cable Communications
(Ethernet,phone) phone) (Ethernet,
Transformer Pad
Figure 1: Installation schematic
11 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Stand Mounting and Assembly The transformer pad mount stand is the preferred method of mounting the Siemens GAS-Guard. However if the GAS-Guard is going to be mounted to the transformer without the stand, an optional transformer tank mounting kit can be purchased from Siemens (Part # 900-0066-XX). If the transformer pad mount stand was not purchased please proceed to the “Mounting the GAS-Guard” section.
Stand Post Mounting 1)
Remove the stand post from the shipping container.
2)
Position the stand on the transformer pad. The mounting location should have been determined during completion of the “GAS-Guard Site Preparation Guide”
3)
Use the stand as a template and mark the four mounting holes onto the pad. Orientation of the four mounting holes is not important.
4)
Temporarily move the stand and using a hammer drill, drill a 3/8in x 3-in (7.6 cm) deep hole at each of the marked locations.
5)
Insert the four 3/8-in concrete anchors supplied with stand.
6)
Reposition the stand over the four anchors and install a flatwasher, split-washer and 3/8-in nut onto each of the four anchors and tighten evenly.
7)
Using a level verify the stand-post is within ±5˚ of plumb in all directions. Use 3/8-in stainless steel washers as spacers under the four corners if leveling is required.
Figure 2: Stand Post
12 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Assembling the Stand 1)
Locate stand hardware, items 2-through-16 (refer to the “Mounting Stand Assembly Drawing” in the back of the guide) and assemble the stand per the figure below.
2)
Attach (1) item 5, channel using (1) item 4, U-bolt assembly with (2) item 9, lock washer to the stand approx 3-in (7.6 cm) from the top. Using a 9/16-in deep socket and a level secure the items to stand without over-tightening ensuring the channel is ±5˚ of plumb. (Note: Over-tightening will crush the aluminum post.)
3)
On the back side of the stand, mark from the top of the U-bolt assembly 20-in down and attach (1) item 5, channel using (1) item 4, U-bolt assembly with (2) item 9, lock washer to post. (Note: Do not fully tighten the lower U-bolts to the stand until the GAS-Guard is installed and secured.)
4)
Attach (2) item 2, spring nut in top channel using (2) item 3, fully threaded bolt.
5)
Attach (2) item 2, spring nut in bottom channel.
6)
Attach (2) item 13, mounting strap using (4) items 14, 15 and 16, screw, lock washer and nut.
7)
Attach items 11 and 12, helium support bracket and strap using (4) items 6, 7 and 9 bolt, washer and nut.
Figure 3: Stand Assembly 8)
If the optional oil cooler was purchased proceed to the “Junction Box Mounting” section. If the oil cooler was not purchased continue with step (9).
9)
Position (1) 291-0014-XX helium dryer mounting clip provided with the Gas-Guard hardware to the outside mounting strap item 13, lower through hole. Attach the clip to the strap using (1) 253-0066-XX screw and (1) 252-0013-XX nut contained in the GAS-Guard hardware. (Note: If a Junction Box will not be installed, attach the second 291-0014-XX using (1) 253-0066-XX and (1) 252-0013-XX, to the second through hole from the top of item 13 outside mounting strap)
13 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Junction Box Mounting The junction box must be mounted prior to mounting the optional oil cooler or GAS-Guard. 1)
Remove the Junction Box from the shipping container taking care not to damage the cable glands protruding form the bottom of Junction Box.
2)
Attach the Junction Box to the stand mounting straps as illustrated in figure 4. Use the mounting hardware included with the Junction Box.
3)
Attach (1) helium dryer mounting clip 291-0014-XX using the Junction Box hardware to top right mounting position.
Figure 4: Junction Box Installation
14 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Oil Cooler (Optional) If the optional oil cooler was not purchased proceed to the next section “Mounting the GAS-Guard.” The optional cooler must be installed on the stand prior to mounting the GAS-Guard and helium dryer retaining clips. If you have purchased the transformer pad mount stand follow the instructions below. 1)
Remove the oil cooler from its shipping container and verify all parts are accounted for.
2)
Mount the oil cooler to the upper GAS-Guard stand mounting bolts. The oil cooler will be secured using the same hardware used to secure the GAS-Guard.
3)
Position (1) 291-0014-XX helium dryer mounting clip to the predrilled and tapped hole located on the upper right hand side of the cooler. Attach the clip to the cooler using (1) 253-0066-XX screw contained in the GAS-Guard hardware. Position (1) 291-0014-XX helium dryer mounting clip to the predrilled and tapped hole located on the lower right hand side of the cooler. Attach the clip using (1) 253-0066-XX screw contained in the GASGuard hardware. Discard (2) 252-0013-XX nuts contained in the GAS-Guard mounting hardware.
CAUTION: If the oil cooler will not be mounted to the transformer pad mount stand, the oil cooler must still be secured by the cooler frame. Oil line fittings and oil tubing can not support cooler weight.
Figure 5: Oil Cooler mounting
15 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Mounting the GAS-Guard CAUTION: The GAS-Guard must be mounted and operated in an upright position. Failure to do so will VOID the warranty.
Mounting with the Transformer Pad Mount Stand 1)
Remove the GAS-Guard from the shipping container taking care not to damage the ambient temperature sensor or cable glands protruding from the bottom of the GAS-Guard enclosure.
2)
Attach the GAS-Guard using the stand mounting bolts item 3 and secure with items 7 and 9, lock washer and nut provided with the stand hardware.
3)
Position the lower channel so the spring nuts are in-line with the GAS-Guard mounting tabs. Loosely secure the GAS-Guard using (2) items 6, 8 and 9, bolts, lock washer and washer to the spring nuts.
4)
Using a 9/16-in deep socket, tighten the lower channel on the post. (Note: Over-tightening will crush the aluminum post.)
5)
Verify GAS-Guard is plumb and level, within ±5˚ and all mounting hardware is tight.
Figure 6: GAS-Guard mounting
16 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Mounting without the Transformer Pad Mount Stand When mounting the GAS-Guard, ensure the following: 1)
The GAS-Guard is mounted a minimum of 12-in (30.5 cm) above any possible water level.
2)
The GAS-Guard is plumb and level within ±5˚.
3)
3/8-in hardware is used to mount the GAS-Guard to supporting structure.
Attaching the Sunshield 1)
Locate the sunshield and the (4) 10x32 retaining screws, part # 253-0066-XX, included in the GAS-Guard hardware.
2)
Position the sun shield over the GAS-Guard, see figure 7.
3)
Install the four screws in predrilled and tapped mounting holes.
Figure 7: Sunshield mounting
17 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Oil Connections There are several steps that must be followed specifically when connecting the oil supply and return lines. The GAS-Guard must be connected to the transformer’s main tank in two locations. The first connection supplies oil from the transformer to the GAS-Guard (Oil Supply Port). The second connection returns oil from the GAS-Guard back to the transformer (Oil Return Port). Refer to the Site Preparation Guide for recommended transformer oil connection locations. To guard against oil leaks, Extra High Density, 1.45 SG or higher Teflon tape (PTFE) or Teflon paste should be applied to all NPT-type connections prior to assembly. CAUTION: Ensure all fittings, valves, and fixtures are clean prior to installing. De-burr all tubing ends prior to swaging on fittings.
CAUTION: Oil lines, valves, and fixtures are not a step! Make sure all tubing is positioned out of the way of any foot traffic or maintenance areas on or around the transformer.
CAUTION: Maximum Oil Inlet Pressure to the analyzer is 45 psi (3 bar)
Inline Oil Filters Two inline oil filters, Part # 250-0130-XX, are supplied with the GAS-Guard. The recommended installation location for the filters is as close to the GAS-Guard bulkhead fittings as possible. If the bulkhead is an inconvenient location to install the oil filters because of the installation of oil cooler or GAS-Guard orientation, the filters must be mounted in a location that will allow easy access for filter service. 1)
Identify location for oil filter mounting
2)
Locate the flow direction arrow on the filter housing.
3)
Install the filter in the oil line with the flow direction orientated correctly.
4)
Swage the two fittings onto the ¼-in oil tubing.
Figure 8: Oil Filter Housing 18 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Oil Plumbing Locate the two bulkhead fittings for oil connections labeled “Oil In” and “Oil Out” on the left side of the GAS-Guard. 1)
Secure the Oil Supply Port Assy, 456-0026-XX to the transformer oil supply port/Top-Oil (moisture/temperature) fixture. Please see the Top-Oil (moisture/temperature) section for fixture specifications.
2)
Attach the Bleed Fixture 900-0053-XX or the customer supplied bleed fixture to the transformer oil return port specified in the Site Preparation Guide.
3)
Secure the Oil Return Valve assembly 456-0022-XX to the Bleed Fixture.
4)
Using ¼-in stainless steel tubing, join the oil supply fitting and the oil return valve assembly to their respective “Oil In” and “Oil Out” bulk-head fittings on the GAS-Guard.
5)
Using the supplied helium and regulator, purge fitted oil lines with helium for one minute prior to final tubing connection to the GAS-Guard.
Figure 9: Bleed Fixture and Siemens Oil Return Valve
19 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
6)
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Select a convenient location no higher than 6 feet (183 cm) above ground level to mount the Siemens Sample port/Shut-off valve assembly 456-0023-XX.
Figure 10: Sample port/Secondary Shutoff Assy.
Note: The sample port/shut-off valve is used when performing manual DGA testing or for stopping oil supply to the GAS-Guard.
20 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Top-Oil Moisture/Temperature (optional) An optional sensor is available to provide oil moisture in parts per million (ppm) or percent relative saturation (%RS) and oil temperature in °C. Depending on sensor location, the oil temperature data can be representative of transformer top oil temperature. Note: Siemens recommends the Oil Moisture/Temperature Sensor be installed on the top oil supply port of the transformer. To install the sensor, use the fittings identified in the “Site Preparation Guide.” All fittings must be stainless steel, brass, or black iron. Please refer to figure 11 below for the Moisture/Temperature sensor fixture configuration. 1)
Install the male nipple and Tee to the transformer oil supply port with the Tee orientation as required.
2)
Reduce the straight-through port on the Tee to ½-in FNPT and the 90˚ port to ¼-in FNPT.
3)
Install the Siemens ¼-in Oil Supply Adapter to the 90˚ port.
4)
Install a ½-in x 2-in nipple to the straight-through port.
5)
Install the ½-in ball valve that comes with the Oil Moisture and Temperature sensor on the ½-in x 2-in nipple.
For proper installation of the Oil Moisture and Temperature sensor, it is important for the nipple connecting the Tee to the ½-in ball be no longer than required. Once the assembly is built, ensure the tip of the Oil Moisture and Temperature sensor is in the oil flow.
Existing Transformer Valve Nipple (X) x 2-3"
Tee (X) x (X) x (X)
Transformer Base
Nipple 1/2" x 2"
Reducing Bushing (X) x 1/2" Reducing Bushing (X) x 1/4"
Serveron Oil Supply Adapter Oil supply Port Assy 1/4" Tube x 1/4" MNPT 456-0026-00 250-0138-XX
Oil Moisture Sensor Cable Serveron Oil Moisture and Temperature Sensor with
Figure 11: Top-Oil (Moisture/Temperature) Sensor Fixture 21 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Oil Transmitter Unit Mounting The moisture sensor is designed for industrial applications. The sensor assembly consists of (4) elements which are:
Probe with Cable (5m)
Transmitter Unit
Mounting Base
Interface Cable (5m)
There are a few options to mount the transmitter unit depending on the valve location in which the sensor will be installed. The transmitter unit is secured with two 3-mm hex screws to the mounting base. If the installation of the sensor is conducive to having the mounting base attached to a structure (control cabinet, junction box, channel, etc.), the transmitter unit can be detached from the mounting based using a 3-mm hex driver, refer to figure 12. In the event the transmitter unit can not be hard mounted to a support structure, the transmitter unit can be secured via cable ties to the oil supply tubing. 3mm hex screws to remove transmitter unit from mounting base
Figure 12: Transmitter Unit
Once the transmitter unit is removed from the mounting base, the base can be hard mounted. If the transmitter unit is installed unprotected in an outside environment (-55 to 60°C), ensure the orientation of the connections are facing in the downward direction, refer to figure 13.
Figure 13: Mounting Base 22 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Gas Connections Two gas sources must be connected to the GAS-Guard- Helium and Verification gas. CAUTION: Use of helium other than 99.9999% pure research or chromatographic grade with less than 0.2-ppm H2O content will VOID the GAS-Guard warranty.
WARNING: When full, the helium gas cylinder is pressured to greater than 2000psi (138 bar). Helium is regulated to 80psi (5.5 bar), nominal, before entering the GAS-Guard. Always follow Compressed Gas Association (CGA) guidelines when handling and transporting compressed gases.
Helium Gas Cylinder and Dryer Mounting (GAS-Guard 8 only) WARNING: Never leave the helium input to the GAS-Guard or the helium dryer inlet and outlet ports exposed to the atmosphere. The helium gas cylinder must be securely mounted. The GAS-Guard stand includes a mounting bracket that meets all Compressed Gas Association (CGA) cylinder restraining requirements. The helium dryer is mounted vertically to the GAS-Guard mounting stand using the retaining brackets included with the GAS-Guard mounting stand. A 10-ft (305 cm) x 1/8-in O.D. stainless steel tube is provided to connect the helium cylinder regulator to the top of the helium dryer. A 10-in (25.4 cm) x 1/8-in O.D. stainless steel tube is provided to connect the bottom of the helium dryer to the GASGuard.
CAUTION: Do not uncap or connect helium gas lines to the helium dryer at this time.
Figure 14: Helium Dryer
23 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
1)
Install the provided helium regulator onto the helium cylinder. Do not use Teflon tape or pipe dope.
2)
Orient the gauge vertically and tighten the CGA fitting.
3)
Orient the helium cylinder so that the gauge on the regulator can be clearly seen.
4)
Mount the helium dryer to the stand in the vertical orientation as indicated in figure 14, using the supplied retaining clips 291-0014-XX.
5)
Install one end of the 10-ft stainless steel tubing onto the regulator.
6)
Verify the helium regulator shutoff valve is closed and slowly turn the valve located on top of the helium cylinder fully counterclockwise (open).
7)
Slowly turn helium regulator shutoff valve counterclockwise (open) until helium begins to flow. At this point, gas should be escaping from the stainless steel tubing.
CAUTION: Do not open the regulator shutoff valve completely to regulate the helium flow. 8)
Leaving the helium flowing, attach the other end of the 10-ft. tubing to the top of the helium dryer.
9)
While the helium is continuing to flow, install the one end of the 10-in stainless steel tubing onto the bottom of the helium dryer.
10) Let the helium continue to purge through the dryer and tubing for one (1) minute. 11) While the helium is still purging, attach the remaining end of the 10-in stainless steel tubing
to the bulkhead fitting on the right side of the GAS-Guard labeled “Helium In.” 12) Now turn the regulator shutoff valve fully counterclockwise (open). 13) Confirm all four helium connections and the helium regulator to helium tank connections
are leak-tight by applying a leak-check solution to the fittings.
Figure 15: Helium Regulator Note: The leak check is very important as even the smallest leak can substantially reduce the life of the helium cylinder.
24 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Verification Gas Cylinder WARNING: When full, the verification gas cylinder is pressured to greater than 500psi (34 bar). Verification gas is regulated to 8psi (0.5 bar), nominal, before entering the GAS-Guard. Always follow Compressed Gas Association (CGA) guidelines when handling and transporting compressed gases. The verification gas cylinder is used to automatically verify and calibrate the GAS-Guard. The cylinder contains a certified NIST-traceable concentration of the transformer fault gases measured by the GAS-Guard. 1)
Open the analyzer door and locate the Verification cylinder mounting bracket and regulator.
2)
Install the Verification cylinder into the mounting bracket and secure using the Velcro strap.
3)
Connect the cylinder to the regulator union and tighten.
4)
Turn the knob on the top of the Verification cylinder counterclockwise until it is fully open. The regulator requires no pressure adjustment.
5)
Confirm that the bottle to regulator connection is leak-tight by applying a leak-check solution to the fitting. Wipe away any excess leak-check solution.
Note: The leak check is very important, as even the smallest leak can substantially reduce the life of the Verification cylinder.
6)
Complete and return the Verification cylinder data sheet found in the appendix to Siemens.
Figure 16: Installed Verification Cylinder
25 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Cable Connections The GAS-Guard has three primary electrical cable connections: Power, Sensor, and Communication. Each cable comes with a preinstalled connector on one end and is marked with an identifying part number and a description. CAUTION: Ensure GAS-Guard power switch is off before connecting cables.
Power Cable, (black 3-wire) 610-0179-00 2-ft/610-0182-00 23-ft The GAS-Guard has a variable input power supply capable of receiving input of 115VAC or 230VAC ±15%, 50/60 Hz. Current draw is 6A max. at 115VAC and 3A max. at 230VAC. There are three 4A/250V type 3AG (T) fuses installed for the power supply (line and neutral) and the GAS-Guard’s enclosure heater (line). CAUTION: Replace fuses with same type and rating only. CAUTION: The GAS-Guard enclosure heater is not a variable voltage input device and must be used with the appropriate 115V or 230V mains voltage as marked within the GAS-Guard. Note: Siemens recommends installing a properly rated and marked switch or circuit breaker in close proximity to the GAS-Guard as a mains voltage disconnect device. 1)
Locate the cable-gland on the bottom of the GAS-Guard labeled “Power.”
2)
Starting from the inside of the GAS-Guard Housing, route the Power cable through the cable-gland until the ferrite core contacts the cable-gland.
3)
Locate the in-line connector from the power supply and attach the power cable.
4)
Tighten the cable-gland onto the Power cable.
5)
Attach the green/yellow ground wire to the ground lug along with the communication and sensor cable shield drain wires then tighten ground lug nut.
6)
Route the blunt cut end of the cable into the Junction Box or control cabinet for termination. Pull enough cable through and trim cable to length. When using the Junction Box, pull approx 10-in through and remove the cable jacket.
7)
Terminate per the wiring termination in figure 17.
Sensor Cable, (black) 610-0180-00 3.5-ft/610-0183-00 23-ft 1)
Locate the cable-gland on the bottom of the GAS-Guard labeled “Sensor.”
2)
Starting from the inside of the GAS-Guard Housing, route the black Sensor cable through the cable-gland until the ferrite core contacts the cable-gland.
3)
Locate the connector J100 on the System board and insert the cable connector.
4)
Tighten the cable-gland onto the Sensor cable.
5)
Attach the shield drain wire to the ground lug with the communication and power green/yellow ground wire then tighten ground lug nut.
6)
Route the blunt cut end into the Junction Box or control cabinet for termination. Pull enough cable through and trim cable to length. When using the Junction Box, pull approx 10-in (25.4cm) through and remove the black cable jacket.
7)
Terminate per the wiring termination in figure 17.
26 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Communication Cable, (gray) 610-0181-00 3.5-ft/610-0184-00 23-ft 1)
Locate the cable-gland on the bottom of the GAS-Guard labeled “Communication.”
2)
Starting from the inside of the GAS-Guard Housing route the gray Communication cable through the cable-gland until the ferrite core contacts the cable-gland.
3)
Locate the connector J101 on the system board and insert the cable connector.
4)
Tighten the cable-gland onto the Communication cable.
5)
Attach the shield drain wire to the ground lug with the sensor and power green/yellow ground wire then tighten ground lug nut.
6)
Route the blunt cut end into the Junction Box or control cabinet for termination. Pull enough cable through and trim cable to length. When using the Junction Box, pull approx 10-in (25.4 cm) through and remove the gray cable jacket.
7)
Terminate per the wiring termination in figure 17.
Notes:
(Red) He Pressure Switch(optional) Helium NC
From Analyzer
Sensor Cable (black) PN # 610-0180-00 (3.5ft) PN # 610-0183-00 (23ft)
Communication Cable (gray) PN # 610-0181-00 (3.5ft) PN # 610-0184-00 (23ft)
GND (White/Red) SGND (Black) +24vdc (Violet) 4-20mA Input Channel 2 Input (White/Violet) (Orange) 4-20mA Input Channel 1 +24vdc Input (White/Orange) +24vdc (White) 4-20mA Input Channel 3 Input (White/Black/BRN) LoadGuide (Brown) LoadGuide AGND (Blue) COM (Yellow) Programmable Relay NC (Grey) NO (Green) COM(White/Yellow) Power Relay NC (White/Grey) NO (White/Green) TXD (Yellow) RXD (White/Yellow) RTS (Green) CTS (White/Green) DCD(White/Violet) RS232 DSR(WhiteGrey) RI (White/Red) DTR (Grey) GND(White/Black) TXA (-) (White/Brown) TXB (+) (Brown) RCVA (-) (White/Orange) RS485 RCVB (+) (Orange) GND (White/Black/BRN) RING (Blue) Internal Modem TIP (White/Blue) +12V (Red) 12V@1A 12V GND (Black)
AC Power Cable (black 3-wire) PN # 610-0179-00 (2ft) PN # 610-0182-00 (23ft) Communication Cable Violet - Not Used White - Not Used
1 2 3 4 5 User Defined
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Communications Input/Outputs
13 14 15 User Defined
16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
LINE (Brown)
25
NEUTRAL (Blue)
26
EARTH GND (Green/Yellow)
27
AUX 12VDC Output
AC Power
Sensor Cable White/Black - Not Connected White/Brown - Not Connected White/Blue - Not Connected
Figure 17: Wiring Terminations
27 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
External Sensors Oil Moisture and Temperature Connections The Oil Moisture and Temperature sensor can be configured for 4-20mA or RS-232 output; the recommended configuration is 4-20mA. The Sensor can also be installed as moisture only or moisture and temperature. Please refer below for the wiring configurations. Sensor Type
Sensor Signal Name
Sensor Wire Color
Monitor Signal Name
Monitor Wire Color
Moisture Only
Supply (-) Supply (+) 24VDC CH 2
GREY PINK
Signal GND CH 1 (+) 24VDC CH 1 Input
BLK ORG
Signal Ground CH 1 (+) 24VDC CH 1 Input CH 3 Input
BLK ORG
Moisture/Temperature
Supply (-) Supply (+) 24VDC CH 2 CH 1
GRN GREY PINK GRN YEL
WHT/ORG
WHT/ORG WHT/BLK/BRN
Table 5: Oil Moisture and Temperature connections
Ambient Temperature 1)
Push sensor through cable-gland marked “Amb Temp” so that sensor tip is exposed 2-in. (5 cm) below bottom of GAS-Guard enclosure and cable-gland.
2)
Ensure sensor cable is plugged into connector J2 on the System board.
LoadGuide (750-0058-XX) WARNING: High voltage can be induced by the LoadGuide sensor. Do not clamp the LoadGuide around the transformer CT winding until its wires have been terminated to the GAS-Guard. 1)
Locate the 0 to 5-amp CT winding identified in the Site Preparation Guide within the transformer control panel.
2)
Pull the LoadGuide leads from the transformer panel to the GAS-Guard junction box. A wire size of 22 AWG or larger can be used to extend the length of the leads.
3)
Connect the black and white wires of the LoadGuide to the brown and blue sensor cable leads, polarity is not significant.
4)
Unscrew white screws and remove back plate from device.
5)
Place the U-shape of the device around the 0 to 5-amp tap.
6)
Reinstall back plate and finger tighten screws.
28 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Relays There are two dry contact relays, (1) Power and (1) Programmable, User defined. The Power relay is triggered on loss of power to the GAS-Guard. The programmable relay can trigger on any GAS-Guard programmed parameter. The relay can be wired for normally-open (NO) or normally-closed (NC) configuration. The following parameters can be programmed:
Block all inputs (no operation)
Gas alarm condition, both PPM and rate-of-change
Gas caution condition
Service required condition
Sensor alarm condition (Oil Temp, Moisture, LoadGuide, Helium Gas (with optional regulator), 4-20ma input CH2, etc.) Note: The relays are capable of handling 100VA, 110VAC @ 1A or 50VDC @ 1A.
29 of 32
30 of 32
4 2 2 2 2 4 4 10 4 1 1 2 4
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 1 2 2 4
18 19 20 21
8 17
16
8
1
1
15
Qty
Item #
254-0094-00 Strut Washer, Grip Style
253-0151-00 3/8 Bolts x .875”
253-0148-00 #10-16 x ¾” Self Drilling Screw
140-0203-00 CMP, Bracket Bulkhead
010-0047-00 Packaging Set (Not Shown)
253-0070-00 #10-32 x ½ Screw
254-0023-00 #10 Lock Washer
252-0013-00 #10-32 Nut
140-0193-00 ¾ x 1/8 Mounting Strap
190-0001-00 Strap
140-0062-00 He Support Bracket
253-0076-00 3/8 Anchor Bolts
254-0071-00 3/8 Locker Washer
254-0070-00 3/8 Flat Washer
252-0014-00 3/8 Nut
253-0071-00 3/8 Bolts x 1.5”
291-0009-00 Unistut – 2 feet
291-0010-00 U-Bolt Assy w/Mtg Plate
253-0144-00 3/8 Bolts x 3” Fully Threaded
291-0011-00 Nut—Mounting w/spring
140-0190-00 CMP, Stand Post
Part/Description
810-1732-00 Rev A GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Mounting Stand Assembly Drawing
Figure 18: Mounting Stand Assembly
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Installation Checklist The following is a checklist to help ensure that all the proper steps have been completed prior to filling the GAS-Guard with oil.
GAS-Guard securely mounted Helium cylinder securely mounted Helium regulator installed Helium dryer installed in the vertical orientation Helium system leak-checked Verification cylinder securely mounted Verification cylinder system leak-checked All oil plumbing components secure (Optional) Oil Cooler securely mounted to stand All compression fittings securely tightened and leak-checked All cabling securely routed and safely out of the way Electrical conduit and or termination strip enclosures installed, secured, and grounded as necessary
Sensor connections established Communication connections established Power connections established (power is OFF in the GAS-Guard)
CAUTION: DO NOT apply power to the GAS-Guard! Power will be applied as part of the commissioning procedure.
31 of 32
810-1732-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard Installation Guide
Forms Verification Cylinder Data Sheet Upon successful installation of your GAS-Guard verification cylinder; please complete and fax or e-mail this Verification Cylinder Data Sheet to Technical Support at: +1 (503) 924-3290 fax
[email protected] e-mail Attention:
Siemens Product Support
From:
Customer Information Company: Site: Site Address: City, State and Zip: Country:
GAS-Guard and Verification Cylinder Information Installer’s Name: Installation Date:
GAS-Guard Serial Number:
Helium high pressure gauge (psig):
Helium low pressure gauge (psig):
Verification high pressure gauge (psig):
Verification low pressure gauge (psig):
Verification Cylinder Lot Number:
Manufacture/Analysis Date
Verification Cylinder Components Hydrogen Oxygen Methane Carbon Monoxide Carbon Dioxide Ethylene Ethane Acetylene
H2 O2 CH4 CO CO2 C2H4 C2H6 C2H2
N/A
Certified Concentrations ppm ppm ppm ppm ppm ppm ppm ppm
Table 6: Verification cylinder datasheet 32 of 32
SIEMENS
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide 810-1734-00 Rev A
Corporate Office: +1 (800) 880-2552 Technical Support: +1 (866) 273-7763 E-mail:
[email protected] Copyright © 2006 Serveron Corporation All rights reserved
Serveron, TrueGas, and LoadGuide are registered trademarks of Serveron Corporation. All other trademarks, registered trademarks, service marks, and trade names are the property of their respective owners.
810-1734-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
Table of Contents Introduction..............................................................................................................................................................3 Product Symbols......................................................................................................................................................4 Operation ..................................................................................................................................................................5 Calibration ............................................................................................................................................................5 Alarm Settings......................................................................................................................................................5 New transformers or transformers with no previous gas data:................................................................................. 6 Transformers with a stable gassing history: ................................................................................................................. 6 Gassing Transformers which have been degassed: ..................................................................................................... 7 Transformers with an unstable gassing history which have not been degassed: ................................................... 7
Viewing GAS-Guard Data..................................................................................................................................7 Front panel lights (Indicators) ...........................................................................................................................8 Turning the GAS-Guard On/Off ......................................................................................................................9 Manual DGA Sampling ....................................................................................................................................10 Operational Parameters ....................................................................................................................................10 Maintenance ...........................................................................................................................................................11 Helium and Verification Gas ...........................................................................................................................11 Helium Gas ..................................................................................................................................................................... 11 Helium Dryer.................................................................................................................................................................. 11 Helium Cylinder and Dryer Removal and Replacement.......................................................................................... 11 Verification Gas .............................................................................................................................................................. 13 Verification Gas Cylinder Removal and Replacement.............................................................................................. 13
Leak Check Fittings ...........................................................................................................................................14 Replacing Fuses..................................................................................................................................................14 Oil Filter Service.................................................................................................................................................15 Customer Replaceable Units (CRU’s) .............................................................................................................16 Cleaning ..............................................................................................................................................................16 Internal Cleaning............................................................................................................................................................ 16 External Cleaning ........................................................................................................................................................... 16
Return Shipping Instructions...............................................................................................................................17 Forms.......................................................................................................................................................................18 Verification Cylinder Data Sheet.....................................................................................................................18
Table of Figures Figure 1: Siemens GAS-Guard...............................................................................................................................3 Figure 2: Oil shut off valve .....................................................................................................................................9 Figure 3: DGA sample port ..................................................................................................................................10 Figure 4: Installed verification cylinder..............................................................................................................14 Figure 5: Filter assembly.......................................................................................................................................15 Figure 6: Internal foam support...........................................................................................................................17
1 of 18
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
810-1734-00 Rev A
Table of Tables Table 1: Product Symbols .......................................................................................................................................4 Table 2: Recommended caution/alarm settings for transformers with no previous gas data.....................6 Table 3: Recommended caution/alarm settings for transformers with a stable gassing history.................6 Table 4: Recommended caution/alarm settings for gassing transformers after degassing..........................7 Table 5: Front panel lights ......................................................................................................................................8 Table 6: Customer Replaceable Units .................................................................................................................16 Table 7: Verification cylinder datasheet .............................................................................................................18
2 of 18
810-1734-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
Introduction The Siemens GAS-Guard is an on-line laboratory-grade gas chromatograph. The GAS-Guard detects and measures fault gases found in the cooling oil of power transformers. The GAS-Guard is designed and constructed to operate under those environmental conditions typical of a power substation or generating facility.
Figure 1: Siemens GAS-Guard
3 of 18
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
810-1734-00 Rev A
Product Symbols The following symbols are used throughout the GAS-Guard or accessories. They are defined by the International Electrotechnical Commission, IEC 878 and IEC 417A. It is important for safety reasons to have an understanding of their representation.
Voltage Output Voltage Input Fuse High Voltage Caution: Refer to GAS-Guard Installation Guide and accompanying documentation. Protective earth (ground)
V~ H L __I__ O
Alternating Current and Voltage Connect to mains live conductor (brown) Connect to mains neutral conductor (blue) The I position indicates the power switch is ON The O position indicates the power switch is OFF This device has been tested and certified by the Canadian Standards Association International to comply with applicable U.S. and Canadian safety standards. Table 1: Product Symbols
WARNING statements in this manual identify conditions or practices that could result in personal injury. CAUTION statements in this manual identify conditions or practices that could result in damage to the equipment or other property. NOTE statements provide additional important information.
4 of 18
810-1734-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
Operation Once installed, the Siemens GAS-Guard requires very little setup before operation commences. To retrieve DGA data from the GAS-Guard, set caution/alarm levels, sampling schedules etc. use either GAS-Guard View software or the Serveron Monitoring Service (SMS). Refer to the GAS-Guard View Software User’s Manual or the SMS User’s Guide. For more information, manuals are available for download from www.serveron.com or by contacting Technical Support at
[email protected].
Calibration Every Siemens GAS-Guard is calibrated at the factory. Following installation and commissioning, the GAS-Guard’s auto-calibration feature verifies calibration automatically every three days. Siemens recommends confirming calibration of your GAS-Guard every six months by viewing the ‘Verification PPM in Gas’ graph in GAS-Guard View (Graph Tools→Maintenance→Verification Data). A manual recalibration should not be required unless a new certified verification cylinder is installed, approximately once every three years. If Siemens has connectivity to the GAS-Guard during the standard warranty period (12-months from date of shipment) Siemens will periodically confirm calibration of the GAS-Guard as well. Note: For Serveron Monitoring Service customers, upon installing a new verification cylinder fill out and return the Verification Cylinder Datasheet located at the end of this document and return it to Technical Support.
Alarm Settings Following installation of the GAS-Guard and after an initial 24 hour stabilization period, the gas caution and alarm levels can be set in the GAS-Guard. These levels can be set using the GAS-Guard View software which was included with your GAS-Guard or by the Serveron Monitoring Service. There are no universal rules regarding the values at which to set the caution and alarm levels in the GAS-Guard. In the most general case caution and alarm settings are disabled while the GAS-Guard runs for approximately thirty (30) days to establish gassing trends and a baseline PPM level for each of the fault gases. After the GAS-Guard PPM data has been established, you can use the history to set the caution and alarm levels directly or consult with the support group at
[email protected] to determine the appropriate caution and alarm settings for your GAS-Guard. The following guidelines may be useful for setting the initial gas caution and alarm levels. Keep in mind that these are recommendations. The appropriate caution and alarm settings for your GAS-Guard may vary from these recommendations.
5 of 18
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
810-1734-00 Rev A
New transformers or transformers with no previous gas data: Set the GAS-Guard caution level to 50% and the alarm level to 100% of the low-end CAUTION ppm limits proposed by IEEE PC57.104 Draft 11, published April 21, 2004; except acetylene, as noted below. Gas
Caution PPM
Alarm PPM
Hydrogen
50
100
Methane
60
120
Acetylene
2
5
Ethylene
25
50
Ethane
33
65
Carbon Monoxide
175
350
Carbon Dioxide
1750
3500
Oxygen
baseline+10%
Baseline+20%
Notes:
Per Draft 11
above initial measured PPM
Table 2: Recommended caution/alarm settings for transformers with no previous gas data
Transformers with a stable gassing history: Use the GAS-Guard to measure the transformer oil for thirty (30) days in order to establish baseline levels of the eight fault gases. Set the GAS-Guard caution/alarms levels to the measured baseline levels + value (PPM) shown below. Gas
Caution PPM +value (PPM)
Alarm PPM +value (PPM)
Hydrogen
+50
+100
Methane
+60
+120
Acetylene
+2
+5
Ethylene
+25
+50
Ethane
+33
+65
Carbon Monoxide
+175
+350
Carbon Dioxide
+1750
+3500
Oxygen
baseline+10%
Baseline+20%
Notes:
above initial measured PPM
Table 3: Recommended caution/alarm settings for transformers with a stable gassing history
6 of 18
810-1734-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
Gassing Transformers which have been degassed: Set the caution level to 50% and the alarm level to 100% of the low-end CAUTION ppm limits proposed by IEEE PC57.104 Draft 11, published April 21, 2004; except acetylene, as noted below. Gas
Caution PPM
Alarm PPM
Hydrogen
50
100
Methane
60
120
Acetylene
2
5
Ethylene
25
50
Ethane
33
65
Carbon Monoxide
175
350
Carbon Dioxide
1750
3500
Oxygen
baseline+10%
Baseline+20%
Notes:
Per Draft 11
above initial measured PPM
Table 4: Recommended caution/alarm settings for gassing transformers after degassing
Transformers with an unstable gassing history which have not been degassed: There are no recommendations possible for transformers in this category. In order to establish the caution and alarm levels, allow the GAS-Guard to run for thirty (30) days to establish gassing trends and baseline measurements. After this data has been collected, you should consult with Siemens (
[email protected]) to determine the appropriate caution and alarm settings for the transformer.
Viewing GAS-Guard Data The GAS-Guard data can be viewed using the supplied GAS-Guard View software or the optional Serveron Monitoring Service Client software. A copy of the GAS-Guard View software and user’s manual can be found on the CD that shipped with the GAS-Guard. Alternatively, the GAS-Guard can present data to SCADA systems using DNP3 or Modbus protocols. Please contact a Siemens representative for further information regarding the Serveron Monitoring Service or to integrate the GAS-Guard with a SCADA system
7 of 18
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
810-1734-00 Rev A
Front panel lights (Indicators) The Siemens GAS-Guard has three colored lights (LED’s) located on the front panel. These lights are described in the following Table as they appear on the front panel, from top to bottom.
Light Alarm
Notes: The GAS-Guard has detected one or more gas values equal to or greater than their respective alarm settings. The GAS-Guard needs service. The service indicator is activated by a number of GAS-Guard-specific parameters. For cause identification proceed as follows-
Service
GAS-Guard View: Open GAS-Guard View program and update the unit database. After updating the database open the event-log and view recorded event condition. Serveron Monitoring Service: Open the Serveron Monitoring Service Client program and view the event log. Contact Technical Support group at (
[email protected]). Note: Depending on the cause for Service, the GAS-Guard may need to perform an analysis before the blue Service LED is turned OFF.
Power
The GAS-Guard is ON.
Table 5: Front panel lights
8 of 18
810-1734-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
Turning the GAS-Guard On/Off CAUTION: Always ensure helium is being supplied to the analyzer. Never leave the helium inlet to the GAS-Guard exposed to atmosphere.
CAUTION: The GAS-Guard is designed to operate continuously. When powering down the GAS-Guard for extended periods of time (more than 24 hours), always close the oil supply and return valves to the analyzer. To isolate (shut off) the oil inlet and oil outlet ports, close the transformer oil supply and return valves or close the Siemens manual DGA (sample port/oil shutoff) valve as well as the Siemens oil return valve located on the bleed fixture. The figure below is a typical example of one of these valves. There are at least two valves per installation, one for the inlet and one for the outlet. The exact location and number of these valves will vary by installation. The valve is shown in the ON position in the following figure.
Figure 2: Oil shut off valve For whatever reason, if the GAS-Guard is consistently unable to complete its sample runs, Siemens recommends powering down the GAS-Guard and closing the supply and return valves (described above) until the exact nature of the problem is understood and/or corrected. This will ensure no damage is caused to the GAS-Guard.
9 of 18
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
810-1734-00 Rev A
Manual DGA Sampling A manual DGA sample port is installed in-line with the GAS-Guard oil supply tubing. Siemens recommends this port for correlation of GAS-Guard data to manual DGA data. The location of the sample port will vary by installation. The sample port provided with the GAS-Guard is a ¼-in locking valve with a 1/4-in FNPT fitting. No special procedures are required when obtaining a manual DGA sample.
Figure 3: DGA sample port
Operational Parameters Please see the “Siemens GAS-Guard Data Sheet” available online at www.serveron.com.
10 of 18
810-1734-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
Maintenance The Siemens GAS-Guard has been designed to keep maintenance to a minimum. The following will help you determine the best service plan.
Helium and Verification Gas Helium Gas The helium gas cylinder will last greater than four (4) years based on the default four hour sampling interval. It is important that the gauge on the regulator be checked quarterly and a leak-check solution applied to fittings biannually to ensure no leaks have developed. The helium cylinder should be replaced when the pressure gauge reads less than 150psi (10.34 bar).
Helium Dryer The helium dryer will last greater than four (4) years based on the default four hour sampling interval. A leak-check solution should be applied to the helium dryer fittings bi-annually to ensure no leaks have developed. The helium dryer should be replaced when the helium cylinder is replaced.
Helium Cylinder and Dryer Removal and Replacement WARNING: When full, the helium cylinder is pressured to greater than 2000psi (138 bar). Helium is regulated to 80psi (5.5 bar), nominal, before entering the GAS-Guard, Always follow Compressed Gas Association (CGA) guidelines when handling and transporting compressed gases.
CAUTION: Use of helium other than 99.9999% pure research or chromatographic grade with less than (0.2 ppm) H2O content will VOID the GAS-Guard warranty.
1)
Turn off power to the GAS-Guard by opening the GAS-Guard door and toggling the power switch located in the upper right hand corner to the OFF position.
2)
Turn the helium cylinder valve clockwise to the fully OFF position.
3)
Using a 7/16-in wrench, remove the 1/8-in helium inlet and outlet lines from the top and bottom of the helium dryer.
WARNING: A small amount of high-pressure helium will be released upon loosening the fitting.
4)
Using a suitable wrench, remove the helium regulator from the cylinder valve.
11 of 18
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide 5)
810-1734-00 Rev A
Carefully support the regulator to prevent any damage to the 1/8-in helium line or regulator.
CAUTION: It is extremely important that no water or other foreign contaminates be allowed to enter the open regulator fitting or tubing.
6)
Remove the helium cylinder from its mounting bracket.
7)
Remove the helium dryer from its mounting clips.
8)
Verify the replacement cylinder meets the following specifications:
9)
Chromatographic grade helium
99.9999% pure/Grade (6.0)
Less than 0.2 ppm H2O
CGA-580 fitting
Position the new helium cylinder in the mounting bracket and secure the cylinder in place.
10) Reinstall the regulator onto the helium cylinder. Do not use Teflon tape or pipe dope. 11) Orient the gauge vertically and tighten the CGA fitting. 12) If necessary, reorient the helium cylinder so that the gauge on the regulator can be clearly
seen. 13) Install the new helium dryer in the mounting clips. The dryer is not flow directional.
Note: Do not remove the helium dryer plugs at this time. 14) Verify the helium regulator shutoff valve is closed and slowly turn the valve located on top
of the helium cylinder fully counterclockwise (open). 15) Slowly turn helium regulator shutoff valve counterclockwise (open) until helium begins to
flow. At this point, gas should be escaping from the stainless steel tubing. CAUTION: Do not open the regulator shutoff valve completely to regulate the helium flow. 16) Leaving the helium flowing, remove the top helium dryer plug and attach the free end of
the 10-ft helium line to the top of the helium dryer. 17) With the helium continuing to flow reinstall the line to the bottom of the helium dryer. 18) Now turn the regulator shutoff valve fully counterclockwise (open). 19) Confirm all four helium connections and the helium regulator to helium tank connections
are leak-tight by applying a leak-check solution to the fittings. Note: The leak check is very important as even the smallest leak can substantially reduce the life of the helium cylinder. The helium regulator outlet pressure is preset at 80psi (5.5 bar), nominal, and requires no adjustment.
12 of 18
810-1734-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
Verification Gas The verification gas certification is three (3) years and the cylinder holds enough gas for over 4 years worth of verification runs based on the default ‘every three days’ sampling interval. It is important that the gauge on the regulator be checked quarterly and a leak-check solution applied to fittings biannually to insure no leaks have developed. The verification cylinder should be replaced when the high pressure gauge reads less than 25psi (1.72 bar). CAUTION: Use of verification gas that does not meet Siemens specifications will VOID the GAS-Guard warranty.
Verification Gas Cylinder Removal and Replacement WARNING: When full, the verification gas cylinder is pressured to greater than 500psi (34 bar). Verification gas is regulated to 8psi (0.5 bar), nominal, before entering the GAS-Guard. Always follow Compressed Gas Association (CGA) guidelines when handling and transporting compressed gases. The verification gas cylinder is used to automatically verify and calibrate the GAS-Guard. The cylinder contains a certified NIST-traceable concentration of the eight-transformer fault gases measured by the GAS-Guard. 1)
Turn off power to the GAS-Guard by opening the GAS-Guard door and toggling the power switch located in the upper right hand corner to the OFF position.
2)
Turn the verification cylinder tank valve to the fully OFF (clockwise) position.
3)
Using a 9/16-in wrench loosen the verification cylinder to regulator union.
WARNING: A small amount of high-pressure verification gas will be released upon loosening the fitting. 4)
While supporting the verification cylinder release the Velcro strap retaining the verification cylinder in the bracket.
5)
Install the new verification cylinder into the mounting bracket and secure using the Velcro strap.
6)
Connect the cylinder to the regulator union and tighten.
7)
Turn the knob on the top of the verification cylinder counterclockwise until it is fully open. The regulator requires no pressure adjustment.
8)
Confirm that the bottle to regulator connection is leak-tight by applying a leak-check solution to the fitting. Wipe away any excess leak-check solution.
Note: The leak check is very important, as even the smallest leak can substantially reduce the life of the verification cylinder.
13 of 18
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
9)
810-1734-00 Rev A
For Serveron Monitoring Service users, please complete and return the Verification cylinder data sheet to Technical Support (
[email protected]) after the Verification cylinder is replaced.
Figure 4: Installed verification cylinder
Leak Check Fittings After the first month of continuous use, all regulator, gas and oil fittings should be checked for leaks. A semi-annual check of these fittings is recommended following the one month initial check.
Replacing Fuses The GAS-Guard has a variable input power supply capable of receiving input of 115VAC or 230VAC ±15%, 50/60 Hz. Current draw is 6A max. at 115VAC and 3A max. at 230VAC. There are three 4A/250V type 3AG (T) fuses installed for the power supply (line and neutral) and the GAS-Guard’s enclosure heater (line).
CAUTION: Replace fuses with same type and rating only.
14 of 18
810-1734-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
Oil Filter Service The GAS-Guard uses two inline screen type oil filters. Under normal operation, no filter maintenance is required. If service is require, the filter consist of three main parts: the filter housing, filter screen and the filter cap. For filter service proceed as follows: 1)
Turn off power to the GAS-Guard by opening the GAS-Guard door and toggling the power switch located in the upper right hand corner to the OFF position.
2)
Loosen the filter cap while supporting the filter housing with an adjustable end wrench. The exact filter location will vary by installation.
3)
After loosening the filter cap slowly back off the cap until transformer oil starts flowing out the purge hole located on the side of the filter cap.
4)
Let the oil continue to flow until a clear stream of oil void of any contaminates is visible.
5)
Tighten filter cap.
6)
Turn on power to GAS-Guard.
Figure 5: Filter assembly
15 of 18
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
810-1734-00 Rev A
Customer Replaceable Units (CRU’s) Customer Replaceable Units (CRU’s) are defined as customer replaceable parts onsite without decommissioning the GAS-Guard.
Part #
Description
270-0004-XX 290-0020-XX 290-0017-XX 292-0018-XX 292-0019-XX 370-0025-XX 370-0026-XX 370-0027-XX 430-0032-XX 750-0076-XX 750-0084-XX 750-0090-XX 250-0130-XX R750-0076-XX R750-0084-XX
Helium Dryer Regulator, CAL, Cylinder, Verification Regulator Helium Regulator Helium w/ Pressure Switch LED, Front Panel, Green LED, Front Panel, Red LED, Front Panel, Blue Fuse, TD, 4 Amps, 1/4" x 1 1/4" Column Assembly, GAS-Guard 8 Assy, Power Supply Column Assembly, GAS-Guard 3 Filter, Oil Replacement Column Assembly1, GAS-Guard 8 Refurbished Power Supply Assy
Table 6: Customer Replaceable Units Please contact Technical Support (
[email protected]) for removal and installation procedures.
Cleaning Internal Cleaning No internal cleaning of the GAS-Guard is required; doing so may cause damage the internal components and void the warranty.
External Cleaning No external cleaning of the GAS-Guard is required. If external cleaning is desired, water is the only recommended cleaning solution. Direct spray of high-pressure water onto the GAS-Guard door seal, LED’s, oil/helium bulkhead fittings and cable glands should be avoided.
1
GAS-Guard 3 does not require replacement column assembly
16 of 18
810-1734-00 Rev A
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
Return Shipping Instructions Prior to returning parts to Siemens a Return Material Authorization (RMA) number must be obtained from Siemens technical support: Technical Support: +1 (866) 273-7763 E-mail:
[email protected]). Returned items should be shipped in the original packaging or like packaging to avoid shipping damage. If original packaging or like packaging is not available contact Technical Support for shipping assistance. Warning: Shipping of the GAS-Guard without installing the internal foam support, part # 010-0038-XX, can cause damage to the GAS-Guard and void the warranty.
Figure 6: Internal foam support
17 of 18
GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 Operations and Maintenance Guide
810-1734-00 Rev A
Forms Verification Cylinder Data Sheet Upon successful installation of your verification cylinder; please complete and fax or email this Verification Cylinder Data Sheet to Technical Support at: +1 (503) 924-3290 fax or
[email protected] e-mail
Attn:
Siemens Product Support
From:
Customer Information Company: Site: Site Address: City, State and Zip: Country:
Gas Cylinder Information Installer’s Name: GAS-Guard Serial Number:
Installation Date: Helium high pressure gauge (psig): Verification high pressure gauge (psig):
Verification Cylinder Manufacture Date:
Verification Cylinder Lot Number: Verification Cylinder Gas Components Hydrogen Oxygen Methane Carbon Monoxide Carbon Dioxide Ethylene Ethane Acetylene
Certified Concentrations H2 O2 CH4 CO CO2 C2H4 C2H6 C2H2
ppm ppm ppm ppm ppm ppm ppm ppm
Table 7: Verification cylinder datasheet
18 of 18
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0 810-1735-01 Rev A June 10, 2008
www.serveron.com 3305 NW Aloclek Drive Hillsboro, OR 97124 USA +1 (503) 924-3200 phone +1 (503) 924-3290 fax
Corporate Office: (800) 880-2552 Technical Support: (866) 273-7763 E-mail:
[email protected] Copyright © 2008 Serveron Corporation All rights reserved Serveron and LoadGuide are registered trademarks of Serveron Corporation. Microsoft, Microsoft Internet Explorer, Microsoft .NET, Windows NT, Windows XP, Windows Server 2003, DirectX and Windows are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. FreeWave is a registered trademark of FreeWave Technologies. Unicode is a registered trademark of the Unicode Consortium. All other trademarks, registered trademarks, service marks, and trade names are the property of their respective owners.
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Table of Contents Before You Begin .................................................................................................................................. 6 About This Manual .......................................................................................................................... 6 About GAS-Guard View 2.0 Software .......................................................................................... 6 GAS-Guard View 2.0 Feature Overview .................................................................................. 7 Installing GAS-Guard View 2.0 ......................................................................................................... 9 System Requirements ...................................................................................................................... 9 Choosing an Installation Configuration ....................................................................................... 9 Installation Procedure ................................................................................................................... 10 Upgrade Procedure ........................................................................................................................ 10 Using GAS-Guard View 2.0 .............................................................................................................. 12 Starting GAS-Guard View 2.0 ...................................................................................................... 12 Creating New Files (Adding an Asset) ....................................................................................... 13 Opening Files .................................................................................................................................. 14 Navigating to Company, Sites, Assets and Monitors ............................................................... 15 Navigation Pane Icons and Notification ..................................................................................... 15 Working with Files......................................................................................................................... 17 Using Legacy Files ..................................................................................................................... 17 Corrupt or Invalid Files ............................................................................................................. 18 Removing a File from the Navigation Pane ............................................................................... 18 Using Commands........................................................................................................................... 19 Using Tabs....................................................................................................................................... 20 Using the Asset Status Tab ....................................................................................................... 20 Using the Graphs........................................................................................................................ 22 Graph Toolbar .......................................................................................................................... 23 Installing and Using Licenses ....................................................................................................... 25 Overview ..................................................................................................................................... 25 Automatic Scheduled Polling Option ..................................................................................... 26 Diagnostics Package Option ..................................................................................................... 26 GAS-Guard View 2.0 Reference ....................................................................................................... 28 Navigation Pane ............................................................................................................................. 28 Viewing Pane .................................................................................................................................. 29 Transformer Asset Tabs ............................................................................................................ 29 Status Tab.................................................................................................................................. 29 Gas in Oil Tab........................................................................................................................... 31 Limits Tab ................................................................................................................................. 33 Percent of Alarm Tab .............................................................................................................. 33 Rate of Change Tab ................................................................................................................. 34 Duval Triangle Tab.................................................................................................................. 34 Sensor Data Tab ....................................................................................................................... 34 Extractor Data Tab ................................................................................................................... 35 Retention Time Tab ................................................................................................................. 35 Verification Data Tab .............................................................................................................. 35 3 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Company Specific Tabs ............................................................................................................. 36 Welcome Tab ............................................................................................................................ 36 Polling Tab ................................................................................................................................ 36 Status Tab.................................................................................................................................. 38 Site Specific Tabs ........................................................................................................................ 38 Status Tab.................................................................................................................................. 39 Monitor Specific Tabs ................................................................................................................ 39 Sampling Tab (Monitor icon selected in Navigation Pane) ............................................... 39 Communications Tab (Monitor icon selected in Navigation Pane) ................................. 39 Menu Commands........................................................................................................................... 39 File Menu ..................................................................................................................................... 40 File New… ........................................................................................................................... 40 File Open… .......................................................................................................................... 41 File Close… .......................................................................................................................... 41 File Archive…...................................................................................................................... 41 File Export… ........................................................................................................................ 41 File Print… ........................................................................................................................... 42 File Print Preview ............................................................................................................... 42 File Exit................................................................................................................................. 42 Action Menu ............................................................................................................................... 42 Action Select Modem ......................................................................................................... 42 Action Send Diagnostic Data… ........................................................................................ 43 Action Rename Company… (Company selected, Status tab) ...................................... 43 Action Rename Site… (Site selected, Status tab) ............................................................ 43 Action Rename Asset… (Transformer asset selected, Status tab)................................ 44 Action Poll Now (Transformer asset selected, Status tab) ............................................ 44 Action Enter DGA… (Transformer asset selected, Gas in Oil tab) .............................. 44 Action Start Sample Run (Transformer asset selected, Gas in Oil tab) ....................... 44 Action Update Limits (Transformer asset selected, Limits tab) ................................... 44 Action Start Verification Run (Transformer asset selected, Verification Data tab) ... 45 Action Start Calibration Run (Transformer asset selected, Verification Data tab) .... 45 Action Change Monitor Password… (Transformer asset selected, Status tab) ......... 45 Action Set Monitor Date and Time (Transformer asset selected, Status tab) ............. 46 Action View Log… (Transformer asset selected, Status tab) ....................................... 46 Action Sample Hourly (Monitor selected, Sampling tab) ............................................. 46 Action Check Communications (Monitor selected, Communications tab) ................ 47 Action Update Communications (Monitor selected, Communications tab) .............. 47 View Menu .................................................................................................................................. 47 View Refresh (F5)................................................................................................................ 47 View Auto Refresh ............................................................................................................. 47 View Navigator ................................................................................................................... 47 Help Menu .................................................................................................................................. 47 Help User’s Manual............................................................................................................ 47 Help Frequently Asked Questions ................................................................................... 48 Help Release Notes............................................................................................................. 48 Help Licensing .................................................................................................................... 48 4 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Help Install Sample Files ................................................................................................... 49 Help About Siemens Client ............................................................................................... 49 Using the Duval Triangle .............................................................................................................. 49 Overview ..................................................................................................................................... 49 Interpretation of regions ........................................................................................................... 50 Interpretation of the Triangle ................................................................................................... 51 Multiple data points................................................................................................................... 51 Summary ..................................................................................................................................... 51 Using the Rogers Ratio Viewer .................................................................................................... 52 Introduction ................................................................................................................................ 52 Functional Overview ................................................................................................................. 52 Interpretation of Regions .......................................................................................................... 54 Interpreting the Graphical View .............................................................................................. 55 Summary ..................................................................................................................................... 55 Maintaining GAS-Guard View 2.0 Installations ............................................................................ 56 Configuring Communications ..................................................................................................... 56 Introduction ................................................................................................................................ 56 Local Area Network (LAN) ...................................................................................................... 57 Telephone Modem ..................................................................................................................... 57 RS-232........................................................................................................................................... 58 RS-232 with radio (FreeWave®) ............................................................................................... 58 Telephone Modem with radio (FreeWave®) ......................................................................... 59 Configuring Modems .................................................................................................................... 60 Modem Initialization ................................................................................................................. 60 Advanced Dialing Strings ......................................................................................................... 61 Overview .................................................................................................................................. 61 Send/Expect Protocol ............................................................................................................. 61 Configuring TAPI Modems ...................................................................................................... 62 Troubleshooting ............................................................................................................................. 63 Corrupt or Invalid Files ............................................................................................................. 63 Overview .................................................................................................................................. 63 File Structure ............................................................................................................................ 63 Causes of File Corruption....................................................................................................... 66 Repairing Damaged Files ....................................................................................................... 66 Menu Items Unavailable (“Grayed Out”)............................................................................... 67 Theory of Operations ..................................................................................................................... 67 Overview ..................................................................................................................................... 67 Viewer Component .................................................................................................................... 68 Poller Component ...................................................................................................................... 68
5 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Before You Begin About This Manual This User’s Manual provides the information that you need to install, setup, and use the Siemens GAS-Guard View 2.0 software to monitor and diagnose the state of your transformer assets. The manual is organized into chapters of increasing depth and detail. The chapters Installing GAS-Guard View and Using GAS-Guard View are informal user guides. The GAS-Guard View Reference chapter provides detailed descriptions of all parts of the user interface. Finally, the chapter titled Maintaining GAS-Guard View Installations provides additional information. Note: this manual assumes you have basic familiarity with the operating principles of your Siemens Online Transformer Monitor. If you require information regarding the features, operation, and installation of a Siemens transformer monitor please review the technical documentation available at the Serveron web site www.serveron.com or contact your local distributor. Current contact information for authorized distributors and technical support is published on the Serveron web site.
About GAS-Guard View 2.0 Software GAS-Guard View 2.0 is a software application for Windows®-compatible PCs. It is used to retrieve and display data that has been collected by a Siemens GAS-Guard on-line transformer monitor and also to change settings within the monitor. GAS-Guard View 2.0 does not measure gas-in-oil levels; the GAS-Guard monitor makes those measurements. GAS-Guard View 2.0 retrieves these measurements from the monitor and displays them in a variety of formats. GAS-Guard monitors measure, record, and report the status of fault gases in transformer insulating oil. GAS-Guard View 2.0 requires an Ethernet, dial-up, direct serial or radio link from the PC to the monitor in order to retrieve measurements and change settings. Transformer data retrieved by GAS-Guard View 2.0 is stored in ordinary files on the PC. Retrieving data does not cause the monitor to lose or delete its internal measurement history. This allows more than one computer running GAS-Guard View 2.0 to remotely retrieve data from a single GAS-Guard monitor. Alternatively, the security features of GASGuard View 2.0 can be used to restrict monitor access to a single, privileged installation on a single computer.
6 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Note: GAS-Guard View 2.0 is fully compatible with transformer data files created by GAS-Guard View version 1.6 or earlier. After you install or upgrade to GAS-Guard View 2.0 software, however, all GAS-Guard View users at your site must upgrade to version 2.0. Files created or updated with Siemens’ GAS-Guard View 2.0 software cannot be viewed using older versions of GAS-Guard View software. Users who have not upgraded will be notified of an error when they attempt to view or update these files.
GAS-Guard View 2.0 Feature Overview End date and time range controls
Tabs
Viewing pane
Menu bar Application Toolbar Transformer Asset Graph Toolbar Navigation pane Figure 1. GAS-Guard View 2.0 User Interface Overview. Navigation pane: allows selection of the company, site, transformer or monitor for viewing. In addition, the icons provide notification information (e.g. “attention required”, “data not accessible”) about the status of monitored assets. Viewing pane: contains one or more tabs. The tabs collectively display the state of the asset or other item selected in the Navigation pane. Each tab contains a separate purpose-built display. For transformer assets, the available tabs include the Status view, Gas in Oil PPM graph, Limits view, Percent of Alarm graph, Sensor and Extractor Data graphs, Retention Times graph, and Verification Data graph.
7 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Menu bar: allows selection of user commands. Application Tool bar: contains the End Date and Range controls. End Date and Range controls: affect the display of data for many of the tabs that appear in the viewing pane, particularly the graphs. Changing the setting of either control causes an immediate refresh of the viewing pane to conform to the new setting. The default End Date is the timestamp of the most recent available data while the default Range is 1 month. Graph Toolbar: Displayed only when a graph is visible. Contains commands specific to graphs. Later sections of this document describe all features of the user interface in detail.
8 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Installing GAS-Guard View 2.0 System Requirements Siemens GAS-Guard View 2.0 requires a computer with 533 MHz Pentium-III or higher and minimum 128MB of memory (192MB recommended). 1024x768 or higher screen resolution is highly recommended (visual anomalies may occur on an 800x600 display). The video system must be configured to display at least 256 colors. Siemens strongly recommends use of the highest color mode available from your display subsystem. This may be called “high color”, “true color”, “24-bit color”, or “32-bit color” depending on your vendor. Installation requires approximately 50MB of hard disk space. At least 20MB of additional space should be available for normal use. Actual disk usage varies with the number of monitored assets. Siemens GAS-Guard View 2.0 is a Windows®-based application. This product works with Windows 2000, Windows XP, or Windows Server 2003 operating systems. Windows 98, Windows ME, and Windows NT® operating systems are not supported. Microsoft Windows Vista® is not supported. GAS-Guard View 2.0 requires the Microsoft .NET Framework version 2.0.
Choosing an Installation Configuration Siemens GAS-Guard View 2.0 may be installed in any one of three configurations: Viewer Only, Server or Standalone. In order to choose the configuration that best meets your needs, it is helpful to know a little about the internal organization of GAS-Guard View 2.0 software. GAS-Guard View 2.0 is made up of two major components, the Viewer and the Poller. The Viewer is the application you see and interact with. The Poller works "behind the scenes,” communicating with your Siemens monitor(s) and saving the data they gather in files. In the Viewer Only configuration, as the name implies, the Poller component is not installed. Viewer Only installations are limited to accessing data retrieved and stored in files by some other GAS-Guard View 2.0 installation. This configuration is appropriate in a workgroup setting where some users access transformer data but do not have the need or the ability to communicate directly with Siemens monitors from their computer. The Server configuration is the counterpart of the Viewer configuration. It functions as the point of communication with your Siemens monitors. A Server installation can receive monitor data when no user is logged in. Server installations are particularly appropriate when the host computer operates continuously and has ongoing access to the necessary communications resources (modems, network adapters, etc.) Server installations are frequently unattended and may be expected to operate “24x7” for long periods of time. To install a Server configuration, you are required to specify an account identity under which the Poller component will execute. To be successful at this task, you should have 9 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
knowledge of Windows file sharing and network security fundamentals. The account you choose must have sufficient privileges. These include the privilege to access all files (including network files) that will be used by the Poller and also privilege to use the systemwide portion of the Registry. In keeping with industry best practices, Siemens recommends that you do not assign unnecessary privileges to this account. If these concepts are not clear to you, Siemens recommends that you create a Standalone configuration. In the Standalone configuration, the Poller component is installed in your Startup folder and runs only when you are logged in. Data cannot be received from the monitor when you are not logged in. The benefit of the Standalone configuration is that it largely eliminates the need for special knowledge of file sharing and network security. A Standalone installation of GAS-Guard View 2.0 behaves like a traditional desktop application program. Note that this configuration is intended for use by a single user on a single computer. If multiple user login identities will be accessing GAS-Guard View 2.0 on the same computer, Siemens recommends that a Server configuration be used instead.
Installation Procedure Note: Administrative privilege is required to install the software. When you insert the installation CD-ROM, GAS-Guard View 2.0 setup should start automatically. If it does not, please double click setup.exe in the INSTALL folder of the CDROM to start it. Setup will install the necessary prerequisite software and then install version 2.0 of GAS-Guard View. GAS-Guard View 2.0 requires version 2.0 of the Microsoft .NET Framework. If the installation program detects that this mandatory prerequisite is not present, it will be installed automatically from the CD-ROM. Siemens recommends that you use Windows Update to check for any recent updates to Microsoft components after installing GAS-Guard View 2.0 on your computer. When installation is complete, you may start GAS-Guard View 2.0 using either the Start menu or the Desktop icon.
Upgrade Procedure Note: Administrative privilege is required to upgrade the software. Insert the installation CD-ROM. GAS-Guard View 2.0 setup should start automatically. If it does not, please double click SETUP.EXE in the INSTALL folder of the CD-ROM to start it. 10 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Setup will automatically upgrade your existing installation to version 2.0 of GAS-Guard View. GAS-Guard View 2.0 requires version 2.0 of the Microsoft .NET Framework. If the installation program detects that this mandatory prerequisite is not present, it will be installed automatically from the CD-ROM. Note: GAS-Guard View 2.0 is fully compatible with transformer data files created by GAS-Guard View version 1.6 or earlier. After you install or upgrade to Siemens GAS-Guard View 2.0 software, however, all GAS-Guard View users at your site must upgrade to version 2.0. Files created or updated with Siemens GAS-Guard View 2.0 software cannot be viewed using older versions of GAS-Guard View software. Users who have not upgraded will be notified of an error when they attempt to view or update these files. Siemens recommends that you use Windows Update to check for any recent updates to Microsoft components after upgrading to GAS-Guard View version 2.0 on your computer. When installation is complete, you may start GAS-Guard View 2.0 using either the Start menu or the Desktop icon.
11 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Using GAS-Guard View 2.0 This chapter contains an informal guide to the features of GAS-Guard View 2.0. Details of each part of the user interface appear in the GAS-Guard View Reference chapter later in this manual.
Starting GAS-Guard View 2.0 Upon successful installation, a GAS-Guard View 2.0 icon is created on the Desktop and a GAS-Guard View 2.0 item is created in Start Program Files Siemens. Use one of these shortcuts to launch GAS-Guard View. The navigation pane will display the message No Files and the Welcome screen will be displayed. The Welcome screen is shown in Figure 2. GAS-Guard View 2.0 Welcome Screen.
Figure 2. GAS-Guard View 2.0 Welcome Screen. You can now install and open the sample files as described on the Welcome screen. You can also create a new transformer data file if your installation configuration supports this operation (Viewer Only configurations do not support the creation of new files). 12 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Alternatively, if this installation is an upgrade from GAS-Guard View 1.62 or earlier and you have existing transformer data files, you can open these files.
Creating New Files (Adding an Asset) Note: this operation is available if you selected the Standalone or Server configuration during installation. If you selected Viewer Only, operations that create and modify files are not available to you. To add a new monitored asset to the navigation pane, create a new file. The file holds all measurements and other information about the asset, its monitor, and its place in the navigation hierarchy. Use File New… to create a new file. This menu item displays the New File Creation wizard. The first page of the wizard is shown in Figure 3. New File Creation wizard, initial page.
Figure 3. New File Creation wizard, initial page. When you click Next, the wizard presents a series of pages that collect the information required to display and communicate with a Siemens monitor. At the conclusion of the 13 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
wizard, the new asset and its monitor are added to your navigation pane for display and/or update (polling). For a detailed description of the wizard, see the section Configuring Communications later in this manual.
Opening Files To familiarize yourself with the GAS-Guard View 2.0 user interface, you may examine the sample files. To do so, first click the Install Sample Files button on the Welcome screen or click Install Sample Files… in the Help menu. Use the browse box to choose a location (e.g. your My Documents folder). When you click OK, the files are copied to the location you chose (e.g., My Documents). You do not need the installation media to install the sample files. Now select Open… from the File menu and navigate to the location you selected in the previous step. Select one of the sample files and click the Open button. The file contents are added to the navigation pane. The viewing pane displays the Status tab shown in Figure 4.
Figure 4. Asset selected in navigation pane and Status tab displayed in viewing pane.
14 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Note: since the contents of the sample files were captured some time ago, the Data Age section on the Status tab warns you that the file contents are not up-to-date and the Alarm History section displays the message WARNING: No Recent Gas Data. Additional information about the Status tab can be found in the section Using the Asset Status Tab later in this manual.
Navigating to Company, Sites, Assets and Monitors The navigation pane is used to select a company, site, transformer or monitor for display. It is organized as a hierarchy of Company, Sites, Assets and their Monitors. Its structure is similar to the navigation pane found in Windows Explorer and in many other software applications and web sites. The navigation pane remembers all the files you have opened and provides easy access to their contents. When you open additional files, their contents are merged with existing sites and companies if the names match. Click on the small + adjacent to an icon to expand it. Expanding the transformer icon, for example, displays the icon representing the monitor. If you then click the monitor icon, the viewing pane redraws to show tabs specific to managing the monitor’s operation (scheduling and communications).
Navigation Pane Icons and Notification Icons in the navigation pane change to notify you of conditions that may require your attention. By default, items in the navigation pane are represented by the basic icons shown in Figure 5. Folder icon representing a Company or Site Icon representing a Transformer Asset Icon representing an Online Transformer Monitor
Figure 5. Basic icons.
15 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
When an alarm or caution condition is encountered on a transformer asset, or a service required condition is encountered on a transformer monitor, the corresponding icon is temporarily replaced by the pending notification icon: a yellow triangle containing an exclamation point. The pending notification icon is shown in Figure 6.
Icon representing an item that requires your attention
Figure 6. Pending notification icon After an asset or monitor with a pending notification is selected and displayed in more detail, the icon is replaced by an acknowledged notification icon. This appears as the original transformer or monitor icon with a tiny yellow triangle superimposed at upper right. The acknowledged notification icon is displayed as long as the original condition (alarm, caution, or service required) is present. When an update (polling operation) is performed and the condition is cleared, the acknowledged notification icon is replaced by the company, site, transformer or monitor icon. The acknowledged notification icons are shown in Figure 7.
Icon representing a Company or Site holding an item with a condition that has been acknowledged Icon representing a Transformer condition that has been acknowledged Icon representing an Online Transformer Monitor condition that has been acknowledged.
Figure 7. Acknowledged notification icons Pending and acknowledged notification icons propagate upward in the navigation pane. If any of the assets in a site are in a notification condition, the site icon displays the highest priority (pending or acknowledged) notification icon for any of its assets. Similarly, if any of a company’s sites are in a notification state, the company icon will also display the highest priority icon. This behavior allows you to determine at a glance when one of your assets or monitors requires attention.
16 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Finally, distinct icons are displayed for companies, sites, assets or monitors when their data is contained in a file that cannot be accessed by GAS-Guard View 2.0. These icons appear as the original company, site, asset or monitor icon with a tiny white x on a red background superimposed at upper right. The inaccessible file icons are shown in Figure 8. Icon representing a Company or Site contained in a file or files that are not accessible to GAS-Guard View Icon representing a Transformer contained in a file that is not accessible to GAS-Guard View Icon representing an Online Transformer Monitor contained in a file that is not accessible to GASGuard View Figure 8. Inaccessible file icons A file may be inaccessible because: It has been moved or deleted, or It is stored on a file share that is not accessible because of an interruption in your network service, or You no longer have the permissions required to access the file, or The contents of the file have become corrupted so that GAS-Guard View 2.0 can no longer load them. When you click on an icon representing an inaccessible company, site, asset, or monitor, the item does not become selected and the contents of the Viewing pane do not change. Instead, a dialog box is displayed. The dialog box text provides a short explanation of the reason the item is inaccessible, e.g. file not found.
Working with Files Using Legacy Files Files created by GAS-Guard View version 1.6 (or earlier) are considered “legacy” files. GAS-Guard View 2.0 is fully compatible with legacy files. After you install or upgrade to Siemens GAS-Guard View 2.0 software, all GAS-Guard View users at your site must upgrade to version 2.0. Files created or updated with Siemens GASGuard View 2.0 software cannot be viewed using older versions of GAS-Guard View software. Users who have not upgraded will be notified of an error when they attempt to view or update a file created or updated by GAS-Guard View 2.0.
17 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Legacy files do not contain Company, Site or Asset Name information for use in the Navigation pane so GAS-Guard View 2.0 uses the default terms Company, Site, and Asset in the navigation pane. You can change these default names to your actual company, site and asset names. To change a name, first select the Company, Site, or Asset icon in the Navigation pane and then click Rename… in the Action menu. Updated values are stored in the file itself so the change need only be performed once. Please see the Menu Commands section of this manual for more information.
Corrupt or Invalid Files GAS-Guard View 2.0 differs from earlier versions of GAS-Guard View in its handling of corrupt or invalid files. GAS-Guard View 2.0 generally detects and refuses to open corrupt or invalid files where earlier versions of GAS-Guard View may have provided partial functionality or behaved incorrectly. If you encounter a Corrupt or Invalid message when opening a legacy file, please see the Troubleshooting section of this manual or contact Siemens or your Siemens representative for assistance. In most cases, corrupt or invalid files can be repaired without loss of data.
Removing a File from the Navigation Pane The contents of all the files you have created (File New…) or opened (File Open…) are shown in the navigation pane. If you close GAS-Guard View 2.0, the contents of the navigation pane are preserved: when you restart GAS-Guard View 2.0, navigation pane contents are unchanged. If you no longer wish to view one or more assets or their monitors, you can remove them from your navigator using File Close. This menu item displays the Close Files dialog shown in Figure 9.
18 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Figure 9. Close Files dialog. Select the row(s) containing the monitor(s) you no longer wish to view and click OK. The dialog clears and the screen is redrawn. If you close all files, the No files message is displayed in the navigation pane and the Welcome screen appears in the viewing pane. Sites continue to be displayed so long as they contain any visible transformer assets, and companies continue to be displayed so long as they contain any visible sites. If you close all the transformers within a Site, the Site will disappear from your navigator as well. Closing a file merely removes the file from the navigation pane. It does not delete or alter the file data itself. To again display information for a transformer and its monitor in GASGuard View 2.0, use File Open… to add the file to the navigation pane.
Using Commands Commands (user actions) appear in the GAS-Guard View 2.0 menu bar. Menu items are unavailable (“grayed out”) when they do not apply to the current selection; for example, the File Export… menu item is available only when the Viewing Pane shows data that may be exported. Otherwise, it is grayed out.
19 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Note: if your GAS-Guard View 2.0 installation is a Viewer Only configuration, all commands that update or modify data are unavailable to you. These commands must be performed from a Standalone or Server configuration. The contents of the Action menu change according to the currently selected navigation item and tab. The command to Enter DGA…, for example, is only available when viewing the Gas in Oil graph that displays the DGA data. The Enter DGA command does not appear in the menu when viewing other navigational selections or tabs. Some Action menu commands are always present. These commands affect the GAS-Guard View 2.0 application as a whole and appear at the top of the Action menu. They include Select Modem and Send Diagnostic Data. All GAS-Guard View 2.0 commands are described in the Menu Commands section of the GAS-Guard View Reference section of this manual.
Using Tabs This section provides an overview of the status and graphing tabs.
Using the Asset Status Tab When a transformer asset is selected, the default (leftmost) tab presents a dashboard-like status overview. The tab contains colored status indicators, an Alarm History display, and certain textual information. The tab is shown in Figure 10.
20 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Figure 10. Status tab. The groups of colored indicators on the upper left show: The state of the gas PPM level alarm. The state of the gas rate of change (ROC) alarm. The status of the monitor. The data age (an indication of whether data has recently been obtained from the monitor). The Event History section shows the status reported by the selected monitor over the previous several days. This display expands to fill the available screen width. The colored vertical bars represent the outcome of sample runs and other significant monitoring events. Bars that represent successful sample runs are colored green, yellow or red to indicate the most urgent condition detected by that sample run (normal, caution, or alarm). Black bars are displayed to indicate that the monitor aborted a run due an error, and blue bars indicate that the monitor encountered a Service Required condition. If the most recent data is more than about 48 hours old, the Event History label displays WARNING: No Recent Gas Data in red.
21 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Note: for more information about sample runs, Service Required conditions, and other Siemens Online Transformer Monitor principles of operation, please consult the documentation that was provided with your monitor or visit http://www.serveron.com. To obtain details of a particular day’s runs and other significant monitor events, move the mouse pointer over the rectangle (tile) representing that day and click. A small dialog box will be shown containing details of that day’s activity. Click OK to clear the dialog. The Action menu for the Status tab contains several commands. For details of these commands, please refer to the GAS-Guard View Reference chapter later in this manual.
Using the Graphs The Gas in Oil PPM, Rate of Change, and Percent of Alarm graph tabs share several key features. The content of a typical graph tab is shown in Figure 11. Graph toolbar
Secondary Y (sensor) axis
DGA legend
Graph title DGA Primary Y axis label
Primary Y (gas value) axis
X (time) axis
Graph legend Figure 11. Graph tab components.
These graphs display two vertical (Y) axes, one at the left and the other at the right. The values of gases are always displayed relative to the left or primary axis, which may be either logarithmic or linear. Sensor readings (LoadGuide, Ambient Temperature, etc) are displayed relative to the right or secondary axis, which always displays a linear scale.
22 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
A graph legend indicating the color of each gas or sensor data series appears to the right of the graph area. The graph legend relates colors to measured values. Carbon Monoxide (CO), for example, is always shown in red. When a graph is first displayed, measured gas values are shown while computed values and sensor values are hidden. The colored circle adjacent to each series names in the legend is a control buttons. To display or hide a particular gas or sensor data series, click the appropriate button. Siemens GAS-Guard model GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 monitors support configurable labeling for external sensors. For these models, the external sensor labels are taken from information stored in the transformer monitor itself. The labels are normally configured when the monitor is installed. GAS-Guard View 2.0 does not support the ability to change the configured labels. The legend information at extreme upper right indicates that one or more manual dissolved gas analysis (DGA) readings are currently being displayed on the graph. This legend block appears only when manual DGA readings are being shown. On the graph surface, manual DGA data appears as small x markers in the color of the corresponding gas data series. To see the numerical values of DGA data, simply slide the mouse over the area of the DGA. For more information about the Gas in Oil PPM, Rate of Change, and Percent of Alarm tabs, including instructions for entering manual DGA readings, see the corresponding section in the GAS-Guard View Reference chapter later in this manual. Graph Toolbar Graph tabs contain their own toolbar. It is distinct from the Application Toolbar that contains the End Date and Range controls. The graph toolbar is detailed in Figure 12.
Annotate
Copy to Clipboard
Toggle: Annotations
Print
Display Rogers Ratio Viewer
Toggle: Point Labels
Toggle: Data Table
Toggle: Zoom
Figure 12. Graph Toolbar 23 of 70
Toggle: Primary Y axis log/linear
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Copy to Clipboard. This button allows the graph contents to be transferred to the Windows Clipboard in one of three formats: bitmap, metafile, and text. Bitmap and metafile are image formats compatible with many other applications. Text format allows the graph data to be copied. In most cases, better results can be achieved with the File Export menu item, which is described in the GAS-Guard View Menu Commands section of this manual. Print. This button allows the graph contents to be printed. Its behavior is identical to the File Print menu item, also described in the Menu Commands section. Point Labels. This button allows point labels to be displayed or hidden. Point labels are most useful when only a limited number of points are displayed (for example, a 3-day view). Data Table. GAS-Guard View 2.0 can display a data table which provides a tabular data view of the data that is linked to the graph contents. The Data Table button allows the data table to be displayed or hidden. When the mouse is moved over Data Table cells, the corresponding point in the graph series is highlighted. When the mouse is moved over a point in the graph series, the Data Table is automatically scrolled to display the corresponding cell and that cell is highlighted. Zoom. The zoom button enables or disables “zooming” the graph. With zoom enabled, you can click in the graph area at the upper left corner of the area you wish to enlarge and drag the mouse down and to the right to define the area you wish to display. When you release the mouse button the selected area expands to fill the entire graph region and sliders (similar to scroll bars) are displayed to allow the graph to be repositioned. You may zoom repeatedly to magnify smaller areas or click the toggle again to restore the original resolution. Log Scale. The log/linear button changes the primary Y axis from a log scale to a linear scale and back. Display of sensor values is not affected. Sensor values are displayed relative to the secondary Y axis, which is always linear and displays a fixed range suitable for sensors supported by Siemens. Display Rogers Ratio Viewer. Clicking this button displays the Rogers Ratio Viewer, a graphical transformer diagnostic display. The Rogers Ratio Viewer requires a Diagnostic Package license from Serveron. For more information about licensing, see Installing and Using Licenses. For more information about the Rogers Ratio Viewer, see Using the Rogers Ratio Viewer. Toggle Annotations. This button toggles the display of graph annotation markers. Annotations are notes attached to particular points in time on the graph while their markers are cartoon-style “thought bubbles.” To see the annotation contents, move the mouse over the marker or click within the bubble. Annotate. Clicking this button displays the Annotate dialog box, which allows you to enter annotations (notes) that are associated with a point in time on the graph. In order to annotate graphs, you must obtain a Diagnostic Package license from Serveron. For more information about licensing, see Installing and Using Licenses.
24 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Installing and Using Licenses Your initial installation of GAS-Guard View 2.0 is a fully-functional application for monitoring and managing Siemens Online Transformer monitors. In addition, Siemens offers options that require separate licensing. The options include: The Automatic Scheduled Polling option, which provides the ability to perform automatic scheduled polling for more than one monitor (automatic scheduled polling for a single monitor is included in the initial installation). The Diagnostics Package option, which includes Duval’s Triangle, the Roger’s Ratio Viewer, and the ability to annotate graphs. This section explains how to obtain, install, and use licenses for these extended features. To purchase licenses, please contact Siemens or your Siemens representative.
Overview Licensed features are enabled through a two-step process. The process begins when you transmit your Machine ID via email to Serveron and is completed when you receive the license key corresponding to the desired feature. You then install the license key into your GAS-Guard View 2.0 installation in order to enable the feature. Your installation has only one Machine ID, but you must obtain one license key from Serveron for each option you wish to access. In order to obtain a license key, you must first install GAS-Guard View 2.0 in either the Standalone or the Server configuration. Requesting and installing license keys are administrative activities that cannot be performed from a Viewer Only configuration. To begin the process, start GAS-Guard View 2.0 and then click Licensing… in the Help menu to display the Licensing dialog. After a moment, the dialog box displays your Machine ID and enables the Copy to Clipboard button. Create an email message. Address it to
[email protected] with subject License Request. Paste the Machine ID into the body of the message. It should look like this (your Machine ID value will be different): Machine ID: 5F01-7C60-F311-43B2-3A8D Send the email message. Serveron makes every effort to respond to license key requests within two business days, but cannot guarantee response. If you do not receive a timely response to your email, please contact Serveron Customer Support or your Serveron representative. When the email response arrives from Serveron, your license key will take the form of a text file attachment. Please save the file attachment to a known, and preferably backed up directory on your PC or another safe location. If you are ever forced to perform a complete re-installation of GAS-Guard View 2.0, you may need to re-install your license keys. After saving the license key file attachment, open GAS-Guard View 2.0 and again click Licensing… in the Help menu to display the Licensing dialog. Click the Browse… button located at left to display a standard Open File dialog. Navigate to the license key file (the attachment you saved). Select the file and click OK. After a short pause, GAS-Guard View 25 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
2.0 should respond with a dialog stating 1 license key installed. If it does not, please try the operation again. If the problem reoccurs, please contact Siemens or your Siemens representative. You can now make use of the feature or features enabled by your license.
Automatic Scheduled Polling Option GAS-Guard View 2.0 maintains an internal table of licenses available for automatic polling. Each license enables automatic polling for a single monitor. When you install GAS-Guard View 2.0 in either the Standalone or Server configuration, the table is initialized with one (1) license. An automated polling license key encodes a number of additional licenses. Licenses are available from Serveron in groups of 6, 12, or unlimited. When you install the key as described above, the additional licenses you purchased are placed in the internallymanaged table. To access your automatic polling licenses, select the Company node in the navigator and click the Polling tab. The viewing pane should show a list of monitors. Click on a monitor (row) to select it and then click Update Automatic Polling Status… in the Action menu. The Update Automatic Polling Status dialog box appears. The dialog box shows the number of automated polling licenses available in the pool. The value is 1 when you first install GAS-Guard View 2.0. When you add licenses, the value increases by the number of additional licenses you purchased (6, 12, or unlimited). Automated polling for a monitor is enabled by checking Automatically poll this monitor in the Update Automatic Polling Status dialog. When you click OK, one license is removed from the internally managed table and assigned to the selected monitor. The number of available licenses remaining in the table is reduced by one (if you purchased an unlimited license, the table still contains an unlimited number of licenses). If you uncheck Automatically poll this monitor for an automatically polled monitor or use File Close to close the file, its license is automatically returned to the internally managed table. This increases the number of available polling licenses by one. This table-based design allows you to “float” a smaller number of licenses across a larger number of monitors should you choose to do so.
Diagnostics Package Option The Diagnostics Package includes the Duval Triangle display, the Rogers Ratio Viewer, and the ability to place annotations (comments) on graphs. Diagnostic license keys are available from Serveron in groups of 6, 12, or unlimited. License keys are obtained and installed using the procedure described earlier. Once installed, the licenses must be assigned to a particular monitor in order to take effect.
26 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Note: Diagnostic licenses cannot be reassigned. Unlike automated polling licenses, Diagnostic licenses do not “float.” When you install a license key for the Diagnostic Package, the licenses you purchased are placed in an internally managed table. When you assign a license to a monitor, the license is removed from the internally managed table and assigned to the monitor. Unlike Automated Polling licenses, the assignment of a diagnostic license to a monitor serial number is final and irrevocable. There is no “undo.” To access your Diagnostics Package licenses, first obtain and install the license key using the procedure described earlier. Then click Licensing… on the Help menu and select the Diagnostics tab. The tab shows a list of known monitors (from the Navigation pane) and the licensing status of each. To assign a license to a monitor, click in the left list to select it and then click Assign… You will receive a warning indicating that license assignment cannot be revoked or undone. Carefully check that you have selected the monitor you wish to license and then click OK. The monitor’s serial number transfers to the rightmost list indicating the monitor is now licensed. Note: after assigning the license, you must poll the monitor before the license will take effect. Polling the monitor stores encrypted licensing information in the file so the Viewer can access it. You may use the Poll Now menu item in the Action menu or, if the monitor is being automatically polled, simply wait for the next automatic polling cycle to occur. After polling the monitor, click on the monitored transformer asset in the Navigation pane and access the Diagnostic Package features for the monitor. For example, select the Duval Triangle tab to display the Triangle. Each time a monitor is polled, GAS-Guard View 2.0 checks to see whether the monitor being polled has been assigned a Diagnostic Package license. If so, GAS-Guard View 2.0 stores licensing information in the file itself. Any GAS-Guard View 2.0 installation that opens the file checks for the presence of this licensing information. If valid licensing information is found in the file, GAS-Guard View 2.0 enables its diagnostic features for the data found in that file. This design ensures that once a Diagnostics license is issued to a monitor, anyone viewing the monitor’s data using GAS-Guard View 2.0 will have access to all Diagnostic Package features. If, for example, you send a transformer data file to a transformer expert at another location within your organization, the file carries its own licensing information along with it. If the remote expert opens the file using their own standalone GAS-Guard View 2.0 installation, all Diagnostic Package features will be enabled. Similarly, workgroup users with Viewer Only installation configurations will have access to Diagnostics Package display features for any properly licensed monitor.
27 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View 2.0 Reference This chapter contains details of every tab and menu command in the GAS-Guard View 2.0 user interface. The next section describes the navigation pane. The tabs are discussed in the Viewing Pane section. Menu items are documented in the Menu Commands section that follows. For reference, the user interface overview is shown in Figure 13.
End date and time range controls
Tabs
Viewing pane
Menu bar Application Toolbar Transformer Asset
Graph Toolbar Navigation pane
. Figure 13. GAS-Guard View 2.0 User Interface Overview.
Navigation Pane The navigation pane contains a hierarchical list (sometimes called a tree) showing the company, sites, assets and monitors defined in all the files you have opened or created. Each item in the navigation pane is identified by an icon. The icons are shown in Figure 14.
28 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Folder icon representing a Company or Site Icon representing a Transformer Asset Icon representing an Online Transformer Monitor
Figure 14. Navigation pane icons. To expand an icon, displaying the items it contains, click the + (plus) adjacent to a collapsed icon. To collapse the icon, hiding the items it contains, click the – (minus) adjacent to an expanded icon. When you select an icon by clicking on it, the viewing pane is redrawn with tabs that are appropriate to display information about the selected item. Icons in the navigation pane change to notify you of conditions that may require your attention. For details of the alternative icons used for notification, please refer to Navigation Pane Icons and Notification. To add to the navigation pane, click New… or Open… in the File menu. To remove items, click Close… in the File menu. For detailed descriptions of these commands, please see the Menu Commands section later in this manual.
Viewing Pane This section contains additional details about the tabs that appear in the viewing pane. The current selection in the navigation pane determines which tabs appear in the Viewing Pane. Your selection will most frequently be an icon representing a transformer asset. All tabs associated with transformer assets are described in the next subsection, Transformer Asset Tabs. Less frequently, you will select a Company, Site or Monitor icon in the navigation pane. Tabs associated with these selection types are described in subsequent sections,
Transformer Asset Tabs This section discusses the tabs that appear when a transformer asset is selected in the navigation pane. Status Tab The Status tab is the default when a transformer asset is selected. It displays a dashboardlike display of the status of the selected asset. The following indicators are provided: 29 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Gas PPM Level Status and Gas ROC Status. These three-level indicators show the results of the most recent sample obtained from the monitor. They display alarm (red) to indicate that the monitor encountered a gas alarm condition on the most recent sample run or caution (yellow) to indicate a gas caution condition. If no cautions or warnings were detected on the most recent sample run, both indicators display normal (green). If no readings have ever been received, all three indicators display background gray. Monitor Status. This two-level indicator displays service required (blue) to indicate that the monitor has encountered a service required condition. The blue indicator mimics the blue Service Required lamp on the front panel of the monitor itself. The indicator displays normal (green) to indicate a healthy monitor. If no data has ever been received from the monitor, both indicators display background gray. Data Age. This three-level indicator shows whether gas in oil data from the monitor is up to date or needs to be refreshed by polling the monitor. 0 – 8 Hours Old (green) indicates that the timestamp of the most recently-received sample run is from 0 to approximately 8 hours old. 8 – 24 Hours Old (yellow) indicates the most recent sample is more than about 8 hours old but no older than about 24 hours. 24 Hours or Older (red) indicates that the most recent sample is more than about 24 hours old. If no sample data has ever been received from the monitor, all three indicators display background gray. Event History. This horizontal region shows the monitor’s activity over recent days. Each rectangular block or tile displays one day’s activities with the most recent day’s activity appearing at right. Within a day’s tile, the colored vertical bars indicate one significant activity by the monitor. Most activities are sample runs, which appear as green, yellow or red bars to indicate their most urgent outcome (normal, caution, or alarm, respectively). Service required conditions, if any, are displayed as vertical blue bars. Aborted runs are shown as black bars. Finally, non-sample runs are displayed as vertical white bars. Most non-sample runs are regularlyscheduled verification runs. If no data has ever been received from the monitor, the Event History block is empty. Note: for more information about sample runs, Service Required conditions, and other Siemens Online Transformer Monitor principles of operation, please consult the documentation that was provided with your monitor or visit http://www.serveron.com. Textual Information. At the bottom of the screen textual information about the monitor is displayed. The Latest Monitor Timestamp is the timestamp on the most recent piece of significant information (service required event, sample run, etc) received from the monitor. Below the Latest Monitor Timestamp, the Status screen displays the monitor’s serial number and model information for reference purposes. Many commands are available in the Action menu when viewing the Status tab. These commands are documented in the Action Menu section later in this manual.
30 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Gas in Oil Tab Overview The Gas in Oil tab is shown when a transformer asset is selected. Figure 15 shows the Gas in Oil tab.
End date and time range controls
Tabs
Viewing pane
Menu bar Application Toolbar Transformer Asset Graph Toolbar Navigation pane Figure 15. Gas in Oil tab. This tab displays a graph showing the measured levels of gases. Depending on the type of Siemens GAS-Guard transformer monitor used (8 gases or 3 gases), the display will include either eight gases (Hydrogen (H2), Oxygen (O2), Methane (CH4), Carbon Monoxide (CO), Carbon Dioxide (CO2), Ethane (C2H6), Ethylene (C2H4), and Acetylene (C2H2) – model GAS-Guard 8) or three gases (Methane (CH4), Ethylene (C2H4), and Acetylene (C2H2) – model GAS-Guard 3). By default, gas values are displayed on a logarithmic axis. Siemens’s 8 gas analyzers also display a computed estimation of Nitrogen (N2), Total Dissolved Combustible Gas (TDCG), and Total Hydrocarbons (THC). TDCG is the sum of Hydrogen (H2), Carbon Monoxide (CO), Ethane (C2H6), Ethylene (C2H4), Acetylene (C2H2), and Methane (CH4). THC is the sum of Ethane (C2H6), Ethylene (C2H4), Acetylene (C2H2), and Methane (CH4). In all cases, gases are displayed in parts per million (PPM), gas in oil, over a selectable time period (default 1 month). The Gas in Oil tab also displays the levels of external sensors including LoadGuide™, ambient temperature, and oil temperature as well as several optional sensors (oil moisture PPM, oil moisture percent relative saturation (%RS) and auxiliary temperature.)
31 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Note: data from optional oil moisture and temperature sensors is displayed only if sensors are installed and correctly configured. For more information about oil moisture and temperature sensors, please contact your Siemens representative. To display or hide a particular data series, click the small colored button immediately to the left of the series name in the graph legend. Gas values are displayed relative to the left (Gas PPM) axis, which is logarithmic by default; the left axis may be changed to linear by clicking the Log button in the graph toolbar. Sensor values are displayed relative to the right (Sensor Value) axis, which is linear. For more information about axis, legends, and the graph toolbar, please see the section Using the Graphs earlier in this manual. The graph legend relates colors to measured values. Carbon Monoxide (CO), for example, is always shown in red. By default, gas values (except Nitrogen) are shown and all sensor values are hidden. Commands When viewing a Gas in Oil graph, the Action menu contains the tab-specific commands Enter DGA… and Start Sample Run. Selecting Enter DGA… displays the Enter DGA Data dialog box, which contains a simple spreadsheet-like data editor. Set the date of your manual DGA report in the Record Time field and enter the values for the nine supported gases. You may enter multiple rows or correct existing entries. When you click OK, the DGA data is saved and displayed on the graph. For more details about the DGA data display, see Displaying Manual DGA Data below. Selecting Start Sample Run immediately contacts the monitor to begin a sample run. Since sample runs are scheduled automatically by the monitor, use of this command is rarely required. Note: to adjust the monitor’s sampling schedule, click the monitor icon in the navigation pane, then click the Sampling tab, and finally click Update Sampling… in the Action menu. GAS-Guard View 2.0 displays the Update Sample Schedule dialog box. When you click OK, GAS-Guard View 2.0 immediately contacts the monitor and updates the schedule you have defined. Values Below the Lower Detection Limit (LDL) The lower detection limit (LDL) values for Siemens model GAS-Guard 8 and model GASGuard 3 monitors are specified in the Data Sheet for the respective monitor. The monitor may report values below these levels, however, and GAS-Guard View 2.0 will display them. Values below the LDL are visually distinguished by their pale translucent color. This pale color serves as a visual reminder that uncertainty is associated with the measurement.
32 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Displaying Manual DGA Data Manual DGA data is displayed as one or more small colored x markers on the Gas in Oil graph. The colors match the corresponding data series, i.e. CO is displayed in red, H2 in blue, etc. Moving the mouse pointer near a DGA reading on the graph surface displays a popup window showing the exact numerical value of each of the DGA measurements. Note: if you have a Siemens model GAS-Guard 3 monitor, only the GASGuard 3 gases (CH4, C2H2, and C2H4) are displayed on the graph. You may enter values for all 9 fields in the dialog box, however. When you move the mouse over the DGA sample area, all 9 gas in oil values are shown in the pop-up window. Disabling a data series by clicking in the graph legend also disables the corresponding DGA value from appearing on the graph. When DGA data is visible on the graph, a small DGA legend appears at the upper right corner of the screen to indicate the meaning of the display. Limits Tab The Limits tab is shown when a transformer asset is selected. It displays caution (warning) and alarm limits for the eight measured gases and TDCG (TrueGas and model GAS-Guard 8 monitors) or for three measured gases (model GAS-Guard 3 monitor). Limits are displayed for both gas in oil PPM level and gas in oil rate of change (ROC, reported in PPM/day). This tab also displays the most recently measured values reported by the monitor for gas in oil, rate of change, and goodness of fit (a quality metric for the current ROC value). Note: ROC data is available from model GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 monitors only. The TrueGas monitor does not measure or report ROC data. ROC alarm and caution limits cannot be set for the TrueGas monitor. To change the limits, click Update Limits… in the Action menu. This displays the Update Alarm and Caution Limits dialog box. To change a limit, click in the desired cell and type the new value. When you click OK, the monitor is immediately updated. The viewing pane is refreshed when the update is complete. Percent of Alarm Tab The Percent of Alarm tab is shown when a transformer asset is selected. It displays measured gas values and TDCG normalized to their individual alarm or caution limit values. Example: suppose the alarm limit for H2 is 50 PPM and the alarm limit for C2H4 is 120 PPM. Further, suppose the measured value for H2 is 40 PPM and the measured value for
33 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
C2H4 is 60 PPM. Then the displayed value for H2 will be 80 (40 PPM is 80% of the limit value, 50 PPM) and the displayed value for C2H4 will be 50 (60 PPM is 50% of 120). Values may be displayed relative to their caution limits instead of their alarm limits by clicking one of the buttons at lower right. Sensor values (LoadGuide, Ambient Temp, etc.) do not have alarm or caution limits. Their actual values are shown relative to the right axis for reference purposes. No tab-specific commands are available in the Action menu when the Percent of Alarm tab is displayed. Rate of Change Tab The Rate of Change tab is shown when a transformer asset is selected and the transformer monitor is a Siemens model GAS-Guard 8 or GAS-Guard 3. This tab displays the smoothed rate of change (ROC) of gas in oil values expressed in PPM per day. ROC is not computed for sensor values (LoadGuide, Ambient Temp, etc.). Their actual values are shown relative to the right axis for reference purposes. No tab-specific commands are available in the Action menu when the Rate of Change tab is displayed. Duval Triangle Tab Note: the Duval’s Triangle tab displays data when a valid Diagnostic License accompanies the display data. To enable the Triangle, an administrator must obtain a Diagnostic License from Serveron or your Serveron representative, install the license, assign it to the appropriate monitor, and then poll the monitor. The Diagnostic License enables the Triangle for all GAS-Guard View 2.0 installations that view the data contained in the file. For more information, see Installing and Using Licenses. The Duval Triangle is an analytical tool developed by Dr. Michel Duval of IREQ (Hydro Quebec), Canada. The Triangle presents DGA (dissolved gas analysis) results in a graphical form by sorting them according to a list of faults as codified by IEC Publication 60599, "Mineral oil-impregnated electrical equipment in service- Guide to the interpretation of dissolved and free gases analysis," March 1999. For more information about the Triangle, see Using the Duval Triangle. Sensor Data Tab The Sensor Data tab is shown when a transformer asset is selected. It displays the values of internal sensors. This information is intended for use by trained Customer Service personnel. No tab-specific commands are available in the Action menu when the Sensor Data tab is displayed.
34 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Extractor Data Tab The Extractor Data tab is shown when a transformer asset is selected. This tab displays the status of internal sensors related to the transformer monitor’s gas extractor subsystem. This information is intended for use by trained Customer Service personnel. No tab-specific commands are available in the Action menu when the Extractor Data tab is displayed. Retention Time Tab The Retention Time tab is shown when a transformer asset is selected. The tab displays internal information about the status of the chromatography subsystem. This information is intended for use by trained Customer Service personnel. No tab-specific commands are available in the Action menu when the Retention Time tab is displayed. Verification Data Tab Overview The Verification Data tab is shown when a transformer asset is selected. It displays the results of all verification runs performed in the selected time interval. Verification runs measure gas levels from reference gas contained in the monitor’s calibration bottle instead of sample gas from the transformer asset being monitored. Sensor data is not displayed on the Verification Data graph. Commands When viewing the Verification Data tab, the Action menu contains the tab-specific commands Start Verification Run and Start Calibration Run. Selecting Start Verification Run immediately contacts the monitor to begin a verification run. Since verification runs are scheduled automatically by the monitor, use of this command is rarely required. Note: to adjust the monitor’s verification schedule, click the monitor icon in the navigation pane, then click the Sampling tab, and finally click Update Sampling… in the Action menu. GAS-Guard View 2.0 displays the Update Sample Schedule dialog box. When you click OK, GAS-Guard View 2.0 immediately contacts the monitor and updates the schedule you have defined. Selecting Start Calibration Run immediately contacts the monitor to begin a calibration run. Note: Siemens monitors contain an auto-calibration feature. Manual calibration runs should only be performed by trained Customer Service personnel.
35 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Company Specific Tabs This section describes the tabs that appear when you select an organization (typically your company) in the navigation pane. Your organization is usually the top of the navigation hierarchy. Welcome Tab The Welcome tab contains first-time startup instructions and a button that allows you to install the sample files. Note that you may also install or reinstall the sample files at any time by clicking the Help menu and selecting Install Sample Files. Polling Tab The Polling tab is the central point of administration for automatically scheduled polling. The tab shows a row-oriented display of all monitors known to the software. Each row contains several status columns. The display is updated every few seconds to reflect the latest status of each monitor. Each row in the list may be selected by clicking on it. Selecting a row enables some menu items in the Action menu. To configure automatic polling for a monitor, click the monitor’s row to select it and then choose Update Automatic Polling Status… from the Action menu. This displays the Update Automatic Polling Status dialog box.
36 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Figure 16. Polling Tab and Update Automatic Polling Status dialog box. The dialog box displays the number of available polling licenses. To enable automatic polling for a monitor, click the Automatically poll this monitor checkbox and then click OK. The dialog box displays the number of available automatic polling licenses. At least one license must be available to enable automatic polling. If no licenses are available, the checkbox is “grayed out” (unavailable). The Polling Period control can be used to configure the maximum polling period. GASGuard View 2.0 will poll the monitor at least as often as the configured value. GAS-Guard View 2.0 may poll the monitor more often in case of communication errors (retries) and certain monitor conditions. To immediately poll a monitor, click the monitor’s row and then choose Poll Now… from the Action menu (the Poll Now menu item performs the same function as the Poll Now item on the Asset Status tab. For more information about these menu items, see the Menu Commands section of this manual. Each row displayed by the Polling tab is composed of several fields (columns). The following fields are shown: Asset Name. The name of the transformer asset. 37 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Serial Number. The serial number of Siemens monitor. Auto Poll? This field displays Yes if the monitor is configured for automatic scheduled polling, No if it is not. Period. This field displays the maximum period between automatic polling updates in hours. If the unit is not configured for automatic polling (Auto Poll column displays No), this column retains its previous value or displays the default value of 4 hours. GAS-Guard View 2.0 may contact the monitor more frequently than the value shown in this field. For further details, see the Next Poll subsection below. Errors. This field displays the number of communication errors that have occurred since the monitor was last polled successfully. Each successful contact with the monitor resets the count to 0. Successfully Called. This field displays the date and time of the last successful call to the monitor. If the monitor has not been successfully contacted, the field is empty. Next Poll. This fields shows when the Poller component of GAS-Guard View 2.0 will next attempt to contact the monitor. In the simplest case, this value is approximately the time of the last successful call plus the value of the Period. The value may be different for several reasons. Two of the most common are: If a polling attempt fails, the Poller component will retry the failed attempt using an internally defined retry algorithm. The retry frequency may be different than the normal polling frequency. If the monitor begins sampling at an accelerated rate (e.g. hourly), the Poller will eventually detect the monitor’s behavior and begin polling more frequently in order to make timely data available to you. For more information about accelerated sampling, see Action Sample Hourly (Monitor selected, Sampling Tab) in the Menu Commands section. Status. When GAS-Guard View 2.0 is communicating with the monitor, this field displays the most recent status of the conversation, e.g. downloading a record, updating the host data file, etc. The last status is displayed within parenthesis after the communication is complete. File Name. This field displays the name of the file in which the monitor’s data is stored on the host. Status Tab The Status tab is shown when your organization (typically, your company) is selected in the navigation pane. The Status tab displays a flat list of your organization’s sites. The list is not navigable.
Site Specific Tabs This section describes the tabs that appear when you select a site icon in the navigation pane.
38 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Status Tab The Status tab is shown when one of your organization’s sites is selected in the navigation pane. The Status tab displays a flat list of the assets of the selected site. The list is not navigable.
Monitor Specific Tabs This section describes the tabs that appear when you select a monitor icon in the navigation pane. The monitor icon is the lowest or “leaf” node in the navigation hierarchy. Sampling Tab (Monitor icon selected in Navigation Pane) The Sampling tab is shown when a monitor icon is selected in the navigation pane. Use this tab to review the monitor’s sampling and verification schedules. To change the monitor’s sampling or verification schedules, click Update Sampling… on the Action menu while this tab is displayed. The Update Sampling Schedule dialog is displayed. When you click OK in the dialog box, GAS-Guard View 2.0 immediately contacts the monitor and updates the monitor’s sampling schedule. The Action menu for this tab also contains the Sample Hourly… command. The Sample Hourly command is described in the Action Sample Hourly (Monitor selected, Sampling Tab) section below. Communications Tab (Monitor icon selected in Navigation Pane) The Communications tab is shown when a monitor icon is selected in the navigation pane. It displays a textual summary of the communications settings for the selected transformer monitor. Use this tab to review the host’s communication settings. To change the settings used by GAS-Guard View 2.0, click Update Communications… on the Action menu while this tab is displayed. The Update Communications Wizard is displayed. Use the Wizard to review and update the communication settings. When you click Finish, GAS-Guard View 2.0 updates the host’s communication settings. To verify monitor communications, click Check Communications… on the Action menu for this tab. This command will attempt to contact the monitor and retrieve basic information about the monitor. After the command completes (or fails), a message box displays the outcome of the test.
Menu Commands This section provides an overview of the menu commands available in GAS-Guard View 2.0.
39 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
File Menu File New… This menu item displays the New File Creation wizard to begin the creation of a new file. Since each transformer asset and its monitor are represented in a single file, this operation is used to add new assets and monitors to your GAS-Guard View 2.0 installation. After the initial screen, the wizard displays the Monitor Information page shown in Figure 17.
Figure 17. Monitor Information page. After entry of the required information, the wizard displays the Select File page. A default filename is composed from the last folder in which you located a file combined with the site and asset name you specified. If you have not previously located a file using GAS-Guard View 2.0, the location will default to your My Documents folder. You may use the keyboard to change any part of the path or use the Browse… button to select a different folder in which to create the file. The wizard then presents the Connection Type page. This page allows you to select the monitor’s communications type from a range of supported alternatives. When you click the Next button, a communications configuration page specific to the selected communications type is displayed.
40 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
If you selected LAN communication, for example, the configuration page supports entry of a LAN (Ethernet) address. If you selected modem communications, the configuration page supports entry of phone number, communications port, and related information. After configuring communications, clicking the Next button will display a textual summary of the information collected by the wizard. When the Finish button is clicked, the new file is created and added to the navigator. It will remain in the navigator even if you exit and restart GAS-Guard View 2.0. To remove an asset and its associated monitor from the navigator, click Close… in the File menu. File Open… This item is used to open an existing file. It presents a standard Open File dialog. After the file is opened successfully, it is added to the navigator. It will remain in the navigator even if you exit and restart GAS-Guard View 2.0. To remove an asset and its associated monitor from the navigator, use File Close…. File Close… This item is used to close (remove from display) one or more files. The files must have previously been added to the navigator via File New… or File Open…. Closing the file only removes the file from view. The file’s contents are not altered and the file is not deleted. File Archive… This item is used to reduce the size of large files while preserving their data. The Choose Archive Date dialog is displayed. Use this dialog to set the boundary date. When you click OK, a standard file selection dialog is displayed. After you choose an archive file name and location and click OK, all monitor data older than the boundary date is removed from the primary data file and placed in the archive. Since archived data is no longer present in the data file, it is no longer displayed. If you wish to review archived data at a later date, click Open in the File menu and select the archive file using the Open File dialog box. Archiving your data is optional. GAS-Guard View 2.0 will function correctly even if all data ever downloaded is allowed to accumulate in the primary data file. File Export… Selecting this item displays a File Save dialog that allows the export of transformer data. The export file will contain the data for the date range currently selected in the End Date and Range controls in the application toolbar. Use this command to make data available to other application programs, e.g. Microsoft Office Excel. Exports may be created at any time. Exporting data does not remove it from the data file: the data continues to be displayed by GAS-Guard View 2.0 after you export it. Data may be exported in one of two formats: Comma-separated value (.CSV): files in this textual format may be loaded directly by Microsoft Excel and many other applications. 41 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
TOA4: this textual file format is directly compatible with Transformer Oil Analyst version 4 (TOA-4) software from Delta-X Research. File Print… This item allows the contents of the viewing pane to be printed. A standard printer dialog is displayed. You may change print settings defined by your printer, if desired, and then click OK to print the viewing pane contents. This item is unavailable (“grayed out”) if there is nothing to print. File Print Preview A standard Print Preview dialog is displayed. The contents of the viewing pane may be printed from within the preview using the controls at the top. This item is unavailable (“grayed out”) if there is nothing to print. File Exit This item closes the application.
Action Menu Some of the contents of the Action menu are determined by the selection in the navigation pane and the visible (currently selected) tab. This section describes each possible action and identifies the selection type and tab which must be visible for the action to be available in the menu. The following menu items are available in the Action menu regardless of the selection or current tab. Action Select Modem This menu item opens the Select Modem dialog box. The dialog allows you to select the TAPI modem used to communicate with Siemens model GAS-Guard 3 and GAS-Guard 8 monitors. Note: the modem selected using this dialog box affects communication with Siemens model GAS-Guard 3 and GAS-Guard 8 monitors only. When communicating with Serveron TrueGas monitors, the COM port selected on the Configure Modem page of the Update Communications dialog determines the modem used to contact the monitor. The Select Modem dialog box displays a dropdown list containing all properly-configured TAPI modems. If your modem is not displayed in the list, click Configure TAPI Modem to display the Add/Remove Hardware Wizard. Follow the prompts to configure your modem. For more information, see Configuring Modems later in this manual.
42 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Action Send Diagnostic Data… This item displays the Send Diagnostic Data dialog box. It is designed to help you obtain support from Serveron Customer Service should your monitor ever require it. In general, you should contact Serveron Customer Service for guidance before using this command. After querying whether to continue, GAS-Guard View 2.0 will begin generation of an informational file about the monitor. The informational file includes everything in the monitor’s data file. By default, GAS-Guard View 2.0 attempts to contact the monitor (using the configured communication path) to obtain additional service-related information. If a connection to the monitor cannot be established, this additional data is not included in the informational file. You can limit the duration of this connection or choose not to connect using the controls in the dialog box. GAS-Guard View 2.0 will prompt for a file in which to save the diagnostic data. After you select a file and click OK, GAS-Guard View 2.0 will contact the monitor and obtain diagnostic information (unless you chose not to do so) and then copy the current data file into the diagnostic file. After saving the diagnostic file, GAS-Guard View 2.0 will create an email message using your default email client (Microsoft Office Outlook, Outlook Express, Mozilla Thunderbird, etc.) The generated email message will appear on your screen for review. You must attach the informational file to the generated email message using the commands provided by your email client. Instructions for locating the file appear within the generated email message itself. Note: GAS-Guard View 2.0 only prepares data for transmission to Serveron. GAS-Guard View 2.0 will never, under any circumstances, send data of any kind to Serveron. You must send the email that was generated in GASGuard View 2.0, like you would any other email, if you wish to communicate the diagnostic information to Serveron. The remaining menu items in this section are specific to the selection in the navigation pane and the current tab. Example: the Rename Company item appears in the Action menu when you select a Company in the navigation pane and then display the Status tab. Action Rename Company… (Company selected, Status tab) This command displays the Rename Company dialog box which allows the entry of a new name for the currently selected company. When you click OK, one or more files are updated to reflect the change and both the navigation and viewing panes are redrawn. Action Rename Site… (Site selected, Status tab) This command displays the Rename Site dialog box which allows the entry of a new name for the currently selected site. When you click OK, one or more files are updated to reflect the change and both the navigation and viewing panes are redrawn.
43 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Action Rename Asset… (Transformer asset selected, Status tab) This command displays the Rename Asset dialog box which allows the entry of a new name for the currently selected asset. When you click OK, the file is updated to reflect the change and both the navigation and viewing panes are redrawn. Action Poll Now (Transformer asset selected, Status tab) Causes GAS-Guard View 2.0 to connect to the selected asset’s transformer monitor and download all data. The connection attempt uses the current communications settings, which are displayed on the Communications tab when the monitor icon is selected. Action Enter DGA… (Transformer asset selected, Gas in Oil tab) Displays the Enter DGA Data dialog box, which supports entry of DGA data for display on the Gas in Oil graph. Enter the values from your manual DGA into the cells of the empty row and adjust the date as appropriate. If you need to add additional rows, click the Add Row button to add a new empty row. When you are satisfied, click OK to save your entries. If you discover an error in a DGA entry, use the dialog box to change the value displayed in the cell and then click OK. To delete a manual DGA, open the dialog box. Click the area to the left of the date and time to highlight the entire row, click the Delete button, and then click OK to update the file and graph. Action Start Sample Run (Transformer asset selected, Gas in Oil tab) After confirming your choice, this command commands the transformer monitor to immediately start a sample run. Since sample runs are scheduled automatically by the monitor, use of this command is rarely required. Note: to adjust the monitor’s sampling schedule, click the monitor icon in the navigation pane, then click the Sampling tab, and finally click Update Sampling… in the Action menu. GAS-Guard View 2.0 displays the Update Sample Schedule dialog box. When you click OK, GAS-Guard View 2.0 immediately contacts the monitor and updates the schedule you have defined. Action Update Limits (Transformer asset selected, Limits tab) Displays the Update Limits dialog box, which supports changes to the gas in oil caution and alarm limit values. For Siemens model GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 monitors, the dialog supports both level and rate of change alarms; for Serveron TrueGas monitors, only level alarms are supported. When the OK button is clicked, GAS-Guard View 2.0 immediately contacts the monitor to update the limit values.
44 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Action Start Verification Run (Transformer asset selected, Verification Data tab) After confirming your choice, this command commands the transformer monitor to immediately start a verification run. Since verification runs are scheduled automatically by the monitor, use of this command is rarely required. Note: to adjust the monitor’s verification schedule, click the monitor icon in the navigation pane, then click the Sampling tab, and finally click Update Sampling… in the Action menu. GAS-Guard View 2.0 displays the Update Sample Schedule dialog box. When you click OK, GAS-Guard View 2.0 immediately contacts the monitor and updates the schedule you have defined. Action Start Calibration Run (Transformer asset selected, Verification Data tab) After confirming your choice, this command commands the transformer monitor to immediately start a calibration run. A calibration run takes 30 minutes to 1 hour depending the model of transformer monitor you have installed. Note: Siemens monitors contain an auto-calibration feature. Manual calibration runs should only be performed by trained Customer Service personnel. Action Change Monitor Password… (Transformer asset selected, Status tab) This command is intended to ensure that only a single approved installation of GAS-Guard View 2.0 software may access the transformer monitor. Note: changing the password is intended to block access to the selected transformer monitor by other computers running GAS-Guard View 2.0. The new password is set in the monitor and stored securely on the local computer. After completing this command, GAS-Guard View 2.0 will be able to poll data or access monitor data and settings from the local computer only. GAS-Guard View 2.0 first offers the opportunity to cancel the operation. If you choose to continue, GAS-Guard View 2.0 displays a dialog box supporting entry of the new password. When you click OK on this dialog box , GAS-Guard View 2.0 securely stores the password in the host compter. GAS-Guard View 2.0 then displays the Poller Activity dialog and sets the new password in the monitor.
45 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Action Set Monitor Date and Time (Transformer asset selected, Status tab) This command sets the transformer monitor’s internal date and time to match the local computer. If the monitor is a Siemens model GAS-Guard 8 or GAS-Guard 3, the time is converted to Universal Coordinated Time (UTC) before being sent to the monitor. Action View Log… (Transformer asset selected, Status tab) This command displays recent activity by the polling/dialing subsystem (“Poller”). For more information about the Poller, see Theory of Operations later in this manual. Action Sample Hourly (Monitor selected, Sampling tab) Note: this command is available for Siemens model GAS-Guard 8 and GASGuard 3 transformer monitors only. Serveron TrueGas monitors do not support hourly sampling. Causes GAS-Guard View 2.0 to connect to the transformer monitor and establish a temporary sampling schedule within the monitor. The temporary schedule continues for 24 hours and specifies that sample runs should be performed once per hour. After the 24 hour period elapses, the monitor reverts to the schedule that was in effect when the Sample Hourly command was given. If you wish to continue hourly sampling, you may issue the command again to enable hourly sampling for another 24 hour period. The Sample Hourly command is intended to allow you to temporarily accelerate sampling when additional online DGA data is critical, e.g. when a transformer is experiencing a gassing event or other unusual condition. Note: by increasing the number of sample runs, this command increases the monitor’s consumption of helium carrier gas. Excessive use of this command may require replacement of the helium cylinder more frequently than stated in the Siemens Transformer Monitor product documentation. The Sample Hourly command also interacts with the automatic scheduled polling feature of GAS-Guard View 2.0. If the monitor that is sampling hourly is also configured for automatically scheduled polling, the Poller component of GAS-Guard View 2.0 will begin polling it at an accelerated rate (hourly) in order to make the data available to you. Under certain conditions, the Siemens transformer monitor may begin sampling at an accelerated (hourly) rate without any input from you. This form of accelerated sampling occurs when a previously configured Rate of Change (ROC) gas alarm limit is violated within the monitor. ROC accelerated sample will not occur unless you configure Rate of Change alarm limits,. If this form of accelerated sampling does occur at your installation, the Poller component of GAS-Guard View 2.0 will notice after several hours and begin polling at an accelerated rate in order to make the data available to you.
46 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
A monitor that is performing hourly samples due to a ROC alarm will cease performing accelerated runs and return to its previous schedule approximately 24 hours after the ROC alarm condition is cleared. If ROC does not return to normal on its own, you can clear the condition by increasing the ROC alarm limit value or disabling the alarm for that gas. For more information, see Action Update Limits (Transformer asset selected, Limits tab) below. Action Check Communications (Monitor selected, Communications tab) This command allows you to check communications by performing a lightweight poll of the monitor without switching tabs. The Poller Activity dialog is displayed just as with Poll Now. Unlike the Poll Now operation, GAS-Guard View 2.0 will not attempt to download data from the monitor. Instead, it will update control information (alarm levels, sampling schedule, etc) and then terminate the connection. After communication is complete (or fails), a message box displays the outcome of the test. Action Update Communications (Monitor selected, Communications tab) This command displays the Update Communications Wizard, allowing all communication settings for the selected transformer monitor to be reviewed and optionally updated. For more information about the Update Communications Wizard, see Configuring Communications later in this document.
View Menu View Refresh (F5) This command updates the Navigator and all tabs with the latest data. View Auto Refresh Enables or disables the automatic refresh feature. If the menu item is checked, GAS-Guard View 2.0 will automatically refresh the display with the latest data approximately once per hour. Each automatic refresh is equivalent to manually selecting View Refresh or pressing F5. If the menu item is not checked, automatic refresh will not occur. View Navigator This command makes the Navigator visible. It is useful if the navigation pane has been hidden using the small close box at upper right of the pane.
Help Menu Help User’s Manual Opens this document.
47 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Help Frequently Asked Questions Displays the Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ) about GAS-Guard View 2.0. Help Release Notes Displays the Release Notes. Help Licensing This menu item raises the Licensing dialog. All tasks associated with obtaining, installing and assigning licenses (except assigning polling licenses) are performed using this dialog box. These tasks are described in Installing and Using Licenses in the Using GAS-Guard View 2.0 section of this manual. The Licensing dialog box has three tabs. Keys tab. This tab is used to obtain your machine ID, which must be provided to Serveron when you request a license. Use the Copy to Clipboard button to copy your machine ID and then paste it into the license request email as described under Installing and Using Licenses. The Keys tab is also used to install licenses you receive from Serveron. After receiving your license via email and saving the license file attachment, click the Browse… button on the Keys tab to open the Serveron license key file. When you click OK, GAS-Guard View 2.0 attempts to install the license. Finally, the Keys tab displays the license keys you have currently installed. To display the details of an installed license, click the license to select it and then click Details. Polling tab. This tab displays the number of polling license you have available. Your available licenses are maintained in a pool managed internally by GAS-Guard View 2.0 as described under Installing and Using Licenses. The same value is displayed when you open the Update Automatic Polling Status dialog (Polling tab, Action menu, Update Automatic Polling Status). Polling licenses are installed by browsing from the Keys tab, and assigned to monitors using the Update Automatic Polling Status dialog as described in the Company Specific Tabs section. Diagnostics tab. This tab is used to assign Diagnostics Package licenses to individual monitor serial numbers. Siemens monitors that have not been assigned Diagnostics licenses are shown in the left box. To assign a license, click to select the monitor and then click Assign… Since a diagnostic license cannot be reassigned, you will be prompted to confirm. Carefully check your selection and then click OK. The selected serial number is removed from the left box and displayed in the right box. The newly-assigned license will not take effect until the next time GAS-Guard View 2.0 polls the monitor. At that time, encrypted licensing information will be stored in the host data file. Any GAS-Guard View 2.0 installation that opens the file will discover the licensing information and enable the diagnostic features.
48 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Help Install Sample Files Displays the Install Sample Files dialog box which allows the sample files to be copied to a folder of your choice. The function of this menu item is identical to the Install Sample Files button on the Welcome screen. Help About Siemens Client This item displays the About Box, which shows the detailed version number of GAS-Guard View 2.0 and a link to Siemens’s world wide web page.
Using the Duval Triangle The Duval Triangle is a feature of the Diagnostics Package, which requires a separate license from Serveron. For information on how to enable the Diagnostics package, please see Installing and Using Licenses. To access the Triangle, select a Transformer asset in the navigation pane and then click the Duval Triangle tab in the viewing pane. If no license is found, the background will be displayed but data points will not.
Overview The Duval Triangle is an analytical tool developed by Dr. Michel Duval of IREQ (Hydro Quebec), Canada. The Triangle presents DGA (dissolved gas analysis) results in a graphical form by sorting them according to a list of faults as codified by IEC Publication 60599, "Mineral oil-impregnated electrical equipment in service- Guide to the interpretation of dissolved and free gases analysis," March 1999. The Triangle and IEC Publication 60599 are analysis tools meant to be used as an aid for diagnosing the source of combustible gases in transformer coolant oil. The Triangle should not be regarded as the “final word” for such diagnosis but as a tool to be used by an informed expert for the purpose of evaluating the health of a transformer. The Duval Triangle task is shown in Figure 18.
49 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Figure 18. Duval Triangle task.
Interpretation of regions The Triangle is broken into seven (7) polygonal regions, labeled T1, T2, T3, D1, D2, DT, and PD. The regions labeled with a T indicate probable thermal faults, with increasing numbers indicating higher temperatures. The regions labeled with a D indicate probable discharge faults, with increasing numbers corresponding to more energetic discharges. The region labeled DT indicates a probable mixture of thermal and discharge faults. Finally, the small region at the apex labeled PD indicates a probable partial discharge (also known as corona) condition. Specifically, each region is to be interpreted as specified in IEC Publication 60599: T1 - Thermal faults not exceeding 300°C T2 - Thermal faults exceeding 300°C but not exceeding 700°C T3 - Thermal faults exceeding 700°C D1 - Discharges of low energy D2 - Discharges of high energy
50 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
PD - Partial Discharges The DT region indicates a probable combination of thermal and discharge faults. It is not discussed in IEC 60599.
Interpretation of the Triangle Each of the Triangle's three sides forms an axis with a range of 0 to 100%. The Triangle's base is the acetylene (C2H2) axis. The left side is the methane (CH4) axis. The right side is the ethylene (C2H4) axis. Use of the Triangle begins with a dissolved gas measurement (such as one obtained every few hours from the Siemens on-line transformer monitor) that includes acetylene, methane, and ethylene values. The values of the three gases are then normalized to total 100%. Example: A DGA result might show acetylene at 10 parts per million (PPM), methane at 20 PPM, and ethylene at 20 PPM. The normalized values for these three gases at these concentrations are 20% acetylene, 40% methane, and 40% ethylene. A single data point is plotted at the intersection of the three normalized values by drawing lines across the triangle from each of the appropriate normalized values on the axes. These lines are always drawn parallel to some axis of the graphic, as indicated by the dotted white lines.
Multiple data points The advent of on-line DGA data provided by the Siemens transformer monitor provides new opportunities for use of the Triangle. In particular, the wealth of data provided by the Siemens monitor can be used to quickly assess the health of a transformer by viewing values in the Triangle over a specific range of dates, allowing one to correlate specific fault conditions with transformer loading or extraneous events. The End Date and Range controls in the application tool bar determine the range of interest for plotting points on the Duval Triangle. The Duval Triangle displays all meaningful samples shown on the corresponding Trend Graph. The relative age of DGA samples are indicated using pale yellow for the oldest to bright yellow, pale orange, and bright orange for the most recent samples. The latest sample plotted in the Triangle is distinguished using an X marker contained in a circle. In addition, dotted lines normal to the three graph axes are shown on the graph, for the most recent data point only.
Summary The Duval Triangle analysis tool, integrated with Siemens's industry-leading On-Line Transformer Monitor and turnkey asset monitoring services, offers breakthrough capabilities for transformer asset management.
51 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Using the Rogers Ratio Viewer The Rogers Ratio Viewer is a feature of the GAS-Guard View 2.0 Diagnostics Package, which requires a separate license from Serveron. For information on how to enable the Diagnostics package, please see Installing and Using Licenses. To access the Viewer, select a Transformer asset in the navigation pane and then click the Gas in Oil tab in the viewing pane. Then click the Rogers Ratio Viewer button in the Graph toolbar (see Graph Toolbar in the section Using the Graphs). If no license is available, clicking the toolbar button will display a dialog box instructing you to contact Siemens or your Siemens representative to obtain one. Note: the Rogers Ratios (also known as Basic Gas Ratios) are based on five measured gases: H2, CH4, C2H2, C2H4, and C2H6. The Siemens model GAS-Guard 3 online transformer gas monitor measures CH4, C2H2, and C2H4, but does not measure H2 or C2H6. For this reason, Rogers Ratios cannot be computed from data gathered using a GAS-Guard 3. When the asset selected in the Navigation Pane is monitored by a GASGuard 3, the Rogers Ratio button does not appear in the graph toolbar. Siemens recommends use of the Duval Triangle to assess transformer gas in oil data gathered with a GAS-Guard 3 monitor.
Introduction The Rogers Ratio Viewer is displayed using a button on the Graph toolbar as described above. The Viewer is a separate component that displays in its own window. If the Viewer is not installed or cannot be executed, the button itself is not shown on the Graph toolbar. The Rogers Ratios Viewer uses Microsoft DirectX® version 9, a graphical software toolset. Some video adapters and video device drivers do not support DirectX version 9. The Viewer requires a video display with 32-bit color (24-bit RGB plus alpha). This mode may be referred to as “high color” or “true color” and is sometimes erroneously labeled as “24bit color”. Most video adapters built since 2001 can support the Viewer.
Functional Overview Dissolved gas ratios (known as Rogers Ratios in IEEE Standard PC57.104 D11d and Basic Gas Ratios in International Standard IEC-60599) are a tool for the interpretation of Dissolved Gas Analysis (DGA) results. The Ratios present DGA results in graphical form by organizing them according to a list of faults as codified in an IEC Standard and an IEEE Draft Standard. These documents are IEC Publication 60599, "Mineral oil-impregnated electrical equipment in service - Guide to the interpretation of dissolved and free gases analysis," March 1999, and draft IEEE Publication PC57.104 D11d, “Draft Guide for the Interpretation of Gases in Oil Immersed Transformers”, April 21 2004. Note that this latter document is an unapproved IEEE standards draft, subject to change. Both specifications define the ratios as follows: 52 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
CH4 / H2 C2H2 / C2H4 C2H4 / C2H6 The Ratios and respective standards are intended as diagnostic aids for DGA interpretation. The Ratios should therefore not be regarded as the "final word" for such diagnosis but rather as a tool to be used by an informed expert for evaluating the health of a transformer. The advantages of these ratio tools are that they are quantitative and independent of transformer oil volume. However, these and other ratio methods can produce incorrect interpretations or none at all. Therefore, they should be used in conjunction with other diagnostic tools such as the Duval Triangle. The value of on-line monitoring is that these diagnostic tools can be utilized over time to enable a comprehensive condition-based asset management program. The Rogers Ratio Viewer is shown in Figure 19.
Figure 19. Rogers Ratio Viewer The advent of on-line DGA data provided by the Siemens On-Line Transformer Monitor provides new opportunities for use of the Ratios. In particular, the wealth of data provided by the On-Line Transformer Monitor can be used to quickly assess the health of a 53 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
transformer by viewing ratio values over a specific range of dates, allowing one to correlate specific fault conditions with transformer loading or extraneous events. Selecting an End Date and Range for the Trend Graph determines the range of interest for plotting points in the Ratio Viewer. The Ratio Viewer displays all meaningful samples shown on the corresponding Trend Graph. The relative age of DGA samples are indicated using pale yellow for the oldest to bright yellow, pale orange, and bright orange for the most recent samples. The latest sample plotted in the Viewer is distinguished using a solid red color. In addition, dotted lines normal to the three graph axes are shown on the graph, for the most recent data point only.
Interpretation of Regions The Viewer displays ratios in a three-dimensional volume containing several rectangular solid regions, labeled T1, T2, T3, D1, D2, PD, and OK. Note that the region labeled PD appears only in the IEC-60599 ratio definitions while the region labeled OK appears only in the IEEE PC57.104 D11d ratio definitions. The regions labeled with a T indicate probable thermal faults, with increasing numbers indicating higher temperatures. The regions labeled with a D indicate probable discharge faults, with increasing numbers corresponding to discharges that are more energetic. The region labeled PD indicates a probable partial discharge (also known as corona) condition, while the region labeled OK indicates a presumed absence of faults. The IEEE PC57.104 D11d and IEC-60599 specifications generally agree on the following detailed region definitions: OK - Normal Unit IEEE PC57.104 D11d names this region Case 0. IEC-60599 does not define this region. PD - Partial Discharges IEC-60599 defines this region, while IEEE PC57.104 does not. D1 - Discharges of low energy This region is named Case 1 in IEEE PC57.104 D11d. D2 - Discharges of high energy This region is named Case 2 in IEEE PC57.104 D11d. The extent of this region differs slightly between the IEC-60599 and IEEE PC57.104 D11d definitions. T1 - Low temperature thermal faults not exceeding 300°C This region is named Case 3 in IEEE PC57.104 D11d. T2 - Thermal faults exceeding 300°C but not exceeding 700°C This region is named Case 4 in IEEE PC57.104 D11d. T3 - Thermal faults exceeding 700°C This region is named Case 5 in IEEE PC57.104 D11d. 54 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Interpreting the Graphical View Each of the Viewer’s three axes is logarithmic with conceptually unlimited range. The "front" axis shows an increasing ratio of Methane (CH4) to Hydrogen (H2), referred to as R1 in the text below. The "up" axis shows an increasing ratio of Acetylene (C2H2) to Ethylene (C2H4), referred to as R2. The "right" axis shows an increasing ratio of Ethylene (C2H4) to Ethane (C2H6), referred to as R3. Use of the Viewer begins with a dissolved gas measurement (such as one obtained every few hours from the Siemens On-Line Transformer Monitor) that includes nonzero ethylene, ethane, and hydrogen values expressed in Parts per Million (PPM). The three ratios are then computed. The resulting values determine the location of a point in 3D-space for display by the Viewer. Mathematically speaking, a ratio value is not defined if its denominator is zero. Therefore, a sample containing a hydrogen (H2) value of 0.0 PPM causes R1 to be undefined. Likewise, a sample with an ethylene (C2H4) value of 0.0 PPM causes R2 to be undefined and an ethane (C2H6) value of 0.0 PPM causes R3 to be undefined. When one or more of the ratios is undefined, the three values R1, R2 and R3 do not determine a point in 3D-space and the Viewer cannot plot the sample. The Viewer displays a count of samples that could not be plotted in the upper left corner of the display window. The count is labeled Zero denominator. As noted above, each axis has conceptually unlimited range. The Viewer is capable of displaying ratio values between 0.01 and 100.0. If a value of R1, R2 or R3 lies outside the range from 0.01 to 100.0, an out of range marker is displayed. The marker appears as a small ring with an arrow through it. The graphical view can be rotated, zoomed and panned using the arrow keys, shift-arrow keys, and control-arrow keys respectively. The display can be cleared and the points replotted in time sequence by pressing the Backspace key. For more information, press F1 while the Viewer is active to raise the Help window. In the Help window, press Show Key Help... to display the complete command list for the Viewer.
Summary The Rogers Ratio Viewer analysis tool, integrated with Siemens's industry-leading On-Line Transformer Monitor and turnkey asset monitoring services, offers breakthrough capabilities for transformer asset management.
55 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Maintaining GAS-Guard View 2.0 Installations This chapter provides additional detail about GAS-Guard View 2.0 and discusses important aspects of GAS-Guard View 2.0 installations.
Configuring Communications Introduction The physical connection type is selected or updated using the Connection Type page of the Wizard. The Wizard is displayed when creating a new monitored asset (File New… menu item) or when updating communications to an existing monitor (Action Update Communications… menu item on the Communications tab, which is available when a monitor is selected in the navigation pane). The Connection Type page is shown in Figure 20.
Figure 20. Connection Type page. After the connection type is selected and the Next button is pressed, a page specific to the connection type’s configuration requirements is presented. The following sections describe the supported connection types and their configuration options.
56 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Local Area Network (LAN) Direct monitor communication via Ethernet LAN is supported for Siemens model GASGuard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 monitors. The Next button leads to the Configure LAN Connection page. When LAN is selected, only a single configuration item, the network (Ethernet) address of the monitor, need be supplied.
Telephone Modem Plain old telephone system (POTS) and cellular modems are supported for both TrueGas and GAS-Guard family monitors. Configuration data for the modem is entered on the Configure Modem Connection page. Five items are required to configure a modem connection: The phone number, also called the dial string. The dial string may include commas to introduce delays into the dialing sequence. It may also include codes to temporarily disable PBX functionality; in the example, the code *71 represents a typical command to disable the Call Waiting feature. GAS-Guard View 2.0 also supports a send/expect protocol for arbitrarily complex interactions with the modem. This protocol is enabled by the caret (^) character, which can only be entered after checking the Allow advanced dial string checkbox. The send/expect protocol is described in the section Advanced Dialing Strings. The modem setup string. This string contains modem initialization commands that should be in effect at all times. The default modem setup string is also described in the section Configuring Modems, below. The COM port to which the modem is attached (TrueGas monitors only). The number of the COM port on the local computer. This value does not apply to Siemens model GAS-Guard 3 and GAS-Guard 8 monitors and is not displayed for them. To select the modem used to communicate with your model GAS-Guard 3 or GAS-Guard 8 monitors, please click Select Modem in the Action menu. The baud rate which should be used. The baud rate at which the port should be used. GAS-Guard View 2.0 uses Modbus for direct serial/radio connection to Serveron TrueGas monitors only. For TrueGas monitors, the Modbus address of the monitor must be specified. The default Modbus address is 17.
57 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
RS-232 Direct RS-232 connectivity is supported for both TrueGas and GAS-Guard family monitors. Three items are required to configure a direct connection: The COM port to which the cable is attached. The number of the COM port on the local computer. The baud rate which should be used. The baud rate at which the port should be used. The Modbus address of the monitor (Serveron TrueGas monitors only) GAS-Guard View 2.0 uses Modbus for direct serial connection to Serveron TrueGas monitors only. For TrueGas monitors, the Modbus address of the monitor must be specified. The default Modbus address is 17.
RS-232 with radio (FreeWave®) GAS-Guard View 2.0 supports a direct serial connection to a short-range radio link, e.g. FreeWave from FreeWave Technologies. Four items are required to configure a direct-toradio connection: The COM port to which the cable is attached. The number of the COM port on the local computer. The baud rate which should be used. The baud rate at which the port should be used. The unit address of the slave radio. This value is a configuration parameter of the FreeWave. The Modbus address of the monitor (Serveron TrueGas monitors only) GAS-Guard View 2.0 uses Modbus for direct serial/radio connection to Serveron TrueGas monitors only. For TrueGas monitors, the Modbus address of the monitor must be specified. The default Modbus address is 17.
58 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Telephone Modem with radio (FreeWave®) GAS-Guard View 2.0 supports a modem connection to a short-range radio link, e.g. FreeWave from FreeWave Technologies. Six items are required to configure a modem-toradio connection: The phone number, also called the dial string. The dial string may include commas to introduce delays into the dialing sequence. It may also include codes to temporarily disable PBX functionality; in the example, the code *71 represents a typical command to disable the Call Waiting feature. GAS-Guard View 2.0 also supports a send/expect protocol for arbitrarily complex interactions with the modem. This protocol is enabled by the caret (^) character, which can only be entered after checking the Allow advanced dial string checkbox. The send/expect protocol is described in the section Advanced Dialing Strings. The modem setup string. This string contains modem initialization commands that should be in effect at all times. The default modem setup string is also described in the section Configuring Modems, below. The COM port to which the modem is attached (TrueGas monitors only). The number of the COM port on the local computer. This value does not apply to Siemens model GAS-Guard 3 and GAS-Guard 8 monitors and is not displayed for them. To select the modem used to communicate with your model GAS-Guard 3 or GAS-Guard 8 monitors, please click Select Modem in the Action menu. The baud rate which should be used. The baud rate at which the port should be used. The unit address of the slave radio. This value is a configuration parameter of the FreeWave. The Modbus address of the monitor (Serveron TrueGas monitors only) GAS-Guard View 2.0 uses Modbus for direct serial/radio connection to Serveron TrueGas monitors only. For TrueGas monitors, the Modbus address of the monitor must be specified. The default Modbus address is 17.
59 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Configuring Modems Modem Initialization Before sending any dial string to the modem, GAS-Guard View 2.0 will transmit the modem setup string. The default modem setup string is at v1 e0 q0 &d2 x4. This setup string is needed to configure the modem in your PC for proper communication with GAS-Guard View 2.0. at indicates the start of a modem command string. v1 tells the modem to send responses that contain alphabetical codes rather than numeric codes. e0 turns echo off. q0 quiets or suppresses response codes from your modem. &d2 sets the modem to do the following when Data Terminal Ready (DTR) is lost:
hang up
turn off auto answer
return to command mode
x4 sets the modem to display at least these response codes:
extended response set
dial tone
busy signal detection
Below are general definitions of the Hayes-compatible commands being used in the example. Your specific modem may require commands in addition to or instead of those shown in this example. Refer to the documentation that came with your modem for more information. vN - Displays result codes in short form (numbers) or long form (test). N = 0: send numeric responses N = 1: send word responses (default). eN - Turns the command echo feature on or off. N = 0: command echo off N = 1: command echo on (default). qN - Displays or suppresses (quiets) result codes N = 0: displays codes (default). N = 1: suppresses codes. &dN - Controls data terminal ready (DTR) transition 0 = ignore DTR signal 60 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
1 = return to command mode when after losing DTR 2 = hang up, turn off auto answer, and return to command mode after losing DTR (default) 3 = reset after losing DTR xN - Determines which result codes will be displayed following modem operations N = 0: Basic response set, blind dialing N = 1: extended response set, blind dialing N = 2: extended response set, dial tone detection N = 3: extended response set, blind dialing, and busy signal detection N = 4: extended response set, dial tone, and busy signal detection (default).
Advanced Dialing Strings Overview Occasionally, nonstandard communications configurations may require that you exercise direct control over interaction between the host computer running GAS-Guard View 2.0 and the modem (or modem-compatible) device. GAS-Guard View 2.0 supports this unusual but important requirement through advanced dial strings. An advanced dial string is any string containing the caret (^, usually shift-6 on U.S. English keyboards). Since the presence of caret characters significantly changes the behavior of the dial string, GAS-Guard View 2.0 prevents you from entering them by default. To enter an advanced dial string containing carets, you must first check the Allow advanced dial string checkbox. The box is found just below the Phone Number on the Configure Modem Connection page of the New File Creation (or Update Communications) wizard. After checking the box, you may type the advanced dial string in the Phone Number text box. Send/Expect Protocol The caret character is used to define a send/expect protocol between the computer running GAS-Guard View 2.0 and the modem (or modem-like device) attached to the selected COM port. Carets in properly-formed advanced dial strings always come in pairs. The first member of the pair defines a block of text that GAS-Guard View 2.0 will send to the modem. The second caret defines the response to expect from the modem-like device. Further interactions may be specified by entering a third caret with a send sequence, a matching fourth caret defining an expected response, etc. In principle there is no limit to the length of the send/expect sequence that may be defined. Example: the advanced dial string ^AT^OK^ATDT5551212^CONNECTED^AT^OK^ATDT7^CHANNEL 7 Would be executed as follows:
61 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
1. GAS-Guard View 2.0 opens the COM port and then transmits the string AT to the port. 2. GAS-Guard View 2.0 collects response lines from the port until the pattern OK is found. 3. GAS-Guard View 2.0 sends the string ATDT5551212 to the port. 4. GAS-Guard View 2.0 collects response lines until the pattern CONNECTED is found. 5. GAS-Guard View 2.0 transmits the string AT to the port. 6. GAS-Guard View 2.0 collects response lines until the pattern OK is found. 7. GAS-Guard View 2.0 transmits the string ATDT7 to the port. 8. GAS-Guard View 2.0 collects response lines until the pattern CHANNEL 7 is found. At this point, GAS-Guard View 2.0 assumes it is connected to the Siemens transformer monitor and begins communication with the monitor. Each time GAS-Guard View 2.0 transmits a character sequence to the port, it begins interpreting response lines. It continues to collect response lines until the expected response is found or a timeout occurs. The timeout is relatively long (3 minutes). If the timeout occurs, GAS-Guard View 2.0 reports that it was unable to connect to the monitor.
Configuring TAPI Modems GAS-Guard View 2.0 uses TAPI, a feature of Microsoft Windows, to access the modem when communicating with Siemens Model GAS-Guard 8 and GAS-Guard 3 (TMx) monitors. Use of TAPI requires that your analog modem be properly installed as a TAPI modem. If you plan to communicate with GAS-Guard monitors using analog modem(s), you must ensure your modem is properly installed and configured for use by TAPI. Note: if you do not use modem(s) to communicate with Siemens GAS-Guard monitors, this section does not apply to your installation. To select the TAPI modem, click Select Modem in the Action menu to display the Select Modem dialog box. The dialog box contains a dropdown list containing all properlyconfigured TAPI modems. If your modem does not appear in the list, click Configure TAPI Modem to display the Add/Remove Hardware wizard. Follow the prompts in the wizard to configure your modem. If your modem does not appear in the dropdown list after you complete the Add/Remove Hardware wizard, the following information may be helpful. To determine whether your analog modem is properly installed for use by TAPI, click Settings in your Start menu, open the Control Panel, and then double-click Phone and Modem Options. In the Phone and Modem Options applet, select the Modems tab. Verify that your modem (example: MultiTech MT5600ZDX Play & Play) is shown in the list. If it
62 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
is not, click the Add... button and use the wizard to properly install and configure your modem for use by TAPI. GAS-Guard View 2.0 will automatically create a phonebook entry named Siemens to manage your modem. If you system does not have a properly configured TAPI modem, GAS-Guard View 2.0 may fail to bind or may logically bind to a nonfunctional device such as the printer port. If your modem is configured for TAPI but you are unable to connect to your GAS-Guard monitor using it, click Settings in your Start menu and then click Network Connections. Right-click and delete the Siemens entry in the list. Ensure your modem is properly installed for use by TAPI as described above and then restart your computer. When your computer is ready, start GAS-Guard View 2.0 and try the connection again. You may then view your Network Connections and verify that the Siemens entry has been recreated.
Troubleshooting Corrupt or Invalid Files Overview GAS-Guard View 2.0 stores data in structured textual files with the extension .TGH. These files are informally referred to as TGH files.1 Although they are textual, TGH files have an internal structure that must be preserved to allow GAS-Guard View 2.0 to correctly process of the file. If the internal structure of a TGH file is not correct, GAS-Guard View 2.0 will report that the file is corrupt or invalid. This section describes steps that may be taken to recover most or all of the data in this unusual case. Note: Siemens recommends that you create a backup copy of any .TGH file before attempting any of the actions described below. Siemens strongly discourages the examination or modification of TGH files using programs other than GAS-Guard View 2.0 except when absolutely required. File Structure TGH files consist of a series of sections. Each section consists of a single header line followed by content lines. The header consists of the section name, e.g. Serial, enclosed in angle brackets < and >. TGH files may be examined and modified using any textual file editor, e.g. Microsoft Notepad. Examination of a TGH file that has been populated with data will show that the file’s sections fall into two loose groups, header sections and data sections.
1
The acronym TGH stands for Transformer Gas History.
63 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
Each header section contains a collection of key=value pairs. The keys are often but not always numeric. The values include communications configuration, metadata (e.g. company, site and asset names), and monitor configuration (alarm limits, schedules, etc.) Each data section contains an ordered collection of date-time=value,value,… lines. Each line in a data section must begin with a date and time. The definition of the values within the line varies from one section to another. An example of a .TGH file is shown below.
64 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
DO NOT EDIT THIS MACHINE-GENERATED FILE 2=TGE-D998201 20=Siemens Demo 21=Serveron Stories 22=#11 GSU (11-3-2003 for 1 week) 35=0 Address=ModBus,17 CommPort= Command= Modem= Phone= Settings= Interval= PartitionType=UseCustom StdTemp=60 TankWallSensor=0 Alarms= Clock= Schedule= 1= 2= 3= 4= 5= 00=133.0,200.0 01=380.0,400.0 02=0.0,0.0 03=468.0,524.0 04=323.0,498.0 05=3230.0,4980.0 06=443.0,480.0 07=150.0,222.0 08=6.0,8.0 09=0.0,0.0 10=-1.0,-1.0 11=-1.0,-1.0 12=-1.0,-1.0 13=0.0,0.0 14=0.0,0.0 15=0.0,0.0 16=0.0,0.0 17=0.0,0.0 18=0.0,0.0 19=0.0,0.0 20=0.0,0.0 21=0.0,0.0 22=0.0,0.0 23=0.0,0.0 24=0.0,0.0 25=0.0,0.0 26=0.0,0.0 27=0.0,0.0 28=0.0,0.0 29=0.0,0.0 30=0.0,0.0 2003/10/27 00:00=0,6.2,197.1,0.0,0.7,35.9,139.8,1.3,1.0,0.0,0.0,0.0,0.0,0.0 2003/10/27 04:00=0,6.0,196.5,0.0,0.7,38.0,156.5,1.2,1.0,0.0,0.0,0.0,0.0,0.0 2003/10/27 08:00=0,6.0,197.2,0.0,0.8,40.6,162.3,1.3,1.0,0.0,0.0,0.0,0.0,0.0 2003/10/27 00:00=0,0.0,0.0,16.4,30.0,5.7,0.0,23.9,26.0,37.4,60.0,35.0,8.2 2003/10/27 04:00=0,0.0,0.0,12.1,30.0,5.7,0.0,21.8,26.3,37.6,60.0,35.0,8.2
65 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0 2003/10/27
810-1735-01 Rev A
08:00=0,0.0,0.0,16.5,30.0,5.7,0.0,22.9,26.1,37.5,60.0,35.0,8.2 Data> 00:00=0,182.0,323.0,0.0,1171.0,2196.0,776.0,1153.0,976.0,0.0,0.0,0.0 04:00=0,182.0,323.0,0.0,1167.0,2193.0,776.0,1160.0,977.0,0.0,0.0,0.0 08:00=0,183.0,324.0,0.0,1171.0,2194.0,776.0,1157.0,977.0,0.0,0.0,0.0 Data> 00:00=0,31.2,1.9,14.8,15.5,27.3,0.0,35.0,28.7,29.1,25.9,0.0,0.0,0.0 04:00=0,28.7,1.9,15.9,16.5,27.3,0.0,32.9,26.4,29.4,26.1,0.0,0.0,0.0 08:00=0,30.7,2.0,15.3,16.2,26.5,0.0,33.2,27.2,29.8,26.1,0.0,0.0,0.0
TGH files are locale-invariant: the file contents do not change regardless of the current locale. This allows files written on any locale (e.g. Asian or European Windows) to be read and correctly interpreted on any other locale (e.g. U.S. English or Brazilian Portuguese Windows). User-entered textual data, e.g. the company name, is stored in UTF-8, a variablelength encoding for the Unicode® character set. Causes of File Corruption Common causes of file corruption include: Missing or invalid serial number. The value of key 02 in the section must be a valid serial number. If the section does not exist, or key 02 is not present, or the value is not a valid Siemens serial number, the file will be reported as corrupt or invalid. Broken or incomplete line(s). Each line in each data section must begin with a valid date and time. GAS-Guard View 2.0 accepts a wide range of date and time formats. The following conditions will not cause the file to be reported as corrupt or invalid, but may result in unexpected behavior: Nonstandard section names. File sections with unrecognized headers are preserved when the file is modified but are otherwise ignored. They do not cause the file to be reported as corrupt or invalid. Nan or Inf values. Like almost all contemporary software, GAS-Guard View 2.0 represents floating-point data in conformance with IEEE standard 754. IEEE-754 includes representations for values that are Not a Number (NaN) as well as positive or negative infinity (Inf). These values may appear in floating point value fields as the literal strings Nan or Inf. These values are read and processed by GAS-Guard View 2.0 according to the normal rules of IEEE-754 arithmetic; they do not cause the file to be reported as corrupt or invalid. For more information, please consult the IEEE standard. Repairing Damaged Files Begin by checking for the serial number key (02) in the section. If the key is present and valid, scan all data sections for data lines that do not begin with a date and time. You may discover one or more lines with unexpected line breaks. If you find such line(s), use Notepad or a similar text-editing program to merge the split line or delete the badly formed lines completely. After making one or more corrections save the file and use File Open… in GAS-Guard View 2.0 to see if the file can now be read. As noted above, customer textual data is encoded in UTF-8. UTF-8 is a variable-length encoding of the 16-bit Unicode character set. If your TGH file contains characters with code 66 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
points that lie outside the ISO Latin-1 256 character subset, the editor program you select must be capable of handling the variable-length UTF-8 encoding format. If these steps do not correct the problem, please contact Siemens or your Siemens representative.
Menu Items Unavailable (“Grayed Out”) Menu items are unavailable (“grayed out”) if the operation they represent is not meaningful or cannot be performed. For example, GAS-Guard View 2.0 makes the File Close… menu item unavailable when the navigation pane contains no files. If numerous menu items are unavailable (grayed out), check the status information lower right corner of the GAS-Guard View 2.0 window. Many menu items require interaction with the GAS-Guard View 2.0 Poller component. If your GAS-Guard View 2.0 installation configuration is Viewer Only, the status bar will display Poller: None and these menu items are unavailable. They include File New, Help Licensing, and most of the contents of the Action menu. If your installation configuration is Standalone or Server, the indicator at the lower right corner of the main GAS-Guard View 2.0 window should say Busy or Idle. If it says None, the Viewer and Poller components of GAS-Guard View 2.0 are not communicating correctly. For more information about GAS-Guard View’s components, please see the Theory of Operations section below.
Theory of Operations Overview Note: this section assumes general knowledge of Microsoft Windows system administration. Understanding the concepts presented here is not required to make successful use of the GAS-Guard View 2.0 software. GAS-Guard View 2.0 is composed of two components, the Viewer and the Poller. These components are separate programs. The Viewer is the application you see and interact with. The Poller works “behind the scenes”, communicating with your Siemens monitor(s) and saving the data they gather in files. The Viewer is always installed and appears in your Start menu under Programs Siemens GAS-Guard View 2.0 Installation of the Poller depends on the installation configuration you selected.
67 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
810-1735-01 Rev A
If the Installation Configuration is…
Then the Poller component is…
Viewer Only
Not installed – not present.
Standalone
Installed as an ordinary program with a shortcut in every user’s Startup folder.
Server
Installed as a Windows Service requiring separate login credentials that you must specify during installation.
For more information about installation configurations, see the section Choosing an Installation Configuration near the beginning of this manual. GAS-Guard View 2.0 stores company, site, and asset names, the communications configuration, and information gathered from the monitor in structured text files with the extension .TGH (“TGH files”). This file-based design provides data portability and serves to segregate the data by monitor. GAS-Guard View 2.0 retains compatibility with files created using GAS-Guard View version 1.6.2 or earlier. Note: files created or modified by GAS-Guard View 2.0 are incompatible with GAS-Guard View version 1.6.2 (or earlier) and TM MultiView. If your site includes multiple installations of GAS-Guard View, all users should upgrade earlier versions to GAS-Guard View 2.0. In addition to information stored in TGH files, both the Viewer and the Poller store information in the Registry. The Viewer saves the content of the Navigation pane so it can be restored each time you reopen the Viewer. The Poller saves licensing information and the contents of the Polling tab there.
Viewer Component The Viewer provides the entire user interface to GAS-Guard View 2.0. The Viewer opens TGH files in order to read and display their contents; it is incapable of updating or modifying TGH file contents in any way. All operations that update or modify file data involve the Poller This includes operations that do not involve Siemens monitors, such as entering DGA data and creating annotations. Since these operations require the cooperation of the Poller, they are not available to users with Viewer Only installation configurations.
Poller Component The Poller is responsible for all monitor communication and updates to data files, but does not offer a user interface. Since the Poller has no user interface of its own, it must rely on the Viewer to provide one. The Viewer and Poller often interact as client and server, although neither one requires the presence of the other. The Viewer may be installed without the Poller (Viewer Only
68 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
installation configuration). The Poller runs whenever you are logged in (Standalone configuration) or continuously (Server configuration). The Viewer communicates with the Poller using TCP/IP. The Poller listens on port 8011. The Poller accepts connections only from a single Viewer on the same computer (localhost). This feature is hardwired in the code. Restricting incoming connections to localhost addresses network security concerns associated with the use of TCP. If you run firewall software locally on the PC, you may be required to configure the firewall to allow the Poller to listen locally on port 8011. As noted above, this should not raise security concerns because the Poller will only accept connections originating from the same computer on which it is running. GAS-Guard View 2.0 does not offer any network service(s) available from off-host.
69 of 70
GAS-Guard View Software User's Manual v2.0
Serveron Corporation 3305 NW Aloclek Drive Hillsboro, OR 97124 USA www.serveron.com Corporate Office: (800) 880-2552 Technical Support: (866) 273-7763 E-mail: [email protected] Copyright © 2008 Serveron Corporation All rights reserved.
70 of 70
810-1735-01 Rev A
POWEROHM RESISTOR, INC. 5713 13TH STREET KATY, TX 77493
INSTALLATION AND MAINTENANCE INSTRUCTIONS FOR NEUTRAL GROUNDING RESISTORS
IMPORTANT: READ INSTRUCTIONS THROUGHLY BEFORE UNPACKING
INSTALLATION AND MAINTENANCE INSTRUCTIONS FOR POWEROHM NEUTRAL GROUNDING RESISTORS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SHIPPING AND RECEIVING
2
INSTALLATION
3
INSPECTION
4
NEUTRAL CONNECTION
5
GROUND CONNECTION
6
ACCESSORIES
7
MAINTENANCE
8
STORAGE
9
1
SHIPPING After the final inspection, Powerohm Neutral Grounding Resistors are securely fastened, in an upright position, onto a wooden skid. In some cases, additional bracing and/or banding is added to insure a safe shipment. The units are then completely wrapped with plastic to protect the finish and keep the outer surface free of dirt and moisture. Depending on certain criteria, units are shipped either "open" or crated. All crates are constructed with 1" thick lumber. The finished package is easily handled with a forklift or hand truck. All crates are clearly marked with the correct shipping information and requested customer marks. A copy of the packing list is securely fastened to the package in clear view. NOTE:
Each unit is provided with a copy of the certified test report (the originals are kept on file at the factory).
Normally, all crates are loaded by forklift into the enclosed van of a common carrier. At this point, it is the responsibility of the carrier to provide proper handling to the destination.
RECEIVING Upon receipt, the crated unit should be unloaded and inspected immediately to insure that proper handling was practiced during transit. Report any apparent damage to the crate that could have harmed the contents. NOTE:
Great care is taken to properly package your resistor, therefore, it is recommended that the unit remains crated until it reaches the job site.
All packaged neutral grounding resistors are suitable for prolonged storage. Always store the unit in the upright position (as shipped). Setting the crate on its side or top will likely cause damage to the resistor. Avoid stacking anything on top of the crate.
2
INSTALLATION When ready for installation at the jobsite, uncrate the resistor using care not to damage the enclosure finish and/or external bushings. Next, remove the bolts which fasten the resistor enclosure to the skid. It is recommended that a hoisting device be used to lift the unit with the aid of the eyebolts on the top of the enclosure. When using the eyebolts provided with Powerohm Resistors Inc. neutral grounding resistors located at the top of the enclosure, lifting must incorporate use of a spreading device to ensure a safe lift. Not utilizing a spreader while lifting the unit causes the eyebolts to be pulled at various angles resulting in roof damage. See examples below:
CORRECT
NOT CORRECT
For units without eyebolts or if a hoisting device is not available, a forklift can be used, provided the forks rest against the top of the mounting channels located on the bottom of the enclosure. Avoid resting the forks against the screened center. NOTE:
Do not remove the enclosure covers before lifting the resistor unit.
Powerohm Neutral Grounding Resistors can be mounted on a concrete pad, support stand or directly on top of the transformer (if the units size and weight will permit). Always mount the unit in the upright position. The unit should be bolted to the mounting surface using the 5/8" diameter holes provided at each corner of the mounting channels. Expansion type anchors are recommended for concrete pad mounting. If the enclosure has an elevating stand, secure the stand to it's mounting surface before mounting the enclosure. Never lift the enclosure with the elevating stand attached. NOTE:
The enclosure should always be securely grounded to prevent a shock hazard to personnel or wildlife. 3
INSPECTION After the resistor has been securely mounted, remove the front cover (the front cover can be identified by the Powerohm nameplate). Note: If the unit has external bushings mounted on the front cover, remove the back cover only. When installing the front or back cover, DO NOT EXCEED 20 IN.-LBS WHEN TIGHTENING THE 1/4-20 COVER HARDWARE (exceeding this torque value will damage the 1/4-20 threaded inserts). After removing the cover, remove all packing material and banding, if any, used to support the insulators and resistor banks during shipment. NOTE:
Failure to remove packing material from the inside of the enclosure may result in fire hazard and/or resistor failure.
With the packing material removed, carefully inspect the inside of the unit for broken insulators, bushings and other parts that may have been damaged during shipment. NOTE:
If any damaged parts are found, contact the factory immediately. Energizing the unit may damage the resistor and create a shock hazard to personnel.
Finally, check all electrical connections to ensure tightness.
4
NEUTRAL CONNECTION The neutral lead from the transformer or generator may be connected one of three ways depending upon the specific design (refer to the supplied drawing for terminal location): 1.
The connection is made directly to a top or side mounted entrance bushing. The bushing may have an eyebolt connector (accepts bare cable), a copper stud connector (requires customer supplied lug) or a NEMA two or four hole pad type connector (requires customer supplied lug).
2.
The connection is made directly to an internal terminal via rigid conduit entering from the bottom through enclosure knockouts. The terminal consists of a firmly supported stainless steel conductor (normally a Nema 2-hole pad). Cable termination will require a customer supplied compression type lug (that accepts up to 4/0 cable). The neutral terminal is tagged for easy identification. Location and termination of the conduit is the customer's responsibility.
3.
The connection is made directly to the primary terminal of the current transformer which is mounted inside the enclosure. This terminal will be tagged "neutral" and requires a customer supplied lug and bolt. The other primary terminal of the current transformer has been factory wired to the resistive element. The neutral lead usually enters from the bottom through conduit. Sometimes the current transformer is factory wired to a top mounted entrance bushing in which case the connection is the same as the first example above.
NOTE:
The factory supplied drawing identifies the neutral and ground connection.
In all cases, the neutral terminal is tagged for easy identification and the proper connection is shown schematically on the drawing. Check all electrical connections to ensure tightness.
5
GROUND CONNECTION The ground lead from the resistive element to ground may be connected one of two ways: 1.
The connection is made directly to a top or side mounted entrance bushing. The bushing may have an eyebolt connector (accepts bare cable), a copper stud connector (requires customer supplied lug) or a NEMA two or four hole pad type connector (also requires customer supplied lug).
2.
The connection is made directly to an internal terminal via rigid conduit entering from the bottom through enclosure knockouts. The terminal consists of a firmly supported stainless steel conductor (normally a Nema 2-hole pad). Cable termination will require a customer supplied compression type lug (that accepts up to 4/0 cable). The ground terminal is tagged for easy identification. Location and termination of the conduit is the customer's responsibility. Please note if a window type current transformer is present the ground cable must pass through the window of the current transformer and connect to the ground terminal (as identified above).
NOTE:
The factory supplied drawing identifies the neutral and ground connection.
In all cases, the ground connection is tagged for easy identification and the proper connection is shown schematically on the drawing. Check all electrical connections to ensure tightness.
6
ACCESSORIES Neutral grounding resistors may come equipped with accessories such as ground fault sensing devices. If applicable please follow the instructions below when connecting this type of equipment. 1.
2.
If a sensing resistor is present both neutral and ground terminals come pre-wired by the factory. However signal leads must be field wired to the appropriate terminals on the ground fault monitoring device (see owner’s manual). If a current transformer is present the ground cable must pass through the window of the current transformer and connect to the ground terminal (as identified in step 2 of the ground connection section). In addition, the current transformer secondaries (X1 and X2) must be field wired to the appropriate terminals on the ground fault monitoring device (see owner’s manual).
NOTE:
The factory supplied drawing identifies these connections.
In all cases, both the neutral and ground connections are tagged for easy identification and proper connection is shown schematically on the drawing. Check all electrical connections to ensure tightness.
7
MAINTENANCE Normally, no maintenance is necessary on a neutral grounding resistor. However, periodic inspections for damage are needed to ensure that the resistor is still capable of protecting the system. Damage may occur from lightning, storms, earthquakes, wildlife, overloads or extended service life. Basically, it is necessary to ensure that the resistive element has not burned open and that the element (including the incoming bushing) is still properly isolated from ground. The following procedure is recommended for periodic field inspections. 1.
De-energize the system being grounded and break the connection between the system neutral and the grounding resistor. An isolation switch is some times available to break this connection. These precautions are recommended to prevent a shock hazard to maintenance personnel and to prevent the system from being operated without proper grounding.
2.
Remove the front cover (which is on the same side as the nameplate) and the rear cover. This will allow for a visual inspection of all internal components.
3.
Carefully check for cracked insulators or bushings. A Meggar or Hi-Pot test is the most reliable method of ensuring that the porcelain insulation is still providing the necessary electrical isolation.
4.
Check the resistive element for continuity. An ohmmeter reading made between the neutral and the ground side of the resistor should be within 10% of the nameplate value. If the resistance of the element is more than 15% off from the nameplate value, the resistors should be replaced.
5.
Check all internal connections for tightness. Check wiring for signs of damage from heat or overloads.
6.
Check the enclosure for signs of damage from weather or rodents. Replace all covers removed during inspection and check the mounting bolts for tightness.
8
STORAGE 1.
If the unit is to be unused or stored for any length of time indoors, cover the unit to prevent buildup of dirt. If stored outdoors, do not cover with plastic that may create condensation and enclosure corrosion or staining.
2.
There is no special preparation for the unit.
3.
Storage temperatures should remain -40C to 70C (-40F to 158F).
9
Discharge Manual Covers VinBulk and RhinoBulk
Author Date
Justin Smith st
1 November 2013 © 2013 Trans Ocean/JF Hillebrand www.transoceanbulk.com www.jfhillebrand.com
This document remains the sole property of JF Hillebrand Group AG and is to be used by the employees of Trans Ocean Bulk Logistics, JF Hillebrand, their appointed agents and customers. Issuance outside of these entities must first be authorised by Trans Ocean Technical Department.
Any questions regarding any aspect of this manual or the equipment required should be referred to the nearest Trans Ocean Technical Representative. Revision and Issue Listing The final issue on the list will be considered as the current version of the document. Revision
Date
Description
A B
14th Aug 2012 1st Nov 2013
Original issue New format and combined VinBulk and RhinoBulk versions
Checklist A multilingual checklist is attached to the PDF version of this manual
Equipment requirements • • •
The flexitank valve connection is a 3” (DN80) male Camlock. A female Camlock connector will therefore be required. A strap or stand will be required to support the hose during discharge to avoid excessive stress on the valve/elbow assembly. The flexitank cannot be pressurised to assist discharge and therefore a suitable pump will be required.
It is recommended that advice always be sought from a Trans Ocean technical representative before proceeding. This is important due to the potential variations in discharge sites.
Discharge manual
Page 2 of 4
www.transoceanbulk.com
1. Container Positioning & Safety a) b) c) d) e)
Park container/chassis in a stable position Apply ALL vehicle and chassis parking brakes. Turn off vehicle engine and remove keys from ignition. Ground/Earth container via suitable conductive media. Secure chassis wheels with front and back chocks. A slope (<5°) to the rear will assist discharge of the flexitank although this is not essential.
f)
NOTE: These safety procedures MUST be completed before discharge can commence. These should be considered the minimum steps and any additional requirements for a particular facility should be followed accordingly.
2. Discharge a) Check container number corresponds with all relevant documentation. b) Check customs seal is intact and that number corresponds to relevant documentation
c)
Check valve condition. Valve should be locked in closed position with cap in place.
d)
Remove cap and connect hose. Hose should be supported to avoid excess strain on valve/ elbow assembly.
e)
Open valve and ensure locking pin is engaged when ready to begin discharge.
Discharge manual
Page 3 of 4
www.transoceanbulk.com
Flexitank will collapse as discharge continues.
f)
g)
Hose support may require adjustment throughout discharge.
h)
After discharge is complete close valves and replace cap.
Discharge manual
Page 4 of 4
www.transoceanbulk.com
CROMPTON GREAVES LTD; POWER TRANSFORMER DIVISION (T1) : POWER SYSTEMS Kanjur Marg (East), Mumbai 400 042, India
10.4 List of Brochures 1)
Operating Instruction for OLTC MR GERMANY
Leaflet
2)
Installation and Maintenance Instructions of Temperature Indicators (WTI/OTI) perfect control make.
Leaflet
3)
Transformer Temperature Indicator (WTI/OTI)
Leaflet
4)
Tech. Specification on Temperature Detector (RTD System) Perfect Control Make.
Leaflet
5)
Pressure Equalizing Between OLTC & tank
T005-0497
6)
Plate Valve Assembly
T010-0497
7)
Gas and Oil Actuated Relay
T016-0497
8)
Silica gel Breather
T020-0799
9)
Magnetic oil level gauge
T025-0497
10)
Gas Collecting Device
T029-0897
11)
Constant Oil Pressure System (COPS) Conservator
T034-0201
12)
Long Term Storage of Gas Filled Main Unit & Accessories
T035-0998
4
On-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM VR I HD Operating Data Technical Instructions
© All rights reserved by Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen Copying and distribution of this document and the utilization and communication of its contents are strictly prohibited unless expressly authorized. Offenders will be held liable for the payment of damages. All rights reserved in the event of the grant of a patent, utility model or ornamental design registration. The product may have been modified after this document went to press. We expressly reserve the right to make changes to the technical data, the design or the scope of delivery. The information provided and the arrangements agreed during processing of the relevant quotations and orders are generally binding. The original operating instructions were drawn up in German.
Table of contents
Table of contents 1
General / Technical Data ............................................................ 11
1.1
On-load tap-changer designations..........................................................11
1.2
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM ........................................................12
1.2.1 1.2.2 1.2.3 1.2.4
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM I .................................................................. 12 Technical data for VACUTAP® VM II ................................................................. 13 Technical data for VACUTAP® VM III ................................................................ 14 Step capacity diagram VM.................................................................................. 15
1.3
Rated insulation level..............................................................................17
1.4
Rated withstand voltages........................................................................17
1.4.1
1.4.3
Rated withstand voltages of the internal on-load tap-changer insulation (with the exception of VACUTAP® VM 300) ...................................................... 19 Rated withstand voltages of the internal on-load tap-changer insulation for VACUTAP® VM 300........................................................................................... 20 VM rated withstand voltages – multiple coarse change-over selector .............. 22
2
Special designs........................................................................... 23
2.1
Parallel bridges for parallel connections .................................................23
2.2
On-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM 650 Y...VM I 1503 with multiple coarse change-over selector (up to maximum of 5 coarse tap connections)............................................................................................24
2.3
Two-pole on-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM II 302/352/502/602 ......24
2.4
On-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM III 350 Y...VM I 1503 for linear voltage adjustment, up to a maximum of 34 operating positions ............24
3
Appendix ..................................................................................... 25
3.1
Dimensional drawings/connection diagrams...........................................25
3.1.1 3.1.2 3.1.3 3.1.4 3.1.5
VACUTAP® VM III 300 Y-0/W/G (898038) ........................................................ 25 VACUTAP® VM II 302-0/W/G (898039)............................................................. 26 VACUTAP® VM I 301-0/W/G (898040).............................................................. 27 VACUTAP® VM III 350/500/650 Y-0/W/G (746219) .......................................... 28 VACUTAP® VM II 352/502/652-0/W/G (746220)............................................... 29
1.4.2
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
3
Table of contents
3.1.6 3.1.7 3.1.8 3.1.9 3.1.10 3.1.11 3.1.12 3.1.13 3.1.14 3.1.15 3.1.16 3.1.17 3.1.18 3.1.19 3.1.20 3.1.21 3.1.22 3.1.23 3.1.24 3.1.25 3.1.26 3.1.27 3.1.28 3.1.29 3.1.30 3.1.31 3.1.32 3.1.33 3.1.34 3.1.35 3.1.36 3.1.37 3.1.38 3.1.39
4
VACUTAP® VM II 351/501/651-0/W/G (746221)............................................... 30 VACUTAP® VM I 802/1002-0/W/G (746222)..................................................... 31 VACUTAP® VM I 1203/1503-0/W/G (746223)................................................... 32 VACUTAP® VM III K-0/W/G (746224) ............................................................... 33 VACUTAP® VM III 650 Y with multiple coarse change-over selector (746226) 34 VACUTAP® VM I 601 with multiple coarse change-over selector (746227)...... 35 VACUTAP® VM I 802/1002 with multiple coarse change-over selector (746228) ............................................................................................................. 36 VACUTAP® VM I 1203/1503 with multiple coarse change-over selector (746229) ............................................................................................................. 37 VACUTAP® VM III 300 tie-in resistors without potential switch (898695).......... 38 VACUTAP® VM III 300 tie-in resistors without potential switch (898694).......... 39 VACUTAP® VM III 300 tie-in resistors without potential switch (898693).......... 40 VACUTAP® VM III Y tie-in resistors with/without potential switch (898692)...... 41 VACUTAP® VM II tie-in resistors with/without potential switch (898691) .......... 42 VACUTAP® VM I tie-in resistors with/without potential switch (898690) ........... 43 VACUTAP® VM I 351...1503, tie-in resistor cylinder with potential switch without tie-in resistors (898804) ......................................................................... 44 VACUTAP® VM 300 – installation drawing of centrical drive (765192) ............ 45 VACUTAP® VM – installation drawing of centrical drive (746230) ................... 46 VACUTAP® VM – on-load tap-changer head, centrical drive (893899) ........... 48 VACUTAP® VM – variants of on-load tap-changer head (720026) .................. 49 VACUTAP® VM – swivel range of gear unit (720027) ..................................... 50 VACUTAP® VM – screenings on oil compartment contacts (730336) ............. 51 VACUTAP® VM 300 – tap selector cross-sections (898041) ........................... 52 VACUTAP® VM 300 – arrangement of contacts on tap selector (blanks, 891114)................................................................................................. 53 VACUTAP® VM – arrangement of contacts on tap selector, tap selector division 10...22 (898013) .................................................................................... 54 VACUTAP® VM – installation position of tap selector connection contacts (890477) ............................................................................................................. 55 VACUTAP® VM – connecting leads 3W, 1G, 3G (723590) ............................. 56 VACUTAP® VM – screenings on fine tap selector and change-over selector (730335) ............................................................................................................. 57 VACUTAP® VM 802/803/1203/1503 – bridges to parallel connection of tap selector connection contacts (899598)............................................................... 58 VACUTAP® VM – horizontal drive shaft, centrical drive (893896) ................... 59 VACUTAP® VM III 350/500/650 Y – arrangement of tap selectors (891107) .. 60 VACUTAP® VM I 351/501/651 – arrangement of tap selectors (891108) ........ 61 VACUTAP® VM I 1503 – arrangement of tap selectors (891109) .................... 62 VACUTAP® VM I 802/1002 – arrangement of tap selectors (891110) ............. 63 VACUTAP® VM, supporting flange, special design for bell-type tank installation for Um up to 300 kV (896762) ............................................................................ 64
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
Table of contents
3.1.40 3.1.41 3.1.42 3.1.43
VACUTAP® VM – flange for pressure relief valve (895168) ............................ 65 VACUTAP® VM – tap selector base with additional screening, reversing change-over selector design (893934) ............................................................... 66 VACUTAP® VM – tap selector base with additional screening, coarse tap connection design (893935) ............................................................................... 67 VACUTAP® VM – tap selector base with through hole D20 and D13 (725649) ............................................................................................................. 68
3.2
VACUTAP® VM 300 – overview of on-load tap-changer designs (765835)..................................................................................................69
3.3
VACUTAP® VM – overview of on-load tap-changer designs (899740) 70
3.4
Overview of basic connection diagrams with tap selector connection contacts designated in accordance with MR standard (890616) ............71
3.5
Connection diagram (contacts designated in accordance with MR standard).................................................................................................74
3.5.1 3.5.2 3.5.3 3.5.4 3.5.5
VACUTAP® VM III 300 Y, basic connection diagram 10 19 1 W (2414642) ..... 74 VACUTAP® VM III 300 Y, basic connection diagram 10 19 3 W (2414644)...... 75 VACUTAP® VM III 300 Y, basic connection diagram 14 27 1 G (2414648) ...... 76 VACUTAP® VM III 300 Y, basic connection diagram 14 27 3 G (2414649) ...... 77 VACUTAP® VM III 350/500/650 Y, basic connection diagram 10 19 1 W (2414658) ........................................................................................................... 78 VACUTAP® VM III 350/500/650 Y, basic connection diagram 10 19 3 W (2414670) ........................................................................................................... 79 VACUTAP® VM I 802/1002, basic connection diagram 14 27 1 G (2414631)... 80 VACUTAP® VM I 1203/1503, basic connection diagram 18 35 1 W (2414636) ........................................................................................................... 81 VACUTAP® VM I 802/1002, basic connection diagram 16 79 1 G, multiple coarse change-over selector design (2407535) ................................................. 82
3.5.6 3.5.7 3.5.8 3.5.9
4
MR worldwide.............................................................................. 83
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
5
List of figures
List of figures Figure 1
Step capacities (rated step voltage Ui, rated through-current Iu) .....15
Figure 2
Step capacities (rated step voltage Ui, rated through-current Iu) .....16
Figure 3
Rated withstand voltages ................................................................18
Figure 4
On-load tap-changer combination VM I 351/VM II 352 (a – VM I 351, b – VM II 352) for delta connection .......................23
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
7
List of tables
List of tables Table 1
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM I ......................................................12
Table 2
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM II .....................................................13
Table 3
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM III ....................................................14
Table 4
Rated insulation level..............................................................................17
Table 5
Rated withstand voltages of the internal on-load tap-changer insulation (with the exception of VACUTAP® VM 300)...........................................19
Table 6
Rated withstand voltages of the internal on-load tap-changer insulation for VACUTAP® VM 300..........................................................................20
Table 7
Available connections (also available as 3 W, 3 G) ................................21
Table 8
On-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM with multiple coarse change-over selector, rated withstand voltages of the internal on-load tap-changer insulation.................................................................................................22
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
9
1 General / Technical Data
1
General / Technical Data
1.1
On-load tap-changer designations Example: VM III
650
Y - 72.5 / C - 10
19
1W
R
Basic connection diagram
Type Number of phases
Ium (in A)
Number of parallel main switching contacts
Applications Um (in kV)
VACUTAP® VM
VM
1 phase 2 phases 3 phases VM I, VM II, VM III VM I, VM II, VM III VM I, VM II, VM III VM I, VM II, VM III VM I VM I VM I VM I 1 (3-phase Y) 1 (1-phase) 2 (1-phase) 3 (1-phase) For use with neutral point only
I II III 300 350 500 650 802 1002 1203 1503 0 1 2 3 Y
VM VM VM VM VM
72.5 123 170 245 300 B C D DE
Tap selector size
Number of maximum operating positions without change-over selector
Number of maximum operating positions with changeover selector (reversing change-over selector or coarse tap selector)1) Number of maximum operating positions with multiple coarse change-over selector
Mid-positions
Change-over selector Tie-in measures
1)
not with multiple coarse changeover selector 10 12 14 16 18 22 10 12 14 16 18 10 12 14 16 18 0 mid-positions (without changeover selector) 1 mid-position 3 mid-positions Reversing change-over selector Coarse tap connection Tie-in resistor Potential switch Potential switch with tie-in resistor
10 12 14 16 18 22 19 23 27 31 35 59 71 83 95 107 0 1 3 W G R S P
300 amp variants with a maximum of 27 operating positions available
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
11
1 General / Technical Data
1.2
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM
1.2.1
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM I
On-load tap-changer VM I
301
302
351
501
651
1002
1203
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
300
300
350
500
650
800
800
1000
1200
1500
Rated short-time current (in kA)
4
4
4.2
5
6.5
8
8
10
12
15
Rated duration of short-circuits (in s)
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
Rated peak withstand current (in kA)
10
10
10.5
12.5
16.25
20
20
25
30
37.5
3300
3300
3300
3300
3300
3300
3300
3300
3300
3300
990
990
1155
1625
1625
2640
2640
3300
3500
3500
Number of phases and application Maximum rated through current Ium (in A)
Maximum rated step voltage Uim (in V)1) Step capacity (PStN, in kVA)
Oil compartment
Temperature range
Dimensions
Table 1
803
1503
50...60
Rated frequency (in Hz) Operating positions
802
Without change-over selector: maximum 18 With change-over selector: maximum 352) With multiple coarse change-over selector: maximum 1072) Pressure-tight up to 0.3 bar permanent differential pressure (test pressure 0.6 bar), head and cover of the diverter switch oil compartment are vacuum-proof. The on-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM can be operated in the rated load range at surrounding oil temperatures of between -25 ° and +105 °C and with overload up to +115 °C in accordance with IEC 60214-1. For details of operation under Arctic conditions, please refer to the General Technical Data TD 61. Weight, displacement volume and oil content of the diverter switch oil compartment are shown in the relevant dimension drawings.
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM I
1)
The maximum rated step voltage may be exceeded by 10 % due to overexcitation of the transformer if the step capacity is limited to its rated value.
2)
300 amp variants with a maximum of 27 operating positions available
12
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
1 General / Technical Data
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM II
1.2.2
On-load tap-changer VM II
302
352
502
652
2
2
2
2
300
350
500
650
Rated short-time current (in kA)
4
4.2
5
6.5
Rated duration of short-circuits (in s)
3
3
3
3
Number of phases and application Maximum rated through current Ium (in A)
Rated peak withstand current (in kA) 1)
Maximum rated step voltage Uim (in V) Step capacity (PStN, in kVA)
10
10.5
12.5
16.25
3300
3300
3300
3300
990
1155
1625
1625
50...60
Rated frequency (in Hz) Operating positions
Oil compartment
Temperature range
Dimensions
Table 2
Without change-over selector: maximum 18 With change-over selector: maximum 352) With multiple coarse change-over selector: maximum 1072) Pressure-tight up to 0.3 bar permanent differential pressure (test pressure 0.6 bar), head and cover of the diverter switch oil compartment are vacuum-proof. The on-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM can be operated in the rated load range at surrounding oil temperatures of between -25 ° and +105 °C and with overload up to +115 °C in accordance with IEC 60214-1. For details of operation under Arctic conditions, please refer to the General Technical Data for TD 61. Weight, displacement volume and oil content of the diverter switch oil compartment are shown in the relevant dimension drawings.
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM II
1)
The maximum rated step voltage may be exceeded by 10 % due to overexcitation of the transformer if the step capacity is limited to its rated value.
2)
300 amp variants with a maximum of 27 operating positions available
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
13
1 General / Technical Data
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM III
1.2.3
On-load tap-changer VM III
300 Y
350 Y
500 Y
650 Y
3
3
3
3
300
350
500
650
Rated short-time current (in kA)
4
4.2
5
6.5
Rated duration of short-circuits (in s)
3
3
3
3
Number of phases and application Maximum rated through current Ium (in A)
Rated peak withstand current (in kA) Maximum rated step voltage Uim (in V)
1)
Step capacity (PStN, in kVA)
10
10.5
12.5
16.25
3300
3300
3300
3300
990
1155
1625
1625
50...60
Rated frequency (in Hz) Operating positions
Oil compartment
Temperature range
Dimensions
Table 3
Without change-over selector: maximum 18 With change-over selector: maximum 352) With multiple coarse change-over selector: maximum 1072) Pressure-tight up to 0.3 bar permanent differential pressure (test pressure 0.6 bar), head and cover of the diverter switch oil compartment are vacuum-proof. The on-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM can be operated in the rated load range at surrounding oil temperatures of between -25 ° and +105 °C and with overload up to +115 °C in accordance with IEC 60214-1. For details of operation under Arctic conditions, please refer to the General Technical Data for TD 61. Weight, displacement volume and oil content of the diverter switch oil compartment are shown in the relevant dimension drawings.
Technical data for VACUTAP® VM III
1)
The maximum rated step voltage may be exceeded by 10 % due to overexcitation of the transformer if the step capacity is limited to its rated value.
2)
300 amp variants with a maximum of 27 operating positions available
14
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
1 General / Technical Data
Step capacity diagram VM
1.2.4.1
Step capacity diagram for network application
Rated step voltage Ui (V)i
1.2.4
Rated through current Iu (A) u Figure 1
Step capacities (rated step voltage Ui, rated through-current Iu)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
15
1 General / Technical Data
Step capacity diagram for autoclave application
Rated step voltage Ui (V)i
1.2.4.2
Rated through current Iu (A) Figure 2
16
Step capacities (rated step voltage Ui, rated through-current Iu)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
1 General / Technical Data
1.3
Rated insulation level Rated insulation level
For all on-load tap-changer variants
Highest voltage for equipment Um (in kV)1
72.5
123
170
245
3002)
Highest operating voltage Ub (phase-phase) on on-load tap-changer (kV)
55
79
145
170
245
Rated lightning impulse withstand voltage (in kV, 1.2/50 µs)
350
550
750
1050 1050
140
230
325
Rated switching impulse voltage (in kV) Rated short-duration power frequency withstand voltage (in kV, 50 Hz, 1 min.) Table 4
1.4
850
850
460
460
Rated insulation level
1)
In accordance with IEC 60214-1, chapter 3.57: highest effective value for phaseto-phase voltage in a three-phase system for which an on-load tap-changer is designed with respect to its insulation.
2)
300 A variants with a maximum of 245 KV available.
Rated withstand voltages Figure 3 shows diagrams of the voltage stress present on the tap winding of the three primary basic connections of three-pole on-load tap-changers and singlepole on-load tap-changers. When selecting the on-load tap-changer, you must check that the highest stress on the tap selector does not exceed the related rated withstand voltages.
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
17
1 General / Technical Data
without change-over selector
with coarse change-over selector in (+) position
with reversing change-over selector
with coarse change-over selector in (-) position
CAUTION Adhere to maximum rated lightning impulse withstand voltage stress on a0 in mid-position.
Figure 3
Rated withstand voltages
a0
=
Between selected and preselected tap on the diverter switch and tap selector.
a1
=
Between tap selector contacts of the winding of one tap position (connected or not connected)
a
=
Between beginning and end of a tapped winding and, with respect to a coarse winding, between beginning and end of a coarse winding. Note for coarse tap selector connection (-) position of the change-over selector: When stressed with impulse voltage, the permissible withstand voltage "a" must be adhered to between the end of a coarse tap winding connected with the K fine tap selector contact and the fine tap selector contact at the end of the tapped winding of the same phase.
b
=
Between the fine tap selector contacts of different phases and between change-over selector contacts of different phases, which are connected with the beginning/end of a tapped winding or with a fine tap selector contact.
f
=
Between diverter switch output terminal and ground
Additionally for coarse tapping arrangement in (+) position of the change-over selector:
18
c1
=
From one (-) change-over selector contact to take-off lead of the same phase.
c2
=
Between (-) change-over selector contacts of different phases.
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
1 General / Technical Data
1.4.1
Rated withstand voltages of the internal on-load tap-changer insulation (with the exception of VACUTAP® VM 300) The tap selector size (ID letters B, C, D, DE, E) characterizes the internal insulation of the tap selector, whose rated withstand voltages must be matched to the requirements of the transformer winding.
Insulation distances
Tap selector size B
Tap selector size Tap selector size Tap selector size C D DE
kV kV 1.2/ 50 µs 50 Hz 1 min
kV kV 1.2/50 µs 50 Hz 1 min
kV kV 1.2/50 µs 50 Hz 1 min
kV kV 1.2/50 µs 50 Hz 1 min
a0
Power-frequency voltage test (50 Hz/1 min): 20 kV 50 Hz 1 min; Response voltage with 1 mA leakage current: 35 kV 1.2/50 µs; 3 kA residual voltage (= lightning impulse protection level): 56 kV 1.2/50 µs with ZnO
a1
150
30
150
30
150
30
150
30
a
265
50
350
82
490
105
550
120
1)
b
265
50
350
82
490
146
550
160
c1
485
143
545
178
590
208
660
230
c21)
495
150
550
182
590
225
660
250
Table 5
1)
Rated withstand voltages of the internal on-load tap-changer insulation (with the exception of VACUTAP® VM 300)
Insulation distance omitted for single-pole on-load tap-changers
The admissible maximum operating voltage on the individual tap selector distances corresponds to half the value of the above mentioned rated shortduration power frequency withstand voltages.
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
19
1 General / Technical Data
1.4.2
Rated withstand voltages of the internal on-load tap-changer insulation for VACUTAP® VM 300
Insulation distances a0
VM III 300 Y kV 1.2/ 50 µs
VM I 301
kV, 50 Hz, 1 min
kV 1.2/ 50 µs
kV, 50 Hz, 1 min
Power-frequency voltage test (50 Hz/1 min): 20 kV 50 Hz 1 min; Response voltage with 1 mA leakage current: 35 kV 1.2/50 µs; 3 kA residual voltage (= lightning impulse protection level): 56 kV 1.2/50 µs with ZnO
a
300
b
300
70
-
-
c1
400
120
400
120
c2
400
120
-
-
Table 6
70
300
70
Rated withstand voltages of the internal on-load tap-changer insulation for VACUTAP® VM 300
The admissible maximum operating voltage on the individual tap selector distances corresponds to half the value of the above mentioned rated shortduration power frequency withstand voltages.
20
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
1 General / Technical Data
without change-over selector
with reversing change-over with coarse change-over selector selector
Connection
Tap selector size
Connection
Tap selector size
Connection
Tap selector size
10050
B/C/D/DE
10071W
B/C/D/DE
10071G
B/C/D/DE
10060
B/C/D/DE
10081W
B/C/D/DE
10081G
B/C/D/DE
10070
B/C/D/DE
10091W
B/C/D/DE
10091G
B/C/D/DE
10080
B/C/D/DE
12101W
B/C/D/DE
12101G
B/C/D/DE
10090
B/C/D/DE
12111W
B/C
12111G
B/C
10100
B/C/D/DE
14111W
D/DE
14111G
D/DE
12110
B/C/D/DE
14121W
B/C
14121G
B/C
12120
B/C/D/DE
14131W
B/C
14131G
B/C
14130
B/C/D/DE
16121W
D/DE
16121G
D/DE
14140
B/C/D/DE
16131W
D/DE
16131G
D/DE
16150
B/C/D/DE
16141W
B/C/D/DE
16141G
B/C/D/DE
16160
B/C/D/DE
16151W
B/C
16151G
B/C
18170
B/C/D/DE
18151W
D/DE
18151G
D/DE
18180
B/C/D/DE
18161W
B/C
18161G
B/C
22190
B/C/D/DE
18171W
B/C
18171G
B/C
22200
B/C/D/DE
10191W
B/C/D/DE
10191G
B/C/D/DE
22210
B/C
12231W
B/C/D/DE
12231G
B/C/D/DE
22220
B/C
14271W
B/C/D/DE
14271G
B/C/D/DE
16311W
B/C/D/DE
16311G
B/C/D/DE
18351W
B/C/D/DE
18351G
B/C/D/DE
Table 7
Available connections (also available as 3 W, 3 G)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
21
1 General / Technical Data
1.4.3
VM rated withstand voltages – multiple coarse change-over selector a0 = Between selected and preselected tap on the diverter switch and tap selector a1 = Between tap selector contacts of the winding of one tap position (connected or not connected) a
= Between beginning and end of a tapped winding and also between the connected K contact and any points of the tapped winding of the same phase
b
= Between the tap selector contacts of different phases and between the connected K contact of one phase and any points of the tapped winding of another phase
c1 = Between any coarse tappings of one phase to the diverter switch terminal of the same phase c2 = Between identically-named, unconnected coarse tappings of different phases d1 = Between connected and adjacent coarse tap contacts in one phase d2 = Between unconnected, adjacent coarse tap contacts in one phase d3 = Between beginning and end of all coarse tap connections of one phase f
Insulation distances a0
Tap selector size B kV 1.2/ 50 µs
= Between diverter switch output terminal and ground
Tap selector size C
kV kV 50 Hz, 1 min 1.2/50 µs
Tap selector size D
kV kV 50 Hz, 1 min 1.2/50 µs
kV 50 Hz, 1 min
Power-frequency voltage test (50 Hz/60 s): 20 kV 50 Hz 1 min; Response voltage with 1 mA leakage current: 35 kV 1.2/50 µs; 3 kA residual voltage (= lightning impulse protection level): 56 kV 1.2/50 µs with ZnO
a1
150
30
150
30
150
30
a
265
50
350
82
450
105
1)
b
265
50
350
82
450
146
c1
455
127
525
165
590
210
c21)
455
127
525
165
590
215
d1
265
50
350
82
450
105
d2
350
82
450
105
450
105
d3
350
82
450
105
490
120
Table 8 On-load tap-changer VACUTAP VM with multiple coarse change-over selector, rated withstand voltages of the internal on-load tap-changer insulation ®
1)
Insulation distance omitted for single-pole on-load tap-changers
The admissible maximum operating voltage on the individual tap selector distances corresponds to half the value of the above mentioned rated shortduration power frequency withstand voltages.
22
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2 Special designs
2
Special designs
2.1
Parallel bridges for parallel connections Current division on the connection contacts of 2 tap selector planes only for onload tap-changers VACUTAP® VM I 802 (803)/1002 and of 3 tap selector planes only for on-load tap-changers VACUTAP® VM I 1203/1503, see .Chapter 3.1.33 Parallel bridges on the tap selector terminals are mandatory if the tap winding has been wound in two or more branches and each of these branch taps is connected to the terminals of the tap selector. This measure reliably prevents the following: a)
Introduction of circulating currents into the current paths of tap selector and diverter switch
b)
Commutating arc on movable tap selector contact bridges
c)
Overvoltage between adjacent tap selector connection contacts connected in parallel
On-load tap-changer combination for delta connection The on-load tap-changers can also be used with the single-phase on-load tapchanger VM I 351 as a two column on-load tap-changer combination VM I 351/ VM II 352 for adjusting the voltage of transformer windings in a delta connection (analogous to VM I 501/VM II 502 and VM I 651/VM II 652). The tap windings should correspond to those in Figure 4.
Figure 4
On-load tap-changer combination VM I 351/VM II 352 (a – VM I 351, b – VM II 352) for delta connection
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
23
2 Special designs
2.2
On-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM 650 Y...VM I 1503 with multiple coarse change-over selector (up to maximum of 5 coarse tap connections) Extremely fine voltage adjustment requires a great number of operating positions which sometimes can only be achieved with a multiple coarse tapping arrangement. For instance, 107 operating positions can be obtained by using a 5-tap coarse winding and a tapped winding with 18 taps. The multiple coarse change-over selector is attached to both sides of the tap selector. The on-load tap-changers are available (on request) for Um = 72.5 up to max. 300 kV and for 2 to 5 coarse taps (tap selector sizes B and C) or 2 and 3 coarse tap connections (tap selector size D).
2.3
Two-pole on-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM II 302/352/502/602 On-load tap-changer VM II 302/352/502/602 can be supplied as a two-pole onload tap-changer for single-phase center point tap-change operations with the same technical data as on-load tap-changers VM III 350 Y, VM III 500 Y and/or VM III 650 Y (see dimensional drawings, Chapter 3).
2.4
On-load tap-changer VACUTAP® VM III 350 Y...VM I 1503 for linear voltage adjustment, up to a maximum of 34 operating positions The high number of operating positions without change-over selector is achieved by doubling the tap selector contact planes compared with the standard design (requires a larger installation length). The on-load tap-changers are available for Um = 72.5...300 kV and several tap selector sizes (rated withstand voltages and dimensional drawings on request).
24
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3
Appendix
3.1
Dimensional drawings/connection diagrams
3.1.1
VACUTAP® VM III 300 Y-0/W/G (898038)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
25
3 Appendix
3.1.2
26
VACUTAP® VM II 302-0/W/G (898039)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.3
VACUTAP® VM I 301-0/W/G (898040)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
27
3 Appendix
3.1.4
28
VACUTAP® VM III 350/500/650 Y-0/W/G (746219)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.5
VACUTAP® VM II 352/502/652-0/W/G (746220)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
29
3 Appendix
3.1.6
30
VACUTAP® VM II 351/501/651-0/W/G (746221)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.7
VACUTAP® VM I 802/1002-0/W/G (746222)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
31
3 Appendix
3.1.8
32
VACUTAP® VM I 1203/1503-0/W/G (746223)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.9
VACUTAP® VM III K-0/W/G (746224)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
33
3 Appendix
3.1.10
34
VACUTAP® VM III 650 Y with multiple coarse change-over selector (746226)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.11
VACUTAP® VM I 601 with multiple coarse change-over selector (746227)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
35
3 Appendix
3.1.12
36
VACUTAP® VM I 802/1002 with multiple coarse change-over selector (746228)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.13
VACUTAP® VM I 1203/1503 with multiple coarse change-over selector (746229)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
37
3 Appendix
3.1.14
38
VACUTAP® VM III 300 tie-in resistors without potential switch (898695)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.15
VACUTAP® VM III 300 tie-in resistors without potential switch (898694)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
39
3 Appendix
3.1.16
40
VACUTAP® VM III 300 tie-in resistors without potential switch (898693)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.17
VACUTAP® VM III Y tie-in resistors with/without potential switch (898692)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
41
3 Appendix
3.1.18
42
VACUTAP® VM II tie-in resistors with/without potential switch (898691)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.19
VACUTAP® VM I tie-in resistors with/without potential switch (898690)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
43
3 Appendix
3.1.20
44
VACUTAP® VM I 351...1503, tie-in resistor cylinder with potential switch without tie-in resistors (898804)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.21
VACUTAP® VM 300 – installation drawing of centrical drive (765192)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
45
3 Appendix
3.1.22
46
VACUTAP® VM – installation drawing of centrical drive (746230)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
VACUTAP® VM – installation drawing of centrical drive (746230)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
47
3 Appendix
3.1.23
48
VACUTAP® VM – on-load tap-changer head, centrical drive (893899)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.24
VACUTAP® VM – variants of on-load tap-changer head (720026)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
49
3 Appendix
3.1.25
50
VACUTAP® VM – swivel range of gear unit (720027)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.26
VACUTAP® VM – screenings on oil compartment contacts (730336)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
51
3 Appendix
3.1.27
52
VACUTAP® VM 300 – tap selector cross-sections (898041)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.28
VACUTAP® VM 300 – arrangement of contacts on tap selector (blanks, 891114)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
53
3 Appendix
3.1.29
54
VACUTAP® VM – arrangement of contacts on tap selector, tap selector division 10...22 (898013)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.30
VACUTAP® VM – installation position of tap selector connection contacts (890477)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
55
3 Appendix
3.1.31
56
VACUTAP® VM – connecting leads 3W, 1G, 3G (723590)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.32
VACUTAP® VM – screenings on fine tap selector and change-over selector (730335)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
57
3 Appendix
3.1.33
58
VACUTAP® VM 802/803/1203/1503 – bridges to parallel connection of tap selector connection contacts (899598)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.34
VACUTAP® VM – horizontal drive shaft, centrical drive (893896)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
59
3 Appendix
3.1.35
60
VACUTAP® VM III 350/500/650 Y – arrangement of tap selectors (891107)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.36
VACUTAP® VM I 351/501/651 – arrangement of tap selectors (891108)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
61
3 Appendix
3.1.37
62
VACUTAP® VM I 1503 – arrangement of tap selectors (891109)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.38
VACUTAP® VM I 802/1002 – arrangement of tap selectors (891110)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
63
3 Appendix
3.1.39
64
VACUTAP® VM, supporting flange, special design for bell-type tank installation for Um up to 300 kV (896762)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.40
VACUTAP® VM – flange for pressure relief valve (895168)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
65
3 Appendix
3.1.41
66
VACUTAP® VM – tap selector base with additional screening, reversing change-over selector design (893934)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.1.42
VACUTAP® VM – tap selector base with additional screening, coarse tap connection design (893935)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
67
3 Appendix
3.1.43
68
VACUTAP® VM – tap selector base with through hole D20 and D13 (725649)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.2
VACUTAP® VM 300 – overview of on-load tap-changer designs (765835)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
69
3 Appendix
3.3
70
VACUTAP® VM – overview of on-load tap-changer designs (899740)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.4
Overview of basic connection diagrams with tap selector connection contacts designated in accordance with MR standard (890616)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
71
3 Appendix
Overview of basic connection diagrams with tap selector connection contacts designated in accordance with MR standard (890616)
72
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
Overview of basic connection diagrams with tap selector connection contacts designated in accordance with MR standard (890616)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
73
3 Appendix
3.5
Connection diagram (contacts designated in accordance with MR standard)
3.5.1
VACUTAP® VM III 300 Y, basic connection diagram 10 19 1 W (2414642)
74
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.5.2
VACUTAP® VM III 300 Y, basic connection diagram 10 19 3 W (2414644)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
75
3 Appendix
3.5.3
76
VACUTAP® VM III 300 Y, basic connection diagram 14 27 1 G (2414648)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.5.4
VACUTAP® VM III 300 Y, basic connection diagram 14 27 3 G (2414649)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
77
3 Appendix
3.5.5
78
VACUTAP® VM III 350/500/650 Y, basic connection diagram 10 19 1 W (2414658)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.5.6
VACUTAP® VM III 350/500/650 Y, basic connection diagram 10 19 3 W (2414670)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
79
3 Appendix
3.5.7
80
VACUTAP® VM I 802/1002, basic connection diagram 14 27 1 G (2414631)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
3 Appendix
3.5.8
VACUTAP® VM I 1203/1503, basic connection diagram 18 35 1 W (2414636)
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
81
3 Appendix
3.5.9
82
VACUTAP® VM I 802/1002, basic connection diagram 16 79 1 G, multiple coarse change-over selector design (2407535)
VACUTAP® VM
2332907/00 EN
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
4 MR worldwide
4
MR worldwide
Australia Reinhausen Australia Pty. Ltd. Ground Floor 6-10 Geeves Avenue Rockdale N. S. W. 2216 Phone: +61 2 9556 2133 Fax: +61 2 9597 1339 E-Mail: [email protected]
Italy Reinhausen Italia S.r.l. Via Alserio, 16 20159 Milano Phone: +39 02 6943471 Fax: +39 02 69434766 E-Mail: [email protected]
Russian Federation OOO MR Naberezhnaya Akademika Tupoleva 15, Bld. 2 ("Tupolev Plaza") 105005 Moscow Tel. +7 495 980 89 67 Fax. +7 495 980 89 67 E-Mail: [email protected]
Brazil MR do Brasil Indústria Mecánica Ltda. Av. Elias Yazbek, 465 CEP: 06803-000 Embu - São Paulo Phone: +55 11 4785 2150 Fax: +55 11 4785 2185 E-Mail: [email protected]
Japan MR Japan Corporation German Industry Park 1-18-2 Hakusan, Midori-ku Yokohama 226-0006 Phone: +81 45 929 5728 Fax: +81 45 929 5741
South Africa Reinhausen South Africa (Pty) Ltd. No. 15, Third Street, Booysens Reserve Johannesburg Phone: +27 11 8352077 Fax: +27 11 8353806 E-Mail: [email protected]
Canada Reinhausen Canada Inc. 1010 Sherbrooke West, Suite 1800 Montréal, Québec H3A 2R7, Canada Phone: +1 514 286 1075 Fax: +1 514 286 0520 Mobile: +49 170 7807 696 E-Mail: [email protected]
Luxembourg Reinhausen Luxembourg S.A. 72, Rue de Prés L-7333 Steinsel Phone: +352 27 3347 1 Fax: +352 27 3347 99 E-Mail: [email protected]
South Korea Reinhausen Korea Ltd. Baek Sang Bldg. Room No. 1500 197-28, Kwanhun-Dong, Chongro-Ku Seoul 110-718, Korea Phone: +82 2 767 4909 Fax: +82 2 736 0049 E-Mail: [email protected]
India Easun-MR Tap Changers Ltd. 612, CTH Road Tiruninravur, Chennai 602 024 Phone: +91 44 26300883 Fax: +91 44 26390881 E-Mail: [email protected]
Malaysia Reinhausen Asia-Pacific Sdn. Bhd Level 11 Chulan Tower No. 3 Jalan Conlay 50450 Kuala Lumpur Phone: +60 3 2142 6481 Fax: +60 3 2142 6422 E-Mail: [email protected]
U.S.A. Reinhausen Manufacturing Inc. 2549 North 9th Avenue Humboldt, TN 38343 Phone: +1 731 784 7681 Fax: +1 731 784 7682 E-Mail: [email protected]
Iran Iran Transfo After Sales Services Co. Zanjan, Industrial Township No. 1 (Aliabad) Corner of Morad Str. Postal Code 4533144551 E-Mail: [email protected]
P.R.C. (China) MR China Ltd. (MRT)
United Arab Emirates Reinhausen Middle East FZE Dubai Airport Freezone Building Phase 6, 3rd floor, Office No. 6EB 341 Dubai Phone: +971 4 6091828 Fax: +971 4 6091829 E-Mail: [email protected]
ᓔᖋ䌌ᯧ˄Ϟ⍋˅᳝䰤݀ৌ ਛ࿖ᶏᶆϰᮄऎ⌺ϰफ䏃360ภ ᣂᶏ࿖䰙ॺ4ᭈEᐳ 䚂㓪˖ 200120 ⬉䆱˖ˇ86 21 61634588 Ӵⳳ˖ˇ86 21 61634582 䚂ㆅ˖[email protected] [email protected]
© Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen 2010
2332907/00 EN
VACUTAP® VM
83
2332907/00 EN • 11/10 • F0248500
TMDS™ Smart Monitor Solutions for transformer life-cycle management
Answers for energy.
TMDS™ Smart Monitor
Selecting a transformer monitoring solution is a critical step in achieving your company’s Smart Grid asset management strategy. Siemens TMDS™ Smart Monitor is a self-contained, expert system combining multiple IEEE/ANSI-accepted engineering models with advanced rulebased logic, far exceeding existing monitoring concepts. TMDS™ Smart Monitor turns transformer monitoring data into actionable information by translating combustible dissolved gas, bushing capacitance deviation, moisture and other sensor measured data into diagnostic and prognostic messaging. The TMDS™ Smart Monitor provides alarming using models that work with rule-based logic, derived from accepted IEEE/ANSI guidelines. Alarm messaging includes maintenance support and suggested loading recommendations should TMDS™ classify the observed deviation as severe enough that it may result in the damage or potential failure of the transformer.
Additionally the TMDS™ Smart Monitor can perform cooling system control functions by initiating staged cooling to optimize transformer operating temperatures. The Siemens TMDS™ Smart Monitor advantages include the following: Best-in-class transformer monitoring and diagnostic system Advanced detection of abnormal conditions Supports customer preferences in transformer sensing technologies Automatically detects bad sensor data to avoid false diagnosis Configurable for legacy transformers PI Historian and SCADA system interface Can be integrated with Siemens TMDS™ to support a centralized asset management strategy.
Comprehensive data requires powerful analytical tools
Select from a suite of analysis applications. The following Siemens specialist models are provided with TMDS™ Smart Monitor: Bushing relative capacitance deviation Evaluation of bushing insulation condition Insulation moisture Evaluation of oil moisture condition and estimated moisture in paper Thermal Hot spot evaluation by ANSI, IEC and Siemens proprietary methods Ageing and life expectancy Evaluation of relative loss of life and relative ageing by ANSI, IEC or ABNT methods Cooling system monitoring Evaluation of proper cooling system operation by monitoring the load current of the fan groups and oil or water flow (depending on the cooling system)
Conservator oil volume Provides advanced notification of conservator oil volume before reaching lowest acceptable level Cooling system control Controls the cooling system by calculating the future hot spot as a function of the current loading, executing periodical cooling groups exercise Dissolved gas-in-oil Evaluation of limit values of gas generation in oil (depending on sensors installed, may include methane, ethylene, acetylene, ethane, carbon dioxide, hydrogen, oxygen and carbon monoxide). Analysis and indication of incipient faults using the Duval triangle method LTC monitoring Evaluation of position indication, contact wear calculation and torque for comparison with learned values.
Duval’s analysis was performed. In case gas formation shows stability, no further action is recommended. TMDS will re-assess Duval’s analysis within 24 hours. Region of Duval’s Triangle = T2 - Thermal Fault, 200(degrees) C < T < 700 (degrees) C. Reduce load by 25 percent and re-assess transformer behavior. In case it persists, must undertake immediate internal inspection to establish cause of fault.
TMDS™ Smart Monitor delivers decision support to the right personnel in the context of actionable information.
7
Siemens’ answers for transformer monitoring
Siemens provides a comprehensive
TMDS™
suite of transformer life-cycle
TMDS™ supports a central diagnostic strategy where responsibility for fleetwide asset analysis and budget preparation is centralized. Field teams are typically dispatched by central maintenance or asset management groups.
management solutions specifically designed to meet your needs. TMDS™ Smart Monitor TMDS™ Smart Monitor supports a distributed diagnostic strategy where responsibility for responding to alarms and providing diagnostic expertise is regionally distributed. Field teams are self-sufficient in assessing asset condition, performing tests and arriving at corrective actions to be taken.
Differences in functionality and architecture between TMDS™ and TMDS™ Smart Monitor TMDS™
TMDS™ Smart Monitor
Provides monitoring and diagnostics for transformers in one or across multiple substations
X
Stand alone monitor for single transformer
Provides advanced detection of abnormal conditions
X
X
Supports customer preference in sensing technologies
X
X
Automatically detects bad sensor data to avoid false diagnosis
X
X
Provides maintenance support and loading recommendations to address abnormal operation
X
X
Provides overview of possible consequences (prognostics) if current trend or parameter deviation continues
X
X
Location of historical data and diagnostic information
Central TMDS™ engineering server
Smart Monitor flash memory
Access to data and diagnostic information
Active monitoring remotely via customer intranet
Active monitoring via Smart Monitor touch screen or remotely via Smart Monitor Web server
Cooling system control
X
X
Creates and monitors statistical definition for multiple parameters
X
Performs correlation between multiple parameters and across multiple transformers
X
The TMDS™ Smart Monitor can easily be installed on new or legacy transformers from any manufacturer utilizing existing sensors
Actionable information
Configurable for legacy transformers
Delivers statistically relevant abnormal operating data and alarm conditions Provides maintenance support to address abnormal operation Suggests loading recommendations through the adaptation of models using actual field condition assessment data. Sensing technology agnostic
Supports customer preference in transformer sensing technologies
Historical and diagnostic information that can be downloaded directly from the TMDS™ Smart Monitor and is also buffered up to 12 months
Allows customer to incorporate appropriate sensing technology based upon transformer importance.
DNP 3.0/Modbus communication options are available for SCADA-type communications.
Self diagnostic TMDS™ Smart Monitor automatically detects bad sensor data to avoid false diagnosis.
9 9 9
2
4
1 10
8
7
2 5 6 3
Features include: Active monitoring via TMDS™ Smart Monitor’s local 12” touch screen or laptop connection and passive monitoring remotely via built-in Web server
Due to the large availability of sensors in the market, TMDS™ Smart Monitor is designed to support data acquisition from different manufacturers’ sensors.
11
Legacy transformers are unique in that they each have a specific operational history. Siemens TMDS™ Smart Monitor allows condition assessment data to be incorporated into the configuration of alarms and recommended loading to take into account the operational history of the transformer.
Variables monitored, depending on sensors installed, include: 1. Winding temperature 2. Top and bottom oil temperatures 3. Ambient temperature 4. Load current 5. Fan motor current 6. Oil flow (pump motor) 7. Moisture in oil Aquaoil Vaisala 8. Dissolved gas in oil Multi-gas Serveron TM8 Siemens GAS-Guard 8 Kelman MULTITRANS Single-gas Calisto Hydran 9. Bushing condition Doble IDD HSP 10. LTC monitoring 11. Oil level
Published by and copyright © 2010: Siemens AG Energy Sector Freyeslebenstrasse 1 91058 Erlangen, Germany Siemens Energy, Inc. 7000 Siemens Road Wendell, NC 27591 For more information, contact +1 (800) 347-6659 www.usa.siemens.com/energy Siemens Canada Limited 1550 Appleby Line Burlington, Ontario, Canada +1 (905) 315-6868 Order No. E50001-F730-A155-X-76US Printed in USA BU 20099151385997F 01101 All rights reserved. Trademarks mentioned in this document are the property of Siemens AG, its affiliates, or their respective owners. Subject to change without prior notice. The information in this document contains general descriptions of the technical options available, which may not apply in all cases. The required technical options should therefore be specified in the contract.
www.usa.siemens.com/energy
GAS-Guard® 8 Online dissolved gas analysis sensor
Answers for energy.
Dissolved gas analysis (DGA)
Dissolved gas analysis is the single-most comprehensive tool for transformer condition assessment
Throughout your system there are transformers that are vital to the reliability of your grid - generator step-up transformers, large transmission transformers and critical substation transformers. Based on historical installation rates, the average transformer age is 40 years. However, age itself is not a cause of failure. As transformers age, they endure various stresses that can contribute to a variety of failure mechanisms. Appropriate online DGA monitoring and diagnostic tools can help utilities lower maintenance costs, extend transformer useful life and avoid unplanned failures. Gas chromatography (GC) has long been the accepted standard for the measurement of dissolved gas levels in transformer oil. The GAS-Guard® 8 brings the DGA laboratory to your transformer with its rugged, closed-loop gas chromatograph.
Key benefits include: Field-based, fully automated DGA requires no manual oil sampling or remote lab testing Use of the only measurement method specified for all DGA standards worldwide (IEE, IEC, ASTM) Built-in self calibration system traceable to NIST standards executes weekly tests for performance confirmation Accurate and timely DGA results improve the ability to protect transformer against fault damage Time-date stamped test results allow correlation between real events and measured conditions Data generated by the Gas-Guard 8 can be used to support condition-based maintenance programs.
Many transformer failures can be prevented through analysis of DGA data supporting the diagnosis of developing abnormal conditions.
Comprehensive data requires powerful analytical tools
The software package included with the GAS-Guard® 8 sensor allows the user to graphically display continuous gas evolution for each of the eight critical fault gases and as well as moisture, load and ambient temperature.
Online diagnostic tools The software package also allows the user to trace changes in fault severity over time through dynamic plots created using the Duval Triangle and Rogers Ratios analysis tools.
The Duval Triangle (IEC 60599-199-03) provides a diagnostic outcome for combinations of three fault gases.
Online DGA data populating diagnostic tools deliver new insights. This displays Rogers Ratios (IEEE PC57.104.D11d) and basic gas ratios (IEC 60599-1999-03).
SITRAM® GAS-Guard 8: Facts and figures Moisture-in-oil and oil temperature option
Environmental specifications
Parameter
Accuracy5
Range
Operating temperature
–50° C to + 55° C
Moisture-in-oil
±2%
0 – 100% RS6
Cold-start temperature
–20° C
<10% of reading for oil temperature >30° C
0 to 807 ppm
Operating humidity
5% to 95%, RH noncondensing
Oil inlet pressure
0 to 45 psi, to 3 bar
<18% of reading for oil temperature <30° C
0 to 807 ppm
Storage temperature
–40° C to +75° C
±0.1° C (typ.)
-40° C to +180° C
Storage humidity
5% to 95%, RH noncondensing
Oil temperature 5 6 7
Includes nonlinearity and repeatability Relative saturation Upper range limited to saturation
Total dissolved gases True total dissolved combustible gas (TDCG) output is available (∑H2, CO, CH4, C2H2, C2H4, C2H6 in PPM). Each gas is measured at 100% of detected level. Total hydrocarbons (THC) output is available (∑CH4, C2H2, C2H4, C2H6 in PPM).
Input power requirements Voltage
115 VAC or 230 VAC ±15%
Frequency
50/60 Hz
Current
6 A maximum at 115 V 3 A maximum at 230 V
Physical specifications and weights Height
22.0 in (55.9 cm)
Width
20.0 in (50.8 cm)
Depth
11.2 in (28.4 cm)
Gas analysis
Weight
65 lb (29.5 kg)
Oil sampling is continuous and gas analysis intervals are user-selectable from 2 hours to 12 hours (Default: 4 hours).
Enclosure rating
IP 66, NEMA 4
Packaged dimensions
26.4 in x 26.4 in x 15.9 in (67 cm x 67 cm x 40.3 cm)
Up to two years of data stored in memory.
Shipping weight (monitor only)
70 lb (31.8 kg)
Automatic schedule acceleration when rate of change alarm limit exceeded (Default: 1hour).
Certifications/standards
System performs periodic autocalibration to NIST8 traceable gas standard.
Electromagnetic compatibility
Each gas is measured at 100% of detected level.
All data is time-date stamped.
8
National Institute of Standards and Technology
Alarms
Specification
Test method
EN 61326 Class A: 2002
EN 61326:
2002 radiated emissions, 2002 conducted emissions
EN 61000-3-2: 2000
EN 61000-3-2:
2000 current harmonics
EN 61000-3-3: 2001
EN 61000-3-3:
2001 voltage fluctuations
EN 61326 Annex A: 2002
IEC 61000-4-2:
2001 ESD
IEC 61000-4-3:
2002 radiated immunity against HF field
IEC 61000-4-4:
2004 EFT
IEC 61000-4-5:
2001 surge
IEC 61000-4-6:
2004 conducted RF immunity
IEC 61000-4-8:
2001 magnetic field immunity
IEC 61000-4-11:
2004 voltage dips and interrupts
For each individual gas measured: Two individually programmable caution and alarm settings for level (ppm) as well as rate of change (ppm/day) Freely programmable relay contact for gas alarm or service event One relay contact for self-monitoring of power supply. External sensors Current sensor for load-dependent gas development Ambient temperature Moisture in oil and oil temperature Communications options Standard physical layer interfaces include RS-232, RS-485, Ethernet (10/100Base-TX), V.92 internal POTS modem. Optional physical layer interfaces include cellular modem, Ethernet (100Base-FX), wireless radio. Three 4-20 mA inputs and one RS-232 port available to connect to optional devices. Protocols supported: TCP/IP, DNP3, Modbus RTU and ASCII, OPC
Safety IEC 61010-1, IEC 61010-2-81 UL 61010-1 (2nd Edition), UL 60950-1 Clause 6.4 CSA-C22.2 No. 61010-1-04
The Siemens GAS-Guard® 8 provides accurate and repeatable measurement of eight (8) critical fault gases
Graphical representation of GAS-Guard 8 connected to the transformer tank. DGA tolerances of the GAS-Guard 8 Gas
Accuracy1
Repeatability2
Range3
Hydrogen
H2
+/- 5% or +/- 2 ppm
<2%
2-3,000 ppm
Oxygen
O2 +/- 5% or +30 / - 0 ppm
<1%
30-5,000 ppm
Methane
CH4
+/- 5% or +/- 10 ppm
<1%
10-5,000 ppm
Carbon Monoxide
CO
+/- 5% or +/- 3 ppm
<1%
3-10,000 ppm
CO2
+/- 5% or +/- 5 ppm
<1%
5-30,000 ppm
Ethylene
C2H4
+/- 5% or +/- 3 ppm
<1%
3-5,000 ppm
Ethane
C2H6
+/- 5% or +/- 5 ppm
<1%
5-5,000 ppm
Acetylene
C2H2
+/- 5% or +/- 1 ppm
<2%
1-3,000 ppm
Carbon Dioxide
Through chromatography, the GAS-Guard 8 generates individual measurements of eight critical fault gases found in transformer oil. Accuracy is commensurate with traditional lab results. The sensor continually collects oil samples as often as every two hours. The GAS-Guard 8 can also measure moisture in the oil, oil temperature and ambient temperature. DGA results and other measurement data are time-date stamped and can thus be correlated to transformer load.
NOTES: All specifications are independent of oil temperature and gas pressure level. 1 Percent of ppm - whichever is greater 2 At gas calibration level 3 Gas-in-oil
The Siemens GAS-Guard 8 sensor provides a complete online dissolved gas analysis.
Published by and copyright © 2010: Siemens AG Energy Sector Freyeslebenstrasse 1 91058 Erlangen, Germany Siemens Energy, Inc. 7000 Siemens Road Wendell, NC 27591 For more information, please contact: Telephone: +1 (919) 365-2200 Toll-free: +1 (800) 347-6659 Siemens Canada Limited 1550 Appleby Line Burlington, Ontario, Canada L7L 6X7 +1 (905) 315-6868 Order No. E50001-F730-A110-X-4A00 Printed in USA TD 2009212142519480F BR 0110.5 All rights reserved. Trademarks mentioned in this document are the property of Siemens AG, its affiliates, or their respective owners. Subject to change without prior notice. The information in this document contains general descriptions of the technical options available, which may not apply in all cases. The required technical options should therefore be specified in the contract.
www.usa.siemens.com/energy
Type NR Neutral Grounding Resistors APPLICATION
Neutral Grounding Resistor
Powerohm Type NR Neutral Grounding Resistors are used in industrial power systems for resistance grounding of wyeconnected generators and transformers. A neutral grounding resistor limits the fault current to a value which is sufficient enough to operate protective relays, yet prevent unwanted fault damage.
Neutral Grounding Resistor Schematic Transformer or Generator Secondary N To Protective Relay
CT R
Neutral Grounding Resistor G
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS Neutral grounding resistors are rated in line-to-neutral voltage (system voltage divided by 1.732), initial fault current and maximum time on. Powerohm neutral grounding resistors are designed to dissipate the required amount of energy and not exceed the temperature limitations of IEEE Standard 32-1972. As defined in this publication, the time and temperature ratings for neutral grounding resistors are as follows: Short time: Short time ratings are 10 and 60 seconds. Since short time rated resistors can only withstand rated current for short periods of time, they are usually used with fault clearing relays. The short time temperature rise for the resistive element is 760°C. Extended time: A time on rating greater than ten minutes which permits temperature rise of resistive elements to become constant, but limited to an average not more than 90 days per year. The extended temperature rise for the resistive element is 610°C. Continuous: Capable of withstanding rated current for an indefinite period of time. The continuous temperature rise for the resistive element is 385°C.
Ω POWEROHM RESISTORS, INC.
BASIC CONSTRUCTION Resistor Assembly: The resistor coils consist of a stainless steel edgewound element wound around a ceramic core supported on a through-rod. Glazed insulators are attached to each end of the coils and fastened to a heavy gage, corrosion resistant frame. The unit is designed to permit the expansion of supporting rods when submitted to high operating temperatures. Resistor elements are joined by stainless steel connectors, which are welded in place, to form a positive electrical path. Safety Enclosure: Our resistor assemblies are available with grounded safety enclosures to protect personnel and wildlife from harm. Screened and louvered enclosures are available in a variety of finishes including painted, powder coated, mill galvanized, hot-dipped galvanized, aluminum and stainless steel. Options: A number of additional options are available including entrance bushings, current transformers, elevating stands and disconnect switches.
ELECTRICAL TESTS All units are factory tested in accordance with IEEE Standard 32-1972, specifically Sections 10.1.4 and 10.3.2. The procedure includes a resistance measurement test to verify that the tolerance is within + 10%, and an applied potential test. A copy of the test report is included with each shipped unit. 5713 13th Street Katy, Texas 77493 Phone: (281) 391-6800, Fax: (281) 391-6810 Please visit our website at www.powerohm.com
Ratings & Dimensions of Standard Size Units RATINGS: The following table contains information on the most common size units, other variations are available.
10 SECOND TIME RATINGS CATALOG NUMBER
INITIAL AMPS
RESISTANCE
A
B
1390 VOLTS LINE-TO-NEUTRAL (2400 VOLT SYSTEM) 13.90 NR1390-100-10 100 38 38 6.95 NR1390-200-10 200 38 38 4.63 NR1390-300-10 300 38 38 3.48 NR1390-400-10 400 38 38 2.78 NR1390-500-10 500 38 38 2.32 NR1390-600-10 600 38 38 1.74 NR1390-800-10 800 38 38 1.39 NR1390-1000-10 1000 38 38
C
APPROX. WEIGHT
DIMENSIONS: The dimensions listed in the table are in inches. Information subject to change without notice. FRONT VIEW Neutral Bushing
30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30
280 290 300 310 320 340 350 360
30 30 30 30 30 30 36 36
380 390 400 410 420 430 490 500
Ground Terminal
2400 VOLTS LINE-TO-NEUTRAL (4160 VOLT SYSTEM) NR2400-100-10 NR2400-200-10 NR2400-300-10 NR2400-400-10 NR2400-500-10 NR2400-600-10 NR2400-800-10 NR2400-1000-10
100 200 300 400 500 600 800 1000
24.00 12.00 8.00 6.00 4.80 4.00 3.00 2.40
38 38 38 38 38 38 38 38
38 38 38 38 38 38 38 38
RIGHT SIDE VIEW
4160 VOLTS LINE-TO-NEUTRAL (7200 VOLT SYSTEM) NR4160-100-10 NR4160-200-10 NR4160-300-10 NR4160-400-10 NR4160-500-10 NR4160-600-10 NR4160-800-10 NR4160-1000-10
100 200 300 400 500 600 800 1000
41.60 20.80 13.87 10.40 8.32 6.93 5.20 4.16
38 38 38 38 38 38 44 44
38 38 38 38 38 38 54 54
A
36 36 36 36 36 36 54 54
550 560 570 580 590 600 680 700
C
8000 VOLTS LINE-TO-NEUTRAL (13800 VOLT SYSTEM) NR8000-100-10 NR8000-200-10 NR8000-300-10 NR8000-400-10 NR8000-500-10 NR8000-600-10 NR8000-800-10 NR8000-1000-10
100 200 300 400 500 600 800 1000
80.00 40.00 26.70 20.00 16.00 13.30 10.00 8.00
44 44 44 44 44 44 44 44
54 54 54 54 54 54 54 54
54 54 54 54 54 54 84 84
820 830 840 850 870 880 950 990
30 30 36
320 370 420
36 36 54
450 550 850
54 54 54
900 950 1400
B
EXTENDED TIME RATINGS 1390 VOLTS LINE-TO-NEUTRAL (2400 VOLT SYSTEM) NR1390-15-E NR1390-25-E NR1390-50-E
15 25 50
92.7 55.6 27.8
38 38 38
38 38 38
2400 VOLTS LINE-TO-NEUTRAL (4160 VOLT SYSTEM) NR2400-15-E NR2400-25-E NR2400-50-E
15 25 50
160.0 96.0 48.0
38 38 44
38 38 54
4160 VOLTS LINE-TO-NEUTRAL (7200 VOLT SYSTEM) NR4160-15-E NR4160-25-E NR4160-50-E
15 25 50
227.3 166.4 83.2
44 44 84
54 54 54
The above drawing details a typical neutral grounding resistor with enclosure. Units are available with screened or louvered covers on front and back. All units normally have solid tops and sides and a perforated bottom. TO ORDER A NEUTRAL GROUNDING RESISTOR NOT LISTED IN THE TABLE, SPECIFY THE FOLLOWING: 1. Line-to-neutral voltage. 2. Initial fault current. 3. Maximum time on. 4. Special requirements or options.
Generator Neutral Grounding Resistors APPLICATION
Generator Neutral Grounding Resistor
Powerohm offers high resistance grounding equipment for wye connected generators. Our equipment is normally designed to limit the line-to-ground fault current to below 15 amps for generators rated up to 14,400 volts. These units will provide a high resistance neutral during a fault condition, while allowing the system to operate as an ungrounded system during normal operating conditions. The configuration basically consists of a dry-type single-phase transformer with a resistor connected across the secondary. The primary of the transformer is then connected between the wye point of the generator and ground. Powerohm generator grounding equipment is normally supplied with the transformer and resistor installed in a common enclosure. Continuous rated units are usually compartmentalized to separate the resistor assembly from the transformer which is subject to overheating. Units do not normally include any relaying or control circuitry, but do offer the transformer secondary wired to a terminal block installed in an external junction box. WYE-CONNECTED GENERATOR N R
TO PROTECTIVE RELAY
GROUNDING TRANSFORMER G
BASIC CONSTRUCTION Transformer: For continuous time ratings, the transformer must be capable of withstanding rated current for an indefinite period of time; therefore, the KVA rating of the grounding transformer is equal to the rated line-to-neutral voltage times the desired neutral current. For a short-time rating, the KVA rating of a grounding transformer will be smaller because the unit is designed to carry its rated current for a limited time. Resistor Assembly: The resistance value is calculated by dividing the secondary voltage by the rated current necessary to obtain the desired fault current on the primary. Resistor elements are selected to best meet the current and voltage requirements of the system. A typical assembly includes all stainless steel elements, bus bars and terminals.
Safety Enclosure: Our grounding assemblies are available in grounded NEMA 1 or NEMA 3R safety enclosures, complete with nearly any finish including mill galvanized, power coated, hot dipped galvanized after fabrication, aluminum or stainless steel. Options: A number of additional options are available, including entrance bushings, current transformers, elevating stands, and disconnect switches.
ELECTRICAL TESTS All units are factory tested in accordance with IEEE Standard 32-1972, specifically Sections 10.1.4 and 10.3.2. The procedure includes a resistance measurement test to verify that the tolerance is within + 10%, and an applied potential test. A copy of the test report is included with each shipped unit.
Resistance Grounding with a Zigzag Transformer Zigzag Grounding Transformer with Resistor
APPLICATION The best way to resistance ground a power system is to obtain the system neutral through a generator or transformer with a wye-connected winding. However, a system neutral may not be available, particularly in many older low voltage systems and a significant number of existing medium voltage systems. To avoid the high cost of replacing a source transformer, an existing delta-connected system can be grounded using a zigzag transformer to form an artificial neutral, then connecting a resistor between the newly created wye-point and ground. A zigzag transformer has no secondary winding, and is designed to provide a low-impedance path for the zerosequence currents to flow. During a line-to-ground fault condition, the zero sequence currents can flow into the ground at the point of the fault, and back through the neutral of the grounding transformer. The impedance of the zigzag transformer to balanced three-phase voltages is relatively high, therefore, when there is no fault on the system, only a small magnetizing current flows in the windings. A zigzag grounding transformer provides a stable neutral point which makes possible its use for grounding an otherwise isolated neutral system. A zigzag transformer with a resistance ground is normally designed for a short time rating of 10 to 60 seconds. Consequently, the grounding transformer is much smaller in size than an ordinary continuously rated transformer with the same rating. For short time ratings, the short time temperature rise for the resistive element is 760°C.
TO UNGROUNDED 3-PHASE VOLTAGE SOURCE
TO UNGROUNDED 3-PHASE LOAD
ZIGZAG TRANSFORMER
BASIC CONSTRUCTION Transformer: For a short time rating, the grounding transformer is designed to carry its rated current for a limited time, consequently the unit is ordinarily much smaller, physically, than an ordinary three-phase transformer for the same rated kVA. Resistor Assembly: The resistance value is calculated by dividing the line-to-neutral voltage by the rated neutral current. Resistor elements are selected to best meet the short time current rating and voltage requirements of the system. A typical assembly includes all stainless steel elements, bus bars and terminals. Safety Enclosure: Our grounding assemblies are available in grounded NEMA 1 or NEMA 3R safety enclosures, complete with nearly any finish, including mill galvanized, power coated, hot dipped galvanized after fabrication, aluminum, or stainless steel. Options: A number of additional options are available including entrance bushings, current transformers, elevating stands and disconnect switches.
ELECTRICAL TESTS R
RESISTOR
G
All units are factory tested in accordance with IEEE Standard 32-1972, specifically Sections 10.1.4 and 10.3.2. The procedure includes a resistance measurement test to verify that the tolerance is within + 10%, and an applied potential test. A copy of the test report is included with each shipped unit.
24 HOUR EMERGENCY SERVICE
(800) 838-4694
Type ER and ERB Edgewound Resistors - 16 to 100 Amps APPLICATION
Type ER Edgewound Resistor
Powerohm's Type ER and ERB Edgewound Resistors can be used for any AC or DC power application. Units are most commonly used for VFD braking, motor control, load banks and neutral grounding applications. The Type ER and ERB resistors are suitable for continuous duty applications where low resistance and high current are required. The high element mass allows these units to withstand high current, intermittent duty applications. This characteristic, combined with the high-temperature ceramic insulation, makes the edgewound ideal for neutral grounding applications, which reach temperatures as high as 800°C.
ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS BASIC CONSTRUCTION Powerohm's Type ER and ERB resistors are lightweight, heavy-duty units consisting of a non-corrodible, high quality stainless steel alloy. The ribbon-like element is wound on edge in the form of a helix, and then spun onto a ceramic core. Type ER resistors are supported by a threaded rod passing through the center of the ceramic core. Type ERB resistors are supported by a mounting bar which is slotted at either end. Fixed terminations are made by welding stainless steel tabs to either end of the element, or at various points for multiple connections. This unit includes fixed terminals, through-rods, through-bars, hardware and stainless steel element. Our ceramic insulating cores are manufactured in-house to maintain total control over production and quality standards. Powerohm is the only domestic resistor manufacturer with this added advantage.
OPTIONS COIL SIZES: Type ER and ERB resistors are available in (6) standard lengths, all having the same, approximate diameter of 2 inches. Wattage values vary from 400 to 2300 watts per coil. These units are available in (15) different current ratings ranging from 16 to 100 amps continuous, and resistance values between 6.2 and .06 ohms, respectively. ADJUSTABLE TERMINALS: Adjustable terminals, which can be clamped to the element, are available for certain size units; add "-A" to the part number. ENCLOSURES: Powerohm Type ER resistors can be packaged in our standard line of enclosures. See the Enclosure Catalog Section for details.
Ω POWEROHM RESISTORS, INC.
VOLTAGE INSULATION: A standard Type ER and ERB resistor is insulated for up to 1000 volts. Standard enclosures are insulated for up to 1000 volts and by adding further stages of insulation, an assembly of units can be used for applications exceeding 15 kV. RESISTANCE TOLERANCE: + 10% for all units; as low as + 3% if required. COEFFICIENT OF RESISTIVITY: Resistance values will increase as the element temperature rises. Expect an approximate increase of 5% in resistance after the unit reaches an operating temperature of 375°C above ambient. Contact the factory for more specific information if needed. AMBIENT TEMPERATURE: Standard ratings are based on maximum ambient temperatures of 40°C. Derate current rating 95% for 50°C ambient, 90% for 75°C ambient, and 85% for 100°C ambient. EFFECTS OF ALTITUDE: The published electrical ratings are applicable for altitudes of 6000 feet or less. Contact the factory for deration factors above 6000 feet.
CUSTOM DESIGNS Powerohm offers a complete selection of standard size coils on the following page. These coils cover a wide range of resistance and current values. Numerous variations are available for special applications or replacement of other manufacturers. Powerohm can match the electrical ratings of any edgewound product available. Please contact the factory for assistance.
5713 13th Street Katy, Texas 77493 Phone: (281) 391-6800, Fax: (281) 391-6810 Please visit our website at www.powerohm.com
Type ER Electrical Ratings & Coils Dimensions SPECIFY PART NUMBERS AS FOLLOWS: ER or ERB __ - __ . For example, the part number of a Type ER, 50 Length amp, 0.51 ohm coil is ER5-50. Amp Rating RATINGS: The continuous current ratings are based on a 375°C temperature rise. The resistance values are measured at 25°C and have a + 10% tolerance.
ELECTRICAL RATINGS OF STANDARD SIZE COILS CONTINUOUS AMP RATING
RESISTANCE IN OHMS LENGTH 2
LENGTH 3
LENGTH 4
LENGTH 5
LENGTH 6
LENGTH 7
15
1.90
3.00
4.10
5.10
6.20
7.20
16
1.70
2.60
3.50
4.40
5.30
6.20
18
1.30
2.0
2.7
3.5
4.2
4.90
20
1.20
1.80
2.4
3.1
3.7
4.3
23
.89
1.37
1.85
2.3
2.8
3.3
26
.69
1.06
1.44
1.81
2.2
2.6
29
.49
.75
1.02
1.29
1.55
1.82
32
.43
.66
.90
1.13
1.37
1.60
36
.35
.54
.73
.92
1.11
1.30
40
.27
.41
.56
.70
.85
.99
45
.25
.38
.52
.65
.78
.92
50
.19
.30
.40
.51
.62
.72
60
.15
.23
.32
.40
.48
.57
70
.12
.19
.26
.33
.39
.46
85
.07
.11
.15
.19
.23
.27
100
.06
.10
.13
.16
.20
.23
TYPE ER DIMENSIONS: The coil dimensions are for standard size units. Coil and threaded rod length can be varied per customer request. All units have the same approximate diameter of 2 inches. Units are furnished with 5/16"-18 through rods and terminal hardware. FRONT VIEW
SIDE VIEW
3/8 DIA. 3
C B A
STANDARD COIL DIMENSIONS LENGTH
A
B
C
2
9-3/8
7
6-1/8
3
12-3/8
10
9-1/8
4
15-3/8
13
12-1/8
5
18-3/8
16
15-1/8
6
21-3/8
19
18-1/8
7
24-3/8
22
21-1/8
Type ERB Coil Dimensions & Tap Options TYPE ERB (BAR-MOUNT) EDGEWOUND DIMENSIONS TYPE ERB EDGEWOUND: Type ERB bar-mounted edgewounds are available with the same electrical ratings as the Type ER edgewounds. All units have the same approximate diameter of 2 inches. Units are furnished with a through-bar and terminal hardware. FRONT VIEW
SIDE VIEW 3/8 DIA.
(2) 17/32 SLOTS
3
1-1/4 B A
STANDARD COIL DIMENSIONS LENGTH
A
B
2
9-1/4
7-7/8
3
12-1/4
10-7/8
4
15-1/4
13-7/8
5
18-1/4
16-7/8
6
21-1/4
19-7/8
7
24-1/4
22-7/8
ADDITIONAL TAPS Type ER resistors are furnished with two stainless steel terminals at either end of the ceramic core. Additional fixed taps consist of a stainless steel terminal welded in place at various intervals. Numerous tap configurations are available, but limited to a spacing no closer than 1-1/4 inches. SPECIFY PART NUMBERS AS FOLLOWS: Part Number Number of Taps
-
For example, the part number of a Type ER, 50 amp, 0.51 ohm coil with 2 taps at 1/3 spacing is ER5-50-2C. See below for additional part number examples.
Spacing (See Table)
ADDITIONAL TAPS & SPACING CHART FRACTIONAL SPACING
SUFFIX LETTER
1/2 1/3 1/4 1/5
B C D E
1/6 1/7 1/8 1/9
F G H J
1/10 1/11 1/12 1/13
K L M N
1/14 1/15 1/16 1/17
P R S T
Other examples of ER Edgewound Resistors with additional taps.
ER3-50-1D (1 TAP @ 1/4 SPACING)
ER3-50-5F (5 TAP @ 1/6 SPACING)
Type ER Mounting Bracket Options & Dimensions Type ER Edgewound Resistors are available fully assembled on open-style brackets. This open-style construction consist of resistors installed on mill galvanized brackets complete with all hardware and stainless steel bus bars. ER
SPECIFY PART NUMBERS AS FOLLOWS:
-
.
Number of Coils in Assembly Part Number Bracket Identification
For example, the part number of a Type ER, 50 amp, 0.51 ohm coil mounted on B1 Brackets is 1ER5-50-B1. Standard assemblies of 2 or more coils include series jumpers. Add "-N" to eliminate jumpers and "-P" for parallel jumpers.
STANDARD BRACKET DIMENSIONS DIMENSION
SIZE 2
SIZE 3
SIZE 4
SIZE 5
SIZE 6
SIZE 7
A
9
12
15
18
21
24
B
8
11
14
17
20
23
B1 BRACKET ASSEMBLY OPTIONS & DIMENSIONS FRONT VIEW
SIDE VIEW 5/16 HARDWARE
7/16 DIA.
P11026 1.23 1500W
3-1/2
2
B A
B2 BRACKET ASSEMBLY OPTIONS & DIMENSIONS FRONT VIEW
SIDE VIEW
6
7/16 DIA.
P0000 0.00 0000W
5/16 HARDWARE
3-1/4
B A
B3 BRACKET ASSEMBLY OPTIONS & DIMENSIONS FRONT VIEW
SIDE VIEW
P0000 0.00 0000W
5/16 HARDWARE
9 7/16 DIA. B
3-1/4
A
24 HOUR EMERGENCY SERVICE
(800) 838-4694